213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252022-11-012023-10-31iso4217:GBPxbrli:shares213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252021-11-012022-10-31213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252022-11-012023-10-31crestnicholsonholdingsplc:PreExceptionalItemsMemberiso4217:GBP213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252022-11-012023-10-31crestnicholsonholdingsplc:ExceptionalItemsMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252021-11-012022-10-31crestnicholsonholdingsplc:PreExceptionalItemsMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252021-11-012022-10-31crestnicholsonholdingsplc:ExceptionalItemsMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252021-10-31ifrs-full:IssuedCapitalMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252021-10-31ifrs-full:SharePremiumMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252021-10-31ifrs-full:RetainedEarningsMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252021-10-31213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252021-11-012022-10-31ifrs-full:IssuedCapitalMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252021-11-012022-10-31ifrs-full:SharePremiumMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252021-11-012022-10-31ifrs-full:RetainedEarningsMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252022-10-31ifrs-full:IssuedCapitalMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252022-10-31ifrs-full:SharePremiumMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252022-10-31ifrs-full:RetainedEarningsMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252022-10-31213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252022-11-012023-10-31ifrs-full:IssuedCapitalMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252022-11-012023-10-31ifrs-full:SharePremiumMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252022-11-012023-10-31ifrs-full:RetainedEarningsMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252023-10-31ifrs-full:IssuedCapitalMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252023-10-31ifrs-full:SharePremiumMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252023-10-31ifrs-full:RetainedEarningsMember213800ROIFXRRRKVQD252023-10-31
Strong
foundations
for the future
Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Built for
the future
2023 has seen challenging trading conditions for UK
housebuilders. Our attractive land portfolio means
that we are well positioned for the future and our
purpose remains unchanged. We build great places
for our customers, communities and the environment.
Our focus on placemaking means that we create
sustainable communities where people and nature
can thrive.
Cautionary statement
The Annual Report and financial statements
for the year ended 31 October 2023 as
contained in this document (Annual Report),
contains information which readers might
consider to be forward looking statements
relating to or in respect of the financial
condition, results, operations or businesses
of Crest Nicholson Holdings plc (Company).
Any such statements involve risk and
uncertainty because they relate to future
events and circumstances. There are many
factors that could cause actual results or
developments to dier materially from
those expressed or implied by any such
forward looking statements. Nothing in this
Annual Report should be construed as a
profit forecast.
Approval
The Strategic Report for the financial year
ended 31 October 2023 as presented on
pages 1 to 52 was approved by the Board of
Directors on 23 January 2024 and signed on
its behalf by:
Penny Thomas
Company Secretary
Ackender Hill, Alton, Hampshire
Front cover image:
Kilnwood Vale, Horsham, West Sussex
Crest Nicholson
Strategic Report
Our year in review 1
Crest Nicholson at a glance 2
Chairman’s statement 4
Chief Executive’s statement 6
Our strategy 10
Market overview 12
Business model 14
Stakeholder relations 16
Sustainability review 20
Protect the environment 21
Make a positive impact on
our communities 25
Operate our business responsibly 26
Safety, Health & Environment 27
Our People 28
Key performance indicators 30
Financial review 32
Principal risks and uncertainties 35
Task Force on Climate-related
Financial Disclosures 43
Non-financial and sustainability
information statement 51
Viability statement and Going Concern 52
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Corporate Governance Report 54
Nomination Committee Report 70
Audit and Risk Committee Report 74
Directors’ Remuneration Report 81
Directors’ Report 99
Financial Statements
Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities 102
Independent auditors’ report 103
Consolidated income statement 111
Consolidated statement
of comprehensive income 111
Consolidated statement
of changes in equity 112
Consolidated statement
of financial position 113
Consolidated cash flow statement 114
Notes to the consolidated
financial statements 115
Company statement of financial position 156
Company statement of
changes in equity 157
Notes to the Company financial statements 158
Alternative performance
measures (unaudited) 161
Historical summary (unaudited) 163
Shareholder services and Glossary 164
Sales
1
£692.1m
FY22: £955.8m
Our year in review
We have responded proactively to dicult trading
conditions and maintained our financial position.
Revenue
£657.5m
FY22: £913.6m
Adjusted profit before tax
1
£41.4m
FY22: £137.8m
Profit before tax
£23.1m
FY22: £32.8m
Adjusted operating profit margin
1
6.7%
FY22: 15.4%
Operating profit margin
4.5%
FY22: 4.2%
Return on capital employed
1
6.3%
FY22: 22.4%
Net cash
1
£64.9m
FY22: £276.5m
Customer satisfaction
4 star
FY22: 5 star
1 Sales, adjusted profit before tax, adjusted operating
profit margin, return on capital employed and net cash
are non-statutory alternative performance measures
(APMs) used by the Directors to manage the business
which they believe should be shared for a greater
understanding of the performance of the Group.
The definitions of these APMs and the reconciliation to
the statutory numbers are included on pages 161 to 162.
Crest Nicholson 1 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Crest Nicholson at a glance
We are building strong foundations
for the future.
Our purpose
Building great places for our customers,
communities and the environment.
We invest in placemaking, delivering
attractive homes and incorporating
sustainable and energy-ecient featefficient features
in our developments. We strive to make a
positive dierefference to people’s lives.
Our culture
We have an open, welcoming, values-
based culture.
We create a positive, eective and
collaborative working environment to deliver
continued performance that contributes to
our success.
Our values
Our values underpin how we implement our strategy,
defining who we are and how we operate.
Integrating sustainability
We recognise the social responsibilities
we have as a Group to support the natural
environment, human and social capital we
engage with. Sustainability is an integral
part of our strategy and culture. We embed
responsible practices throughout all aspects
of the Group, enabling us to contribute
positively to society and create long-term
value for our stakeholders.
Our sustainability strategy is focused on
three priority areas:
Elmsbrook, Bicester, Oxfordshire
3
Doing the right thing
The safety and wellbeing of
our employees, partners and
communities is our number one
priority. Everything we do is built on a
foundation of integrity, quality and care.
4
Championing our people
We invest in the wellbeing and
development of our people.
We provide them with the tools and
support to be the best they can be.
1
Working together
We are one Crest. We value our
diverse and inclusive workplace
and support each other. We
collaborate closely to build fair
and rewarding relationships.
2
Being the best we can be
We improve and inspire each other
to get things done. We have passion
for what we do and pride in how we
accomplish it.
5
Leaving a positive legacy
We care passionately about the
natural environment. We create
beautiful homes and places
that deliver lasting benefits to our
customers and communities.
Protect the environment
Make a positive impact on communities
Operate our business responsibly
See pages 20 to 26
Crest Nicholson 2 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Our strategy
Our strategy seeks to build on
our strengths and address the
challenges we face. Our five Strategic
Priorities are underpinned by
four Foundations.
Divisional structure
We have five established divisions
predominately in Southern England. In FY22
we opened a new division in Yorkshire.
We have a dedicated Partnerships and
Strategic Land (PSL) division.
Partnerships and Strategic Land
The division has two primary functions: the first
of these is building and establishing strategic
relationships with Registered Providers and
the Private Rented Sector to enable delivery
of Crest Nicholson homes through dierent
tenures. The second function is to acquire,
secure and progress strategic land through
key planning stages.
The PSL division maximises value through
scheme design and placemaking principles
while demonstrating broad expertise in housing,
land and planning. The team has secured
land deals on promising sites in a challenging
market. The existing strategic land portfolio is
actively promoted, with several sites advancing
through key planning stages, including new
Local Plan allocations and draft allocations in
emerging plans. Additionally, the team has
been at the forefront of addressing regional and
national planning challenges, such as emerging
environmental legislation and proposed
changes to the planning system.
1
South West
2
South
3
Chiltern
4
5
Midlands
6
Yorkshire
6
5
3
1
2
4
P
e
o
p
l
e
F
i
n
a
n
c
i
a
l
T
a
r
g
e
t
s
S
u
s
t
a
i
n
a
b
i
l
i
t
y
&
S
o
c
i
a
l
V
a
l
u
e
O
u
r
S
t
r
a
t
e
g
i
c
P
r
i
o
r
i
t
i
e
s
O
u
r
F
o
u
n
d
a
t
i
o
n
s
S
a
f
e
t
y
,
H
e
a
l
t
h
&
E
n
v
i
r
o
n
m
e
n
t
Placemaking
& Quality
Land
Portfolio
Operational
Eciency
Five-Star
Customer
Service
Multi
Channel
Approach
Eastern
Crest Nicholson 3 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Chairmans statement
During our financial year ended 31 October
2023 the UK continued to experience
challenging and changing economic
conditions. The first period followed the
Mini-Budget in late September 2022,
which triggered instant turmoil in financial
markets and a sharp spike in interest
rates. This volatility immediately impacted
confidence in the housing market as
transaction numbers deteriorated. As we
moved into the spring, we saw some stability
and confidence return. However, as interest
rates continued to rise to combat stubborn
levels of inflation, the market weakened again
over the summer as the aordability of new
homes came under increasing pressure.
The planning environment has become more
complex. Local authorities face challenges to
process approvals eectively due to limited
resources within planning departments and
we have to navigate increasing regulatory
and environmental constraints.
In the first half of our financial year the
Group purchased several high quality sites
at attractive terms. These sites are in various
stages of planning and will be progressed at
pace when market conditions improve.
The Board has carefully considered the
impacts of the uncertain macro-economic
environment and the more onerous
planning system on our current strategy
and outlook. During the year we took the
dicult decision to restructure the Group’s
operations to reflect our expectations of
the weaker demand environment persisting
into FY24. In our Yorkshire division, which
is now operational and expected to deliver
completions in FY24, we have lowered our
expectations of volume growth over the
medium term. In addition, we have decided
to consolidate our new East Anglia division
into our existing Eastern division and this
Iain Ferguson CBE
Chairman
Confident for
the medium
term
Crest Nicholson 4 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
our values, as well as have the skills and
capabilities to perform their role, in order to
fulfil our purpose. The Board has made visits
to several of our developments during the
year. This gave us the opportunity to meet
with our colleagues at their places of work
and to hear from them at first hand which
provides important feedback to the Board.
Sustainability and future homes
Our sustainability strategy represents an
ambitious programme of change and we are
pleased to report that we are making good
progress against our targets. We continue
to focus on reducing emissions, delivering
high quality and energy ecient homes.
We partner with and engage closely with
our supply chain to procure materials in
a responsible manner. In June 2023 the
Group successfully implemented the interim
update to Part L of the Building Regulations.
Our future focus includes biodiversity and the
Future Homes Standard while we continue
to influence and prepare for other emerging
regulatory changes.
Dividend
The Board announced at the HY23 results
that it expected the dividend for FY23 to be
at the same level as the FY22 total dividend
paid. I am pleased to announce that the
Board is recommending a final dividend at
11.5 pence per share (FY22: 11.5 pence per
share). Subject to shareholders’ approval, this
will be paid on 23 April 2024. This will make
the total dividend for FY23 in line with the
prior year at 17.0 pence per share.
Board changes
In December 2023 Duncan Cooper, Group
Finance Director, left Crest Nicholson after
four and a half years to pursue his career in
another listed company. During his tenure,
Duncan has played a critical role in the
development and transformation of the
business and has been a valued member of
the Board. On behalf of the Board, I would
like to thank Duncan for his dedication,
professionalism and significant contribution
to our business.
After an extensive search, I am pleased to
announce that Bill Floydd joined the Board as
Group Finance Director in November 2023.
Bill is a highly experienced executive with a
strong track record of finance leadership in
a range of publicly listed companies. I would
like to express a warm welcome to Bill and
look forward to working with him.
I would also like to take this opportunity
to thank Lucinda Bell, who stepped down
from the Board in December 2023, for her
valued contribution to the Board over the
past six years as a Non-Executive Director.
Dr Maggie Semple OBE joined the Board as
Non-Executive Director in January 2024. I am
delighted to welcome Maggie to the Board.
She brings a breadth of experience across a
number of sectors and will complement the
range of skills and experience on the existing
Board. We look forward to working with her.
Outlook and future focus
The housing market is likely to remain
challenging in 2024 as the higher interest
rate environment continues to impact
aordability. In a year where a General
Election is likely, all political parties agree that
the planning system needs significant reform.
It is against this backdrop and expectation
that the Board fully supported management’s
decision to streamline the Group’s operations
and overheads. Maintaining a robust financial
position will always be a key priority for the
Board, and it is with this in mind that we
expect to return to our dividend policy of 2.5
times cover.
Despite the tougher trading conditions,
we remain focused on investing in our
colleagues to ensure they are well prepared
to navigate the current environment, can
implement the regulatory changes impacting
our sector and are ready to respond when
more positive market conditions return.
I would like to thank all my colleagues for
their dedication and commitment during
the year and for their understanding and
professionalism in delivering some of the
necessary changes we have made.
The Board remains confident in the medium-
term prospects of Crest Nicholson. The UK
continues to face an imbalance of housing
supply for the underlying level of demand.
While aordability and confidence have been
impacted this year, pricing has remained
stable, highlighting this market characteristic.
Our decision to remain active in the land
market, albeit on a selective basis, has
ensured that we have several strong sites
that will be ready to support a return to
growth at the right time.
Iain Ferguson CBE
Chairman
Despite the tougher trading
conditions, we remain focused
on investing in our colleagues to
ensure they are well prepared to
navigate the current environment
and are ready to respond for
whenmore positive market
conditions return.
transition has now been finalised. Finally,
we have adjusted our growth expectations
in all our other existing divisions and
aligned the headcount and resourcing
requirements accordingly.
People and culture
The Board is committed to developing and
maintaining an eective culture that supports
the wellbeing and eectiveness of our
colleagues. During the year we undertook
an externally facilitated assessment of our
culture to understand perspectives from
across our business. The findings were
illuminating and insightful, allowing us to
develop an action plan which seeks to build
on the Group’s existing areas of strength,
while identifying new ideas and ways of
working. The Board recognises that our
culture never stands still. We recognise
that our colleagues need to understand
Crest Nicholson 5 Annual Report andnancial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Chief Executives statement
Introduction
The past financial year proved to be one
characterised by significant uncertainty in the
housing sector. In contrast to the previous
year, which experienced robust market
conditions despite supply chain challenges
aecting home delivery, FY23 saw a reversal
of this trend. The sales market weakened
and supply chain pressures gradually eased,
leading to a reduction in inflationary impacts.
While we have encountered challenging
conditions, and performance was more
disappointing than anticipated, the Group
remained profitable, concluding the year with
a strong balance sheet which facilitated a
dividend payout at the same level as FY22.
The economy and housing market
The housing market showed signs of
weakening during late summer and early
autumn of 2022. This downturn was
triggered by the poorly received Mini-Budget
from the Truss-Kwarteng Government in
September 2022, leading to a significant
and rapid increase in interest rates, causing
a temporary collapse in housing sales.
Confidence gradually returned with the
establishment of a more stable Government
and the subsequent easing of mortgage
rates, resulting in more steady sales rates by
late winter and early spring 2023.
Great homes,
strong
foundations
Peter Truscott
Chief Executive
Crest Nicholson 6 Annual Report andnancial statements 2023
Nevertheless, the market faced additional
challenges, including a rise in interest rates
due to persistently high inflation, renewing
concerns of declining house prices. The Bank
of England continued to raise interest rates to
control these inflationary pressures.
While there was initially an expectation of
significant price reductions, prices remained
stable, followed by modest declines through
autumn. Factors such as high mortgage
rates, buyer concerns regarding potential
future decreases in house prices, and the
customary summer slowdown contributed
to a period of very low sales rates. As overall
economic conditions stabilised, sales rates
slowly improved.
Multi Channel Approach
One of our strategic priorities is the
Multi Channel Approach. This approach
serves as a counter-cyclical element
during volatile trading environments,
oering increased visibility of revenue
in the business. This provides the Group
with resilience and a diversified income
stream. Leveraging our highly experienced
Partnerships and Strategic Land (PSL)
division, over the past few years, we have
cultivated strategic relationships with
institutions and Registered Providers
(RPs). Consequently, we have successfully
negotiated and delivered 273 units
for FY23, as well as further units for
future developments.
Build programme
We diligently manage our build programme
and work-in-progress. However, due to
supply chain issues in the second half of
FY22, we commenced the new financial year
with a lower build position than originally
planned. Despite the challenging sales
environment, we seized the opportunity
to maintain our planned production output
during the first half of the financial year as
more labour and materials became available.
This enabled us to restore a normalised build
activity by the end of FY23.
Build cost inflation remained elevated in
the first half of our financial year. This was
due to high energy costs and competitors
finishing homes for their financial year-ends.
A positive outlook for housebuilding in the
spring created additional pressure on building
supplies. The lagged eect of the dramatic
increase in energy costs from the previous
year continued to abate, and with labour costs
moderating, build cost inflation in the second
half of the financial year started to reduce to
mid-single digit percentages. We anticipate
this trend will continue into FY24.
Farnham and other legacy sites
As announced in our November trading
statement Brightwells Yard, Farnham
recorded c.£11m incremental build costs
in the year. The Group has subsequently
conducted a comprehensive review of
the costs to complete this project as well
as our other legacy and low margin sites.
Consequently, further additional costs of
£5.5m have been identified, including £2.5m
at Farnham, which have impacted FY23
adjusted profit before tax (APBT). The Group
has commenced a thorough plan to improve
commercial processes and controls to
mitigate the risk of future cost overruns.
Construction at the Farnham scheme is now
in its final stages.
Land and planning
The supply of land continued to tighten due
to the Government’s decision to eliminate
top-down housing targets, resulting in delays
to new site allocations. This situation is
compounded by broader issues within the
planning system, including challenges related
to nutrients, water neutrality, recreational
impact zones and air quality constraints.
Additionally, there is an under-resourced and
inecient development control function at
the local authority level.
Against this challenging backdrop, and in
the aftermath of a period of acute economic
uncertainty, many of our housebuilding
peers signalled their intention to reduce
land activity and withdraw from some land
deals. In contrast, we took the opportunity
to acquire several highly desirable sites in
attractive locations, thereby strengthening
our land portfolio and securing favourable
economic terms. Our decision to remain
active in the land market positions us to
mitigate planning delays, ensuring a higher
number of outlets are in place when market
conditions improve. Our land acquisition
programme will remain at a reduced level
during FY24.
Accordingly, the Group’s year end cash
position reduced to £64.9m from £276.5m in
the prior year, reflecting both this investment
and work-in-progress, as referred to earlier.
Streamlining Group operations
In response to the deterioration of trading
conditions experienced in the second half
of the year, we have conducted a thorough
and diligent review of all activities within
the Group to reduce overheads. It is never
easy for employees during dicult trading
conditions, and I would like to thank my
colleagues for their dedication and hard work
during these times.
Reduced pace of geographical
expansion
In October 2021 we outlined a growth plan
for our business involving geographical
expansion, with the aim of increasing the
number of our housebuilding divisions.
However, this plan was devised in a
stable, normalised trading environment.
Since then, the housebuilding industry has
encountered acute economic challenges
and a deteriorating trading environment.
As responsible management, it is necessary
to review our business plan to align with
prevailing market conditions.
Yorkshire will remain unaected given it
is now a fully operational, and will now
be expected to grow at a reduced pace,
targeting 300 to 350 units per annum by
FY26, instead of 500 units. East Anglia
is now covered by our existing Eastern
division and the geographical boundaries
have been revised. The Eastern division is
based at Brentwood in Essex and we will
retain East Anglia’s satellite oce in Bury St
Edmunds. As previously announced, we have
postponed the opening of the additional
new division.
The revised footprint allows for wider overall
coverage and enhanced volumes and reflects
the dicult market conditions in the short
term and the constrained land and planning
environment in the medium term.
Costs and overheads
The Group has taken proactive steps to
reduce the cost base at the end of FY23
with the revised growth plan as outlined
previously and will continue to seek ways to
operate more productively. As announced
in our November 2023 Trading Statement,
we have reduced overheads to align with
worsening market conditions and aim to
reduce annualised administrative expenses
by circa. £3m in FY24. Consequently, a
restructuring charge of £0.5m has been
included in our FY23 results.
There continues to be a significant imbalance in the
supply and demand of housing in the UK, and this
undersupply is particularly acute in Southern England,
where Crest Nicholson principally operates.
Crest Nicholson 7 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Combustible materials
On 13 March 2023 the Group entered into the
UK Government’s Developer Remediation
Contract. This incorporated into contractual
arrangements the commitments made by
the Group under the Building Safety Pledge,
signed in April 2022. This agreement
regulates a method of building remediation
going forward and sets out the basis of the
timing and phasing of the recovery of funds
expended by the Building Safety Fund.
It also positively set out a more balanced
and consistent method in assessing
building remediations.
During the year we continued to focus on the
remediation of aected buildings, building
risk assessments, scoping and design.
We have received some recoveries from
subcontractors and suppliers which has
mitigated the impact and our overall fire
safety provision remains broadly unchanged
despite the high build cost inflation we
have experienced.
Customer experience
In 2022 our customer service standards
fell below the level to which we aspire and
understandably, our customers reflected this
in lower NHBC Customer Satisfaction Survey
ratings. Following significant investment in
FY23, in people, processes and systems,
there are encouraging signs that quality and
customer service standards are improving,
and for legal completions from February
2023, in excess of 90% of customers have
said they would recommend Crest Nicholson
to a friend. Sustaining this level and building
on the ongoing eorts to enhance customer
experience, positions us well to regain our
HBF five-star status in 2025.
Sustainability progress
Our sustainability strategy is split into three
priority areas – protect the environment,
make a positive impact on our communities
and operate the business responsibly.
These three priority areas guide our
commitment to drive positive action across
our activities and value chain.
We made positive progress against our
sustainability targets in FY23, including a
reduction in our greenhouse gas emissions.
We also became a Living Wage Employer and
we continued to collaborate with our supply
chain and industry peers on sustainability
initiatives and to prepare for future
regulatory changes.
Current trading
We entered FY24 with a forward position
at 19 January 2024 of 1,732 units at £434.9m
GDV, reflecting the current challenging
environment. We expect trading conditions
will improve towards the second half of 2024
with a strong pipeline of private rented sector
and RPs.
Summary
The last financial year has been amongst
the most challenging for the Group
since the Global Financial Crisis in 2008.
Against a backdrop of a dicult market, with
significantly reduced housing sales activity
and modest low single digit price falls, our
focus and priorities for the future are centred
on supporting our growth strategy. This will
preserve and maintain a robust balance sheet
and continue to control our overheads and
administrative costs eectively.
With a highly attractive asset base,
experienced management and a
strong balance sheet we remain
confident in our future growth
prospects.
During FY23 we increased investment in
work-in-progress and strategically acquired
high quality land to strengthen our land
portfolio, supported by our balance sheet.
This strategic move positions the Group to
capitalise on growth when the market returns
to a more normalised level. There continues
to be a significant imbalance in the supply
and demand of housing in the UK, and this
undersupply is particularly acute in Southern
England, where Crest Nicholson principally
operates. With a highly attractive asset base,
experienced management and a strong
balance sheet we remain confident in our
future growth prospects.
Outlook
We expect the housing market will remain
challenging in 2024 with elevated interest
rates remaining in place until inflation falls
to its target level. In addition, the absence
of any Government support for first time
buyers, coupled with higher borrowing costs
continues to impact aordability.
However, there are reasons to be optimistic
with year-on-year inflation now halved
and real wage growth starting to be felt in
households across the UK. We have acquired
some excellent sites that are at advanced
stages in the planning process, leaving us
well positioned to trade in whatever market
conditions emerge.
Peter Truscott
Chief Executive
Brightwells Yard, Farnham, Surrey
Chief Executives statement continued
Crest Nicholson 8 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Manor View, Milton Keynes,
Buckinghamshire
Enhancing our product
The external materials and elevations of
our Legacy Collection can be designed to
match the local vernacular. Additionally, our
development layouts are designed to have
impact, creating places that our customers
are immediately drawn to.
The homes oer an attractive, competitive
product and are more energy ecient
than the previous 2020 Housing Portfolio.
Enhancements include improved insulation,
the introduction of solar photovoltaic panels
and waste water heat recovery systems.
More ecient ventilation fans continuously
extracting moist air from the property will result
in improved heat retention within the home.
Our house types are designed to complement
each other, creating street scenes that fit
together maintaining the same depth, without
eecting their kerb appeal. This limits the
potential of heat loss form junctions, and
coupled with improved air tightness in excess
of building regulations, further enhances the
building’s ability to retain heat.
We have maximised the eciency of space,
creating opportunities for additional double
bedrooms. We feature utility rooms and
studies in many of our four bedroom homes.
Our kitchens provide flexibility and room for
both dining and family space, which delivers
on customer aspirations for this key area of
the home.
We are proud of the product we deliver to
our customers and have a continued focus
on the future development of this range.
We develop high quality, attractive, thriving communities.
We aim to create developments that our customers are
proud to live in.
Our Legacy Collection provides the Group with the tools
to do this in a consistent and eective manner. The Legacy
Collection comprises a core range of house types and
provides our people with a toolkit of standardised product
with variations and adaptations alongside a range of
aordable house types.
Case study
The
Legacy
Collection
Lancaster Park, West Malling, Kent
I am extremely pleased
to have worked on the
development of our Legacy
Collection, creating a
product that our people are
proud of and homes that
truly benefit our customers.
Our 360 degree feedback
model allows continuous
improvement in an ever
changing landscape,
enabling us to adapt to our
customers’ needs while
retaining our focus on
eciency and buildability.
Graham Gribbin
Group Technical Director
Crest Nicholson 9 Annual Report andnancial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Our strategy
Our strategy is embedded throughout our
operations delivering eciency and providing
strong financial performance. Our goal is to deliver
sustainable growth for our stakeholders.
Operational Eciency
Operational eciency is of paramount importance to our
success and competitiveness, especially in a challenging
economic environment. We focus on all aspects of our
operational process to utilise our resources in the most
ecient way possible, minimise waste and reduce our
environmental footprint.
Progress in FY23
Implemented and integrated a new Enterprise
Resource Planning (ERP) system to improve
plot eciency and management oversight on
build progress
Streamlined operations to align with current
market conditions.
Future focus
Maintain strong oversight on incremental overheads
Continue to remain agile and responsive to changing
market conditions and regulatory requirements.
Land Portfolio
Our land portfolio is primarily located in Southern
England where land supply is limited in desirable
locations where customer demands are high.
Our short-term land portfolio is approximately
five-years’ worth of supply which is appropriate for
our needs.
Progress in FY23
Acquired several high quality sites which will
support future outlet growth
Acquired land at or above hurdle rate
incorporating current sales and build costs.
Future focus
Land acquisition will be reduced in FY24 as we
have sucient land in our portfolio
Maintain discipline in retaining our land acquisition
hurdle rate.
Placemaking & Quality
We are renowned for our placemaking capabilities and we aim to create
aspirational developments that have a positive impact on our customers,
communities and the environment.
Progress in FY23
Maintained our focus on investing
in desirable locations, acquiring
quality sites including in Windsor
and Oxford
Adapted our homes in response to
the interim update to Part L of the
Building Regulations.
Future focus
Incorporate biodiversity net
gain on new sites submitted for
planning from FY24
Continue to prepare for the full
implementation of the Future
Homes Standard. See page 23.
Kilnwood Vale, Horsham, West Sussex
Fernhurst, Camberley, Surrey
Crest Nicholson 10 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Five-Star Customer Service
We have a ‘right first time’ culture. We are committed to delivering high quality
homes and an excellent customer experience is at the heart of everything
we do.
Progress in FY23
Processes have been aligned
to the New Homes Quality
Code and relevant training and
controls implemented
Introduced a customer service
recovery plan to regain five-star
customer service rating
Customer Relations Manager in
place in each housing division
Strengthened handover and follow
up processes enhancing our
customer support
Introduced standardised
upgrade options.
Future focus
Develop an integrated approach
from first enquiry to after sales
Enhance customer portal, for
example home demonstration
videos on the layout of houses and
self-serve information.
Multi Channel
Approach
Our PSL division sources land, develops partnerships
and manages strategic land. Their Strategic Land
team promotes and manages strategic land to
incorporate it into our short-term land portfolio.
Additionally, the division focuses on building
strategic relationships within PRS and RPs.
Progress in FY23
273 units were delivered in the year to PRS
and RPs
Secured good sales pipeline for
future developments.
Future focus
Develop Co-Purchase and Rent to Own models
with external institutions to enhance sales
Commence sales under the Smart Own scheme.
Strategy for growth – geographical expansion
In October 2021 we outlined a growth plan for the
Group involving geographical expansion, with the
aim of increasing the number of our housebuilding
divisions. This plan was devised in a stable, normalised
trading environment. We opened Yorkshire division in
FY22 and East Anglia in HY23.
During the second half of FY23 the Group streamlined
its operations to align with current market conditions.
East Anglia is now covered by the existing Eastern
division and some of the geographical boundaries have
been revised, with Kent moving to the South division.
Yorkshire is fully operational and is expected to grow at
a revised pace.
Our Foundations
Our Strategic Priorities are underpinned by
our Foundations:
Safety, Health & Environment
See page 27
Financial Targets
See pages 32 to 34
Sustainability & Social Value
See pages 20 to 26
People
See pages 28 to 29
We knew we wanted to buy a new build
Crest Nicholson home again for many reasons.
Ultimately, we enjoy having a modern property
with high quality appliances and having access to
the benefits of purchasing from Crest Nicholson,
including an energy ecient home, a fantastic
sales team and schemes that made our move
so much easier.
Nicola and Jon Gigg
Crest Nicholson customers
Nicola and Jon Gigg, Waterman’s Gate, Arborfield, Berkshire
Crest Nicholson 11 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Market overview
Housing is a cyclical industry and sensitive to market
sentiment and the macro-economic environment. With our
experienced team the Group will navigate through these
challenging trading conditions and position the Group to
capture growth when the market improves.
Structural imbalance
Demand outweighs the supply of housing.
The medium to long-term fundamentals of
the housing market remain strong. This is
based on data on UK population growth
which is projected to increase by 3.2% in
the next 10 years to 67.1m in mid-2020 and
to 69.2m in mid-2030. The undersupply
is also evidenced by the high growth of
property prices to income ratio as well as
rising rental rates. New housing supply
is currently lower than the Government’s
ambition of 300,000 new homes per year.
Around 237,000 new homes were built in
2022/23, 21% less than the target.
Housing supply and demand imbalances
vary greatly across dierent regions of the
UK. London and the South East have the
most acute shortages and this results in
people being concentrated in areas with
high demand, which further intensifies the
pressure on housing supply.
Our response
We are predominantly based in Southern
England and have an attractive land
portfolio of approximately five years in
desirable locations to support future
outlet growth and demand. See page 3
We build attractive communities
in locations with good transport
and infrastructure.
Link to Strategic Priorities
and Foundations
Placemaking & Quality
Land Portfolio
Five-Star Customer Service
2
Sustainability & Social Value
UK economy
The UK economy continues to be impacted
by a variety of macro-economic and political
factors. According to the National Institute
of Economic and Social Research, GDP is
projected to grow by 0.3% in 2024, with
the outlook remaining highly uncertain.
Latest GDP figures released in December
2023 by the ONS stated the economy
contracted by 0.5%. Stubborn inflationary
pressures are being exacerbated by limited
labour availability and resulting labour
cost inflation.
Consumer confidence plays a crucial
role in the housing market and can
significantly influence the dynamics of
buying and selling homes, house prices
and the overall health in the economy.
While the housing market is cyclical by
nature, the current surging mortgage and
rental rates, a slowing jobs market and the
uncertainties posed by conflict in the Middle
East, have all contributed to a decline in
consumer confidence.
After improvements in the previous couple of
months, the latest GfK Consumer Confidence
Index released in October 2023 fell by nine
points, which underlines the economy is still
exerting acute pressure for many consumers
and that confidence remains low.
Our response
Continue to preserve our financial position
Operational review to align the Group with
the current environment
Adjust the pace of planned growth in our
new and existing divisions.
Link to Strategic Priorities
and Foundations
Multi Channel Approach
Land and planning
Land is the key component for a
housebuilder so the availability of
land suitable for development and the
eectiveness of the planning system have
a major eect on the medium to long-term
development of the industry and the supply
of homes.
The planning environment continues to
be challenging with delays to new site
allocations in 2023 and beyond with
resource pressures impacting the supply
of land for housing. Uncertainty on the
application of nutrient neutrality guidelines
has had further negative impacts on the
housebuilding industry and poses significant
challenges to planning applications for both
local authorities and developers. This causes
delays and tightens the supply of land
for development.
In August 2023 the Government announced
that it would amend the Habitats Regulations
which underpin nutrient neutrality through
the Levelling-up and Regeneration Act 2023.
The proposed amendments were rejected
by the House of Lords in September 2023.
Overall the long-term backdrop is uncertain
for planning and is likely to reduce land
supply in the medium term.
Our response
We have a short-term land portfolio
of approximately five years which is
appropriate for our size
We acquired several high quality sites
in FY23 which will mitigate the planning
delays and support future outlet growth
Quality strategic land portfolio which we
can utilise at a higher gross margin.
Link to Strategic Priorities
and Foundations
Land Portfolio
2
Sustainability & Social Value
Crest Nicholson 12 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
The biggest direct influence on the housing
market are interest rates. A significant series
of interest rate hikes since December 2021
have had a profound impact on the UK
mortgage market and the aordability of
borrowers. Mortgage approvals decreased
by 35.1% in September 2023 compared to
prior year. This has led to a slowdown in the
housing market with transactions year-on-year
decreased by 13.4%.
Based on Bank of England data, mortgage
borrowing costs for new mortgages declined
for more than 12 years to a low of 1.51% in
November 2021. During the last two years
there has been a sharp reversal, with the
average cost of new mortgages tripling
(September 2023: 5.01%). Mortgage rates have
since stabilised and a five-year fixed rate with
a 75% LTV is approximately 4.4%.
Housing aordability is challenging across
the UK housing market. The UK new build
house price to earnings ratio in 2022 was at
eight times, below its peak in 2021 at above 10
times, when sales price inflation was high due
to pent-up demand after the pandemic.
Our response
Adjusted the pace of our build
programmes and land acquisitions to
reflect tougher market conditions
Launched the new Smart Own shared
ownership scheme in conjunction with
Legal & General Aordable Homes
Introduced new sales products such as
Smart Own and Family Cashback.
Link to Strategic Priorities
and Foundations
Land Portfolio
Five-Star Customer Service
Multi Channel Approach
Environmental regulations
The housebuilding industry faces several
forthcoming regulatory changes including
the Future Homes Standard and biodiversity
net gain.
The Future Homes Standard, set to be
enforced from 2025 presents a substantial
challenge, mandating a minimum 75%
reduction in carbon emissions compared to
the 2013 Building Regulations. We continue
to actively collaborate with our energy
assessors, supply chain and industry
partners so that we are well prepared to
meet the requirements.
Biodiversity net gain, which is expected to
come into force in early 2024, will require all
new developments submitted for planning to
deliver a biodiversity net gain of at least 10%
compared to a pre-development baseline.
Our response
Evolving our house types and
collaborating with our energy assessors,
suppliers and wider industry to prepare for
the Future Homes Standard
Reducing greenhouse gas emissions in
line with our science-based targets
Engaging with ecologists and landscape
architects early in the planning process to
deliver biodiversity net gain.
Link to Strategic Priorities
and Foundations
Placemaking & Quality
Operational Eciency
2
Sustainability & Social Value
Wycke Place, Maldon, Essex
Mortgage market and housing aordability
Link to Strategic Priorities
Placemaking & Quality
Land Portfolio
Operational Eciency
Five-Star Customer Service
Multi Channel Approach
Link to Foundations
1
Safety, Health & Environment
2
Sustainability & Social Value
3
People
4
Financial Targets
Average UK mortgage rate 2010 – 2023 (%)
0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
Q1 Q3
2010
Q1 Q3
2011
Q1 Q3
2012
Q1 Q3
2013
Q1 Q3
2014
Q1 Q3
2015
Q1 Q3
2016
Q1 Q3
2017
Q1 Q3
2018
Q1 Q3
2019
Q1 Q3
2020
Q1 Q3
2021
Q1 Q3
2022
Q1 Q3
2023
Crest Nicholson 13 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Focused
divisional
businesses
Regional housebuilding operations
with local expertise and relationships,
enabling eective and ecient delivery
ofnew homes
A dedicated PSL division developing
multiple channels to market and promoting
strategic land.
Design, planning
and placemaking
Energy ecient house type range with
interior andexterior flexibility, to cater to a
range of customers and adaptable to local
design policies
Placemaking expertise to create a strong
legacy of vibrant communities with a
mixture ofhomes and tenures.
Land
Operational eciency programme and
reputation for placemaking supports
landacquisition at appropriate margins
Strategic land capability allows us
topromote sites through to approval
andearnsuperior returns
Partnerships developed with land owners
and local authorities to secure planning
permission in a timely manner.
Construction
Championing best practice in build, choice
of materials and waste management, with
cross-team functional forums embedding
and sharing best practice including safety,
quality and energy eciency.
Selling our homes
Highly trained, passionate sales executives
delivering high quality service, supported
by focused marketing channels to reach
customers in the most targeted way
Our PSL division bring forward a range of
ownership tenures including aordable,
shared ownership and PRS.
Quality and
customer
experience
Aiming to provide the best customer
experience throughout the home-buying
process, with a ‘right first time’ approach
to the quality of homes, sales support
andafter care.
Business model
Our business model is centred on our purpose
to buildgreat places for our customers,
communities andthe environment. Guided by
our strategy, wecarefully select resources and
partners to create value for all stakeholders
bybuilding qualityhomesindesirable locations.
People
Experienced, dedicated
anddiverse workforce
Robust Safety, Health &
Environment processes to keep
everyone safe.
Natural and
manufactured
resources
High quality building materials
Commitment to reducing waste
and carbonemissions throughout
ourvalue chain.
Partnerships
Carefully selected business
partners and projects
Close relationships with regulatory
andindustry bodies to help shape
thefuture of housing
Relationships with landowners
and engagement throughout the
development process.
Customers
Commitment to delivering
five-star customer experience
Focus on customers’ needs
to ensurefirstclass service is
provided atevery stage of the
buying process.
Design and
innovation
Attractive and flexible design
of our Legacy Collection
house type range to improve
qualityandoperational eciency
Investment in innovative sales
andmarketing tools
Modern technology to support
safety,quality and service.
Financial
resources
Supportive shareholders
Diverse capital structure and
aprudentapproach to risk.
Our resources
and relationships
What we do
Crest Nicholson 14 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Our investment case
Our investment case emphasises our ability to weather economic uncertainties while continuing
to deliver value to investors and stakeholders, focusing on adaptability, resilience and long-term
sustainability of the business model.
1
Resilient fundamentals for the UK housing market
Despite economic challenges, the UK housing market
benefits from a growing population and a persistently
limited housing supply
The complex planning system, while challenging, favours
experienced housebuilders with a broad range of
capabilities and deep knowledge of the local market
The lending environment remains functional and the
supply of mortgages remains stable and available, albeit at
a higher interest rate.
4
Diversified income streams to counter cyclicality
The Multi Channel Approach oers resilience by
diversifying income sources and capital streams to
withstand market fluctuations
In the face of challenges, the PRS provides dependable
yields and stability within our diversified income streams
The dedicated PSL division maintains strong relationships
with Registered Providers and PRS partners, providing
additional stability in uncertain market conditions.
2
Adaptive land portfolio
We maintain a high quality land portfolio, primarily
concentrated in Southern England, with new
developments strategically added in regions that are well
placed to capture growth when the market improves
Our extensive strategic land portfolio, primarily held under
option, represents an ecient use of capital, allowing for
flexibility in land development decisions
Our financial position with a five-year land bank enables
the Group to stay selective in acquiring land in a
tightened market.
5
Commitment to sustainability
We remain committed to our sustainability goals, including
reaching net-zero emissions by 2045
In a challenging market, the emphasis on reducing
greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions, waste and natural resource
consumption remains crucial to both cost eciency and
environmental responsibility
We make a positive impact in our communities, providing
attractive, high quality new homes and investing in
infrastructure that delivers lasting benefits to the
local area.
3
Brand synonymous to quality and placemaking
Established brand name with strong heritage associated
with quality and customer experience
Reputation for placemaking and creating attractive,
vibrant communities can be leveraged to navigate
market challenges
The Group can extend its reputation and oer more
customers the chance to own a home across a wider range
of regions in the UK.
6
Robust balance sheet and margin recovery plan
Our balance sheet, with a year end net cash position
of £64.9m and a £250m revolving credit facility (RCF),
provides financial stability
We maintain a disciplined and selective approach to land
acquisition and capital allocation
The sustainable dividend cover of two and a half times is
evidence of a well considered financial strategy that can
withstand adverse economic conditions.
and for society
We are committed to creating a positive
legacy and long-term value for society by
building quality homes in desirable locations.
The value we create
for our stakeholders
Investors
Compelling investment proposition
settingouthow we realise value
from ourhigh quality portfolio
of assets.
Customers
Five-star customer experience
withquality products in
desirable locations.
Our people
Investing in people to develop the
skillsthatwe need and enhancing
our reputation as an employer
of choice.
Suppliers
Being a long-term and
trusted partner tosuppliers
and subcontractors.
Communities
and the
environment
Creating a positive environmental
and social legacy through strong
community relationships and
investment in social infrastructure.
Government
and other bodies
Regular engagement with
Government to understand its
priorities and to shareour expertise
to support eective regulation.
See pages 20 to 26
Crest Nicholson 15 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Section 172 statement
We work hard to understand and meet the
needs of our dierent stakeholder groups,
engaging with them, adapting our service
and creating value for them.
The Board acknowledges that we may
have to take decisions that aect one
or more stakeholder groups negatively.
In challenging markets it is even more
important to reflect upon the need to
act fairly and with integrity. The Section
172 statement, contained within the
Companies Act 2006 (Act), provides the
Board with the foundations for its decision-
making processes.
The Company should act in good faith
in order to promote the success of the
Company for the benefit of its members
as a whole and in doing so, have regard
(amongst other matters) to:
The likely consequences of any decision
in the long term
The interests of the Company’s employees
The need to foster the Company’s
business relationships with suppliers,
customers and others
The impact of the Company’s operations
on the community and the environment
The desirability of the Company
maintaining a reputation for high
standards of business conduct
The need to act fairly as between
members of the Company.
How we consider stakeholders
We have a comprehensive programme of
stakeholder engagement and feedback
mechanisms to support us in making
balanced decisions.
How our Board engaged
Board site visits
The Board visited two sites in the
Midlands and South, where they
met the divisional boards, sales
and site teams
Employee Voice meetings
Louise Hardy, our Non-
Executive Director responsible
for employee engagement,
facilitated our Employee Voice
meetings and met a cross-
section of our employees
Stakeholder relations
Engagement is essential for our growth and
for delivering long-term positive outcomes
to our stakeholders.
Stakeholder engagement and decision making
Annual
strategy and
budget review
Board
Committees
with key
focus areas
A SHE Committee
and Sustainability
Committee providing
updates to the Board
Board oversight
of the Group’s
purpose, values
and culture and
alignment with
our strategy
External feedback
on market perception
and shareholder
engagement
Regular updates from
senior management
Risk review
Board decision making
The following pages comprise our Section 172 statement, setting out how the Board has, in
performing its duties over the course of FY23, with regard to the matters set out in Section
172(1) (a) to (f) of the Act, alongside examples of how each of our key stakeholders have been
considered and engaged. Further information can also be found throughout the Strategic
Report and in the Governance Report.
Crest Nicholson 16 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
What matters
to them
How we
have engaged
Key outcomes
Link to KPIs
Our employees require a safe and healthy working
environment which is complemented by a supportive,
diverse and inclusive culture. Our employees value
challenging and rewarding work that is enhanced by
professional development and career opportunities.
Our people
Board engagement
The Board received updates on employee matters at
each of its meetings and regularly discussed employee
turnover, engagement, succession planning, appraisals,
training and development
The Chief Executive attended employee forums
and divisional roadshows to provide strategic and
trading updates
The Board encouraged management to engage an
external consultant to assess the Group’s culture, and
was kept informed of both the process and output of
this review.
Group engagement
The Group’s Anity Groups responded to diversity and
inclusion matters
Focused regular engagement with charity partners,
including the Group-wide charity challenge
Health and wellbeing training and the ability for
employees to enhance their mental health fitness
through online resources
The Sharesave scheme enables employees to save and
purchase shares in the Group
Operated formal talent development
training programmes.
Increased involvement in the FY23 Sharesave scheme
with 41% participation
Six Employee Voice meetings were held during the
year which took place across all the divisions
22% of employees received formal training or were in
trainee positions in FY23
Achieved Gold accredited membership of The 5% Club
The average number of training days per employee in
FY23 was 4.75 days
There were 61 internal promotions in FY23.
Individuals who are directly
employed by us.
Voluntary employee turnover
Annual Injury Incidence Rate (AIIR)
Our investors have a strong and eective relationship
with the Board and senior management. We understand
that our ability to navigate the current market challenges,
while maintaining sustainable returns, is important for
our investors.
Investors
Board engagement
The Chief Executive, Group Finance Director and Head
of Investor Relations met regularly with investors and
analysts to convey an understanding of the housing
market, the Group’s strategy and its operations
The Chairman and the Senior Independent Director
held an annual governance roadshow
Consulted with investors on the Directors’
Remuneration Policy which was proposed for a
shareholder vote at the 2023 AGM
All Directors attended the AGM and were available to
answer shareholder questions.
Group engagement
Discussions were held during the year with investors
and analysts on the Group’s operational review and
streamlining our operations to align with the current
market conditions
Meetings were held to provide insight on our response
to the impacts of climate change and progress against
our sustainability targets.
The Chief Executive and Group Finance Director
attended 62 investor meetings during FY23,
representing over half the issued share capital
We remain a constituent of the FTSE4Good Index
Series and achieved a B rating in the CDP climate
change disclosure
The Directors’ Remuneration Policy received
shareholder support with 94% votes in favour.
Both individual and
institutional investors.
Return on capital
employed (ROCE)
Earnings before interest
and tax (EBIT) margin
Net cash
Unit completions
Land creditors as a
% of net assets
GHG emissions intensity
Waste intensity
Crest Nicholson 17 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
What matters
to them
How we
have engaged
Key outcomes
Link to KPIs
Our customers expect quality homes in beautiful places
that are safe, delivered on time and which oer good
value for money. Customer engagement enables us to
understand our customers’ needs and how we respond.
Board engagement
The Board considered initiatives undertaken
by the Group to deliver high levels of customer
experience, enhance placemaking and create
sustainable developments
The National Housebuilding Council (NHBC)
customer satisfaction survey scores were considered
at each Board meeting and the approach for
improving performance
Regular updates to the Board on relationships with
our partners
The Board approved the Group joining the Department
for Levelling Up, Housing and Communities (DLUHC)
Responsible Actors Scheme which was launched in
July 2023
Reviewed the sales strategy to enhance the
sales process
Received regular updates on the Group’s progress
supporting those living in buildings impacted by the
Developer Remediation Contract.
Group engagement
Divisional marketing events were held for customers
to provide information on our homes, the local area
and development
The Group allocated additional resources to support
delivery of improving customer experience
The divisional boards reviewed and monitored
customer service feedback and satisfaction
All employees received training on the New Homes
Quality Code (NHQC).
Customer experience plan implemented to restore the
Group’s five-star satisfaction score
Additional customer service roles were created
to enhance the relationship between site teams
and customers
Processes were put in place for build teams to support
customers throughout their purchasing journey.
Customers
Unit completions
GHG emissions intensity
Customer satisfaction
PRS/Aordable unit completions
It is important to our suppliers and subcontractors
that projects are delivered safely and on time.
Mutually beneficial working relationships that share
risk and reward alongside operational eciency are
important for eective relationships. Suppliers expect us
to preserve our financial position and to pay them within
agreed timescales.
The people and organisations who
purchase our homes. These can be
private individuals or larger institutions
that we work in partnership with.
Board engagement
The Board regularly discussed the Group’s
responsibility to its suppliers and subcontractors
and its impact on the local housebuilding and
construction industry
Regular updates were provided to the Board on the
Group’s supply chain, including payment practices,
material costs and availability, and the prevention of
modern slavery
The Board received regular updates on the
supply chain, including quality and safety
performance statistics.
Group engagement
Maintained relationships with key suppliers with a
particular focus on safety, costs and sustainability
Feedback on supplier performance was considered at
divisional board meetings
Expected commitment to our Supply Chain Code
of Conduct including anti-slavery and human
tracking policies
Launched the ‘Crest Nicholson Introduction to
Sustainability’ learning pathway with the Supply Chain
Sustainability School which was issued to all suppliers
Became an accredited Living Wage Employer
Partnered with the Supply Chain Sustainability School
and industry peers to lead a packaging optimisation
project with major suppliers
Engaged with suppliers on their GHG emissions data to
support our whole life carbon analysis.
56% of Group suppliers actively engage with the
Supply Chain Sustainability School
35% of suppliers have completed the sustainability
learning pathway since it was launched in early
October 2023
Engaged with subcontractors on their compliance with
paying the real Living Wage
36 days was the average time taken to pay suppliers.
Suppliers
Net cash
Unit completions
GHG emissions intensity
Waste intensity
AIIR
The suppliers that provide the
materials for our homes and the
skilledsubcontractors for our
construction activities.
Stakeholder relations continued
Crest Nicholson 18 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
What matters
to them
How we
have engaged
Key outcomes
Link to KPIs
Our neighbours in the local communities want engaged
two-way communication with us. We seek to provide
well-designed quality homes with character that are
competitively priced for local residents. Investment in
infrastructure including transport, school and health
facilities is important. We also seek to protect the local
environment, reduce emissions and waste and help
support sustainable lifestyles.
Board engagement
The Board considered sustainability and environmental
impacts in relation to the development of sites
Reviewed product development changes for
the mandatory compliance with the Future
Homes Standard
Considered the energy and water eciency of
household appliances in our homes
Monitored the Group’s overall sustainability
performance in line with published targets.
Group engagement
Regularly engaged with the local community, planning
authorities and environmental regulators, which
enabled us to respond to concerns and incorporate
feedback into the development process
Regularly reviewed sustainability performance and
implemented action to reduce GHG emissions
Launched a new charity partnership with Young
Lives vs Cancer and continued to donate and provide
support to local charities and organisations.
Delivering attractive developments that are valued by
our customers and communities
55% reduction in scope 1 and 2 emissions compared
to FY19, the baseline year against which emission
reductions are measured
Agreed to set a minimum B EPC rating for standard
house types
Recipient of the Silver Award for the Armed Forces
Covenant Employer Recognition Scheme.
Communities
and environment
Unit completions
GHG emissions intensity
Waste intensity
PRS/Aordable unit completions
The communities and environment
local to our developments.
The Government expects proactive engagement from
us and solutions to meet the requirements of the Future
Homes Standard and industry initiatives that support
biodiversity and climate change matters.
Government
and other bodies
Board engagement
Regular active dialogue and debate was held by the
Board on industry developments, including the Future
Homes Standard, NHQC, market trends and the
planning environment
The Chief Executive participated in regulatory and
industry bodies that shape the legislative environment
and local planning departments
The Chief Executive met with Ministers from the
DLUHC and the Department of Housing
Ongoing discussion on the mandatory compliance with
the Future Homes Standard in 2025.
Group engagement
Divisional attendance at HBF and NHBC events
Divisional attendance at local planning meetings
and engagement with Homes England and
Housing Associations
Active participants in the Future Homes Hub to
support the transition to net-zero and nature-
positive developments
Regular engagement with local authorities, the
Environment Agency and local water authorities.
Engagement with Government enables us to
understand their priorities for housing
Progress with our partners across a multitude of our
strategic land projects
Implemented the NHQC across the Group
Regular dialogue with Government and industry to
address the global challenges of climate change and
biodiversity loss.
The Government, regulatory and
industry bodies shape the legislative
environment in which we operate and
local planning departments.
Unit completions
GHG emissions intensity
Waste intensity
PRS/Aordable unit completions
Crest Nicholson 19 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Sustainability review
Sustainability is embedded across
all aspects of our business, enabling
us to make a positive societal impact
andgenerate long-lasting value
for our stakeholders.
Our approach
Sustainability is one of our four strategic
foundations. It remains at the core of our
Group’s purpose to build great places
for our customers, communities and
the environment.
Our sustainability strategy is built around
three overarching priorities, encompassing
the multi-faceted nature of sustainability:
Protect the environment
We are committed to reducing our climate
impact, preserving biodiversity, minimising
waste and conserving natural resources.
Make a positive impact on
our communities
We actively seek opportunities to make
a positive impact on the communities in
which we operate. This includes providing
attractive, high quality new homes and
investing in infrastructure that delivers
lasting benefits to communities.
Operate responsibly
We operate our business with integrity
by upholding high ethical standards.
We champion our people and prioritise the
health, safety and welfare of everyone who
comes into contact with our operations.
Recognising the ever-evolving landscape
of environmental and social challenges, we
are committed to regularly engaging with
our stakeholders. This dialogue allows us to
continually review and respond to concerns,
helping us address material issues and
anticipate potential sustainability-related
risks and opportunities. For more details
on what matters most to our stakeholders
and our engagement with them, see pages
16 to 19.
We continue to monitor emerging
regulations and reporting requirements,
including the disclosure standards
established by the International
Sustainability Standards Board and the
Taskforce on Nature-related Financial
Disclosures’ recommendations.
Our proactive approach enables us to align
with future compliance requirements.
To support our strategy, we link sustainability
targets to our remuneration packages
(see pages 82 to 83). Our Revolving Credit
Facility (RCF) is linked to four sustainability
targets detailed below. See page 147 for our
performance against the targets.
Reduce absolute scope 1 and 2 GHG
emissions in line with our science-
based targets
Increase supplier engagement with the
Supply Chain Sustainability School
Increase the proportion of homes with an
Environmental Impact rating of A and B
Increase the proportion of
employees in trainee positions or on
training programmes.
Read more on how our sustainability
strategy aligns with the UN’s Sustainable
Development Goals (SDGs).
Our ESG Data Handbook provides
further information on our sustainability
performance, including our response to the
Sustainability Accounting Standards Board
(SASB) Home Builder’s industry standard
FY23 highlights
Governance
Eective governance plays a pivotal role
in driving improvements in sustainability
performance. Our commitment to
responsible operations starts at the
highest level of our organisation with Board
oversight of the sustainability strategy and
objectives. The evolution of our strategy
and integration within the Group is guided
by our Sustainability Committee, which
operates with delegated authority from the
Board and Executive Committee. In FY23
the Sustainability Committee, chaired
by our Chief Executive, met four times.
Further details on our governance structure
can be found on page 44.
Protect the
environment
Make a positive impact
on our communities
Operate
responsibly
Reduction in scope 1 and
2 emissions compared to
baseline FY19
55%
FY22: 47%
Developments
within 1km of a
public transport link
92%
FY22: 88%
Trained mental health
first aiders
16
FY22: 18
Electricity procured
fromrenewable taris
89%
FY22: 70%
Aordable homes
delivered
525
FY22: 522
% employees in
trainee positions
or in formal training
22%
FY22: 19%
Crest Nicholson 20 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Protect the environment
We are taking proactive measures to safeguard the
natural environment for the long term by reducing
greenhouse gas emissions, minimising our impact
on natural resources and preserving and enhancing
nature across our developments.
Climate action
GHG emissions continue to rise, and the
eects of climate change are becoming more
pronounced. The scale and urgency from
Government and stakeholders is increasing.
We are committed to mitigating our impact
on climate change through GHG emissions
reduction in alignment with our science-based
targets (SBTs).
Climate change presents both risks and
opportunities for our operations and value
chain. You can find information regarding
our climate-related risks and opportunities
inour Task Force on Climate-related
FinancialDisclosures (TCFD) section on
pages43 to 50.
FY23 highlights
SBTs approved by the SBTi
Reduced absolute scope 1 and 2
emissions by 55% compared to
2019 base year (35% reduction in
emissions intensity)
Rolled out new fuel and plant
dashboards to embed resource ecient
practices across our sites.
Link to Strategic Priorities
Placemaking & Quality
Operational Eciency
Link to Foundations
1
People
2
Sustainability & Social Value
3
Safety, Health & Environment
Scope 1 and 2 GHG emissions breakdown
A Scope 1 2,848 tCO
2
e 75%
B Scope 2 956 tCO
2
e 25%
FY23
FY22
FY21
3,803
4,449
5,356
FY19 8,458
Scope 1 and 2 GHG emissions
performance (tCO
2
e)
Scope 1 and 2 emissions tCO
2
e
FY30 target (3,383 tCO
2
e)
Reducing our scope 1 and 2 emissions
In FY23 our total scope 1 and 2 GHG
emissions were 3,803 tonnes of carbon
dioxide equivalent (tCO
2
e), representing a 15%
reduction on FY22 and 55% reduction against
our FY19 science-based target baseline.
On an intensity basis, our scope 1 and 2 GHG
emissions were 2.09 tCO
2
e per 100 sq. m,
reflecting a 35% reduction compared to FY19
(FY19: 3.20 tCO
2
e).
Scope 1 emissions encompass direct emissions
from the use of fuel in the operation of plant
and equipment at our sites, gas consumption
for heating and hot water and the fuel used by
our vehicle fleet. Scope 2 emissions represent
indirect emissions arising from the procurement
of electricity and heat.
Scope 3 emissions relate to the emissions for
which we are indirectly responsible throughout
our value chain. These emissions are primarily
associated with our supply chain (upstream)
and the use of our homes (downstream).
Our targets
Reduce absolute scope 1 and 2 GHG
emissions 60% by 2030 from a 2019
base year
1
Reduce absolute scope 1 and 2 GHG
emissions 90% by 2045 from a 2019
base year
1
Our targets
Reduce scope 3 GHG emissions 55%
persq.m completed floor area by 2030 from
a2019 base year.
Reduce scope 3 GHG emissions 97% per
sq.m completed floor area by 2045 from
a2019 base year.
Reach net-zero GHG emissions across the value
chain by 2045 from a 2019 base year.
Our science-based targets
The Science Based Targets initiative (SBTi)
approved our near and long-term targets,
including our commitment to achieve
net-zero GHG emissions across our value
chain by 2045.
Achieving net-zero will be a significant
challenge and we continue to learn
and adapt our approach. A successful
transition to net-zero will require eective
collaboration and coordinated action
across the industry and our value chain.
Net-zero target
Scope 1 and 2 GHG emissions Scope 3 GHG emissions
1 Science Based Targets initiative.
A
B
Crest Nicholson 21 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Protect the environment continued
Actions taken to reduce scope 1 and 2 emissions
Implementing ecient
plant and equipment
Continue to prioritise early connection to the grid to reduce the use of generators and
associated fuel consumption
100% of our telehandler fleet have the most ecient Tier 5 engines
Utilise hybrid generators where feasible
Site compound specification upgraded to improve fabric eciency, reducing heating
requirements and improving comfort.
Reduction in generators
on hire across the Group
in FY23
1
47%
Sourcing alternative low
carbon fuels
Reducing consumption remains the priority
Hydrotreated vegetable oil (HVO
2
) used as a substitute for white diesel that is lower in
carbon and derived from waste vegetable oil and fats. It accounted for 53% of our total
site diesel use
Continue to explore alternative technologies to reduce fuel and energy consumption.
Proportion of HVO used
on our sites
53%
FY22: 49%
Procuring renewable
electricity
Increased the proportion of electricity from renewable taris to 89%
A key challenge is the lack of renewable taris for unmetered supplies, such as
street lights
Engaging with peers, utility management partners and energy suppliers to
find solutions
Targeting 100% renewable electricity for suppliers within our control.
Renewable taris
3
as
proportion of total
electricity consumption
89%
FY22: 70%
Shifting vehicle fleet
to electric and hybrid
Provide a diverse range of electric and hybrid vehicles on our company car scheme
Expanded EV charging infrastructure at our divisional oces and sites.
Proportion of our Group
car fleet hybrid or electric
64%
FY22: 40%
Communication
and behaviour
Developed and rolled out monthly fuel and plant dashboards that provide insights into
on-site generator utilisation, telehandler eciency and opportunities to reduce site
fuel consumption
Performance updates are provided in internal communication channels.
Reducing our scope 3 emissions
Scope 3 emissions account for 99% of our
total GHG emissions and predominantly
comprise of emissions relating to our supply
chain (upstream) and the use of our homes
(downstream). In FY23 our absolute scope 3
emissions reduced by 19% compared with
FY22. Scope 3 intensity was 2.64 tCO
2
e/sq. m,
representing a 9% increase from FY22
and a 3% increase from our FY19 baseline.
The intensity increase stems from our
ongoing construction activity and fewer legal
completions in FY23, particularly in emissions
tied to purchased goods and services.
Decarbonising our supply chain
GHG emissions associated with the materials
and services used to build our homes and
developments account for around 36% of our
total emissions. As emissions associated with
the use of our homes decrease, upstream
supply chain emissions will become the
largest source of our carbon footprint. This is
why collaboration with our supply chain will
be critical in our transition to net-zero.
In FY23 we conducted a whole life carbon
analysis on key Legacy Collection house
types of varying sizes. This analysis
enables us to identify emission reduction
opportunities and prioritise communication
with suppliers.
We engage with our suppliers on the
availability of emissions data and our recent
analysis highlighted that 26% of our upfront
embodied carbon emissions associated with
a home are covered by a supplier or product
specific Environmental Product Declaration.
Environmental Product Declarations
communicate verifiable environmental data
on products, which we use when assessing
material choices. A current area
of focus is engaging with the supply chain
to improve emissions data availability to
support these choices.
Additionally, we actively participate in the
Future Homes Hub’s Embodied and Whole
Life Carbon workgroup, which is developing
guidance tools and an implementation plan
to drive industry-wide reductions in whole life
carbon emissions.
1 Generators on hire reduced from 43 in November 2022 to 23 in October 2023. Includes generators sized 20kVA or larger.
2 HVO is a direct replacement for white diesel that is lower in carbon and derived from waste vegetable oil and fats.
3 Backed by Renewable Energy Guarantees of Origin certificates.
Scope 3 emissions breakdown
A Supply chain 36%
B Use of sold product 63%
C Other scope 3 1%
A
B
C
Crest Nicholson 22 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
13
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
1
12
14
15
16
17
Current fabric and technology
specifications include:
Potential fabric and technology
specifications from 2025 include:
CO
2
emissions
vs 2013
Building
Regulations
At least 31% reduction. At least 75% reduction
Homes are ‘zero-carbon ready’.
Fabric
1
Fabric first approach to prevent heat loss,
including enhanced fabric in walls, floor, roof
and windows with thermally broken lintels
2
Improved airtightness from 5 to a maximum
of 4.5, helping keep the home warm while
using less energy.
12
Higher fabric eciency in external walls
and double or triple glazing
13
Further improvement in airtightness.
Technology
3
Renewable and low carbon technology
including solar PV and some homes fitted
with air source heat pumps
4
PV diverter on hot water cylinders (where
installed) to maximise eciency of PV
5
Enhanced heating controls
6
Ecient gas boilers where fitted
7
Waste water heat recovery
8
Larger radiators for optimal heating
eciency and pipes enlarged to future proof
for air source heat pumps
9
Electric vehicle charge points
10
Decentralised mechanical extract ventilation
and larger trickle vents on windows to
improve ventilation and reduce risk of
overheating
11
Ecient water fittings.
14
Increasing use of air source heat
pumps
15
Hot water cylinder in every home
16
Additional smart technology
17
Electric vehicle charge points to
everyhome
Mechanical ventilation withheat
recovery in apartments.
Decarbonising our homes
The use of our homes accounts for
approximately 62% of our GHG emissions.
In FY23 we implemented the interim update
to Part L of the Building Regulations,
which requires a 31% reduction in carbon
emissions compared to the 2013 regulations.
Looking ahead, the impending Future Homes
Standard set to be enforced from 2025,
presents a substantial challenge, mandating a
minimum 75% reduction in carbon emissions
compared to the 2013 Building Regulations.
In preparation for the transition, we are
actively collaborating with our energy
assessors, supply chain partners and the
industry to ensure we are well prepared
to meet the Future Homes Standard
requirements. Future Homes Standard-
compliant homes will be zero carbon ready,
utilising electric heating systems such as
air source heat pumps. We are gradually
introducing air source heat pumps to an
increasing number of developments and
leveraging the knowledge and experience
gained to prepare for the implementation of
the Future Homes Standard.
We prioritise a fabric first approach to
enhance the thermal eciency of our homes,
reducing heat loss. Technologies supporting
emissions reduction are also integrated into
our homes. Feedback from customers and
suppliers informs ongoing refinements to
our designs and the technologies utilised,
ensuring our homes are comfortable,
user-friendly and cost eective to operate.
The infographic details some of the fabric and
technology specifications incorporated within
our homes both now and beyond 2025.
Our sustainability-linked RCF includes a
target to increase the proportion of our
homes that receive an Environmental Impact
rating of A or B, progressively increasing the
number of A rated homes. In FY23 96% of our
homes achieved an A or B rating.
Reducing the ‘in-use’ emissions of our homes
Natural resources and waste
Unsustainable resource consumption and
waste are major contributors to climate
change, biodiversity loss and pollution.
Reducing waste and our impact on natural
resources aligns with our Operational
Eciency strategic priority.
Reducing and recycling construction waste
In FY23 our total construction waste
decreased by 6% compared to FY22
(FY23: 19,975 tonnes; FY22: 21,356 tonnes).
However, waste intensity increased to 10.98
tonnes per 100 sq. m legally completed floor
area compared to FY22 (8.72 tonnes/100
sq. m), representing a 14% increase from our
FY19 baseline and a 26% increase from the
previous year. This year’s increase in waste
intensity can be partly attributed to reduced
completions in FY23, while building work
continued to progress at a steady pace. It is
clear that significant eorts are needed to
achieve our FY25 target to reduce waste
intensity by 15% from our FY19 baseline.
To promote waste reduction and embed
good practices, we are enhancing
communication around waste management
and introducing new reports in FY24.
These reports will identify anomalies and
pinpoint opportunities to reduce waste.
We prioritise waste segregation across
our sites and diverted 98% from landfill
in FY23 (FY22: 96%), exceeding our
95% diversion target. We encourage
timber reuse through our partnership
with Community Wood Recycling and our
pallet return scheme. Community Wood
Recycling oers employment and training
opportunities to disadvantaged individuals,
producing products from surplus timber
and ocuts. Our collaboration with them in
FY23 resulted in eight jobs and 14 training
places. Additionally, our pallet return partner
collected 36,036 pallets (FY22: 15,052),
which were repaired and reused in our supply
chain or recycled.
Lightweight compactable material, primarily
packaging waste, constitutes the highest
proportion of the waste we generate.
We continued to partner with the Supply
Chain Sustainability School and industry
peers to lead a packaging optimisation
project with major industry suppliers.
This collaboration resulted in the publication
of an industry report on optimising product
packaging in the housebuilding sector.
We remain committed to working with our
suppliers to implement initiatives aimed at
reducing waste and enhancing sustainability
throughout our operations.
Crest Nicholson 23 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Water resilience
The country faces an escalating risk of water
supply stress due to factors including climate
change, population growth and ageing
water infrastructure.
To support a reduction in demand, our
Legacy Collection homes are designed to
consume less than 105 litres per person
per day (lpppd), a 16% reduction compared
to the current regulatory requirement
of 125 lpppd. Our homes feature water
meters, dual-flush toilets, low-flow taps and
showers, all which reduce water demand and
customer consumption.
Furthermore, we integrate sustainable
drainage systems (SuDS) into most of
our developments, enhancing resilience
against water scarcity and flood risk on a
development level. SuDS reduce water runo
rates by incorporating natural features like
swales and attenuation ponds, while having
the added benefits of improving water
quality, providing recreational space and
promoting biodiversity.
Nutrient neutrality
In response to elevated levels of phosphate
and nitrate in watercourses, several Local
Authorities have mandated nutrient neutrality
in new developments in accordance with
Natural England guidance. While this
initiative aims to address water quality
concerns, it has inadvertently resulted in
planning delays without directly tackling
the root cause of river pollution. We are
engaged with Government bodies, industry
stakeholders and other interested parties to
explore and implement solutions to address
nutrient neutrality.
Protect the environment continued
Enhancing biodiversity
Biodiversity loss is a significant issue, with
implications at both a local and global scale.
The 2023 State of Nature report highlighted
that one in six species in Great Britain is at
risk of extinction. The loss of biodiversity
has negative eects on ecosystems and
the environment, reducing the stability and
availability of natural resources.
Biodiversity net gain is set to become a
mandatory requirement in early 2024.
This regulation requires developers
to achieve a minimum 10% net gain in
biodiversity compared to a pre-development
baseline. This not only helps to preserve
local ecosystems but also supports the
Government’s ambition to curb biodiversity
loss by 2030.
The implementation of biodiversity net gain
strategies can vary significantly across our
developments. To navigate this eectively,
we engage ecologists and landscape
architects early in the planning process.
This ensures that our eorts are both cost
eective and environmentally beneficial,
reflecting our commitment to enhancing
biodiversity and recognising the role it
plays in supporting business sustainability
and resilience.
Case study
Supporting nature and delivering
low carbon homes in Windsor
Situated near Windsor, the development
achieved planning consent in 2023
and will comprise of 135 homes, with
40% designated as aordable housing.
Our South division actively engaged with
our energy consultants to ensure high
levels of fabric eciency. The homes
will incorporate air source heat pumps
and apartments will utilise hot water
heat pumps and electric panel heaters.
GHG emissions will be 76% lower across
the development than 2013 Building
Regulations, aligning with the Future
Homes Standard target. An additional
financial contribution into a carbon oset
fund will balance the residual emissions.
Our team worked in partnership with
our ecologists and landscape architects
to ensure that open spaces will provide
a haven for wildlife and attractive
recreational areas for residents.
The development will create a 14%
biodiversity net gain through the delivery
of a wildflower meadow, an orchard,
nature-based sustainable drainage and
tree planting. Other features that support
nature and the community include:
Community allotments
50 swift bricks
50 bat bricks
10 bee homes
Hedgehog highways
Playground and informal play spaces
throughout the development
Attractive drainage features that are
designed for informal recreational
space, ecological benefits and
water management during high
rainfall events.
In line with our commitment
to sustainability, as well as
delivering much needed new
homes and aordable housing,
we aim to make Windsor Gate
a sustainable development for
future generations.
Nicholas Daruwalla
Land Director, South
Crest Nicholson 24 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Make a positive impact on our communities
We are committed to delivering attractive, high quality
homes, excellent customer experience and a lasting
positive legacy for our communities and the local
environment.
Creating thriving communities
and social value
At the core of the Group’s purpose is
the creation of thriving communities
and the delivery of lasting social value.
Through a considered approach to
placemaking, collaborative planning
and stakeholder engagement, we are
committed to providing high quality homes
with convenient access to local amenities.
We prioritise enhancing the connection
between our customers and nature by
establishing accessible green space
wherever possible.
Placemaking is aligned with the provision
of social value within the local community.
This is realised through local infrastructure
enhancements which include public
transportation connectivity, community
centres, educational facilities and
recreational and play areas. In addition, we
actively contribute socio-economic benefits
by generating employment opportunities for
local subcontractors, apprentices, trainees
and the supply chain.
Charitable giving and supporting the
local community
In FY23 we launched our charity partnership
with Young Lives vs Cancer. Their mission is
to make sure children and young people with
cancer get the right support at the right time.
Additionally, the Group actively supports
local charities and organisations through
donations and sponsorships, while oering
a payroll giving scheme enabling employees
to make tax-free donations to their chosen
charities directly from their salary.
Delivering high quality homes and
excellent customer experience
Building high quality homes and delivering
excellent customer experience is a core
component of our sustainability strategy.
In FY23 we were marginally below the
threshold to retain our five-star rating
for customer satisfaction from the Home
Builders Federation (HBF). The Group has
taken several proactive measures to regain
our five-star status and enhance the overall
customer journey.
Implementation of the New Homes
Quality Code
The New Homes Quality Code (NHQC)
was introduced in FY23. The NHQC which
aims to improve quality, consistency and
customer service standards across the
industry. We are strongly committed to
its principles and invested in employee
training and the development of new
processes to successfully implement the
NHQC requirements.
Quality Assurance
Our Quality Assurance team supports and
trains our site teams to deliver high quality
homes. During FY23 the team supported
our divisions with the implementation of Part
L Building Regulations requirement to take
photographic evidence during the quality
assurance process. Photographic evidence is
required to demonstrate that new homes are
built to high thermal standards and to provide
peace of mind that customers will receive a
high quality and energy ecient home.
Customer experience
Central to our commitment to delivering
an excellent customer experience is the
introduction of our new Customer Relations
Managers. The team provides a central
contact point within the build team for our
customers. They provide support both prior
to moving in and during the early weeks
of occupation.
After this initial period, the dedicated
customer service teams manage any
further queries from customers. We have
strengthened our follow-up processes which
are designed to address concerns promptly
and eectively, providing customers with the
support and resolution they expect.
FY23 highlights
Embedded the NHQC
Established new quality assurance
and customer experience processes
525 aordable homes delivered
Launched charity partnership with
Young Lives vs Cancer.
Link to Strategic Priorities
Placemaking & Quality
Five-Star Customer Service
Multi Channel Approach
Link to Foundations
1
People
2
Sustainability & Social Value
3
Safety, Health & Environment
Read more in our
Customer Charter
Easter egg hunt to celebrate the launch of a new
play area. In addition, Crest Nicholson sponsored
the local preschool to upgrade its roof, drainage and
outside area.
‘Story time’ event with a local
author provided to pupils at one of
our developments.
Crest Nicholson 25 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Operate our business responsibly
We are committed to responsible business operations.
We foster a safe, inclusive workplace and collaborate
with our supply chain to drive positive outcomes for
ourstakeholders.
Sustainable supply chain and
responsible procurement
Collaboration with our supply chain partners
plays a critical role in the successful
delivery of our strategy and sustainability
performance. Our Sustainable Procurement
Policy and Supply Chain Code of Conduct
(Supplier Code) set out clear environmental,
ethical and social obligations for our supply
chain partners and promote safe and
fair working conditions. We continue to
partner with the Supply Chain Sustainability
School, of which we have achieved Gold
status membership.
Membership of the Supply Chain
Sustainability School provides access to
sustainability-related learning resources and
CPD-accredited content for our supply chain.
We launched a new learning pathway for
our supply chain, which was developed
in partnership with the Supply Chain
Sustainability School. This pathway facilitates
increased engagement between our
suppliers and the Supply Chain Sustainability
School while enhancing the skills and
knowledge of our supply chain through
specific learning modules on important
sustainability topics, including climate
change, waste and modern slavery.
In FY22 we established our sustainability-
linked RCF. One of our targets is for 90% of
suppliers with Group Trading Agreements to
achieve bronze, silver or gold membership
of the Supply Chain Sustainability School by
FY26. At the end of FY23 56% had achieved
at least bronze status, of which 33% had
achieved gold status.
Sustainable timber
Our Sustainable Timber Policy commits
us to purchasing certified timber from well
managed forests, including FSC (Forest
Stewardship Council) and PEFC (Programme
for the Endorsement of Forest Certification)
certified timber. Purchasing FSC and PEFC
accredited timber promotes sustainable
forest management and reduces the risk of
illegal deforestation. Our last reported timber
audit confirmed 100% of our timber procured
from suppliers was FSC or PEFC certified.
Human rights and anti-slavery
We are committed to conducting business
with integrity, respecting and safeguarding
the human rights of our colleagues and those
who are associated with our operations,
including our supply chain, customers and the
communities in which we work. Our Human
Rights Policy supports the principles set out
in the UN Guiding Principles on Business and
Human Rights, the Universal Declaration of
Human Rights and the International Labour
Organization’s Fundamental Conventions.
We expect our supply chain partners to
operate responsibly and with respect for
human rights. Our Supplier Code sets out
our expectations relating to environmental
and social matters within our supply chain.
All supply chain partners are contractually
required to abide by our Supplier Code,
which is available on our website.
An anti-slavery e-learning module is
compulsory on induction for relevant new
employees and is completed annually by
existing employees. Anti-slavery updates are
provided on our intranet and posters have
been issued to sites to help those working on
our developments identify the potential signs
and understand how to report concerns via
the Speaking Up (whistleblowing) helpline
and website. A zero tolerance approach
is taken to any form of modern slavery,
including forced labour and child labour.
Our Speaking Up policy allows our
colleagues, subcontractors, suppliers and
the local community to report concerns.
During FY23 there were zero substantiated
grievances relating to human rights and zero
reported cases of modern slavery.
FY23 highlights
Launched new learning pathway for
our supply chain
Increased supply chain
engagement with the Supply Chain
Sustainability School
Became an accredited Living
Wage Employer
Achieved The 5% Club Gold Award.
Link to Strategic Priorities
Placemaking & Quality
Operational Eciency
Multi Channel Approach
Link to Foundations
1
People
2
Sustainability & Social Value
3
Safety, Health & Environment
Read more in our
Speaking Up policy
Real Living Wage
In FY23 we were accredited as a Living Wage
Employer by the Living Wage Foundation.
The real Living Wage is higher than the
Government’s minimum and National Living
Wage, and it is the only UK wage rate that is
independently calculated based on the cost
of living.
We pay at least the real Living Wage to
all direct employees¹ and this is reviewed
annually. Our Supplier Code sets out a
requirement that subcontractors working on
our sites are also paid the real Living Wage.
We communicate our status as a Living
Wage Employer across our sites. We provide
information on how to report any potential
non-compliance through the Speaking
Up channels.
Group suppliers at bronze,
silver or gold status
with the Supply Chain
Sustainability School, of
which 33% received gold
56%
FY22: 18%
Read more in our
Supply Chain Code of Conduct
1 Apprentices are subject to a dierent pay scale in line
with statutory requirements.
Crest Nicholson 26 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Safety, Health & Environment
The safety and welfare of everyone who
comes into contact with our operations
is our number one priority.
Our number one priority is that our
employees and people aected by our
activities remain healthy and go home safely
to their family and friends every day. We can
only achieve this by continuing to have a
relentless focus on identifying risks early and
everyone taking responsibility to mitigate
these through proactive decision making
and compliance.
We continually monitor our compliance with
Safety, Health & Environment (SHE) standards
and industry best practice. Compliance has
improved during the year increasing to
89.9% (FY22: 87.9%). Measuring compliance
gives us a forward indicator of performance.
We use this performance monitoring
information and analysis of incidents to
guide our eorts, through intervention and
improvement campaigns.
We are pleased with our progress this year
and with the reduction in our AIIR which has
reduced to 304 (468 in FY22). A continual
focus on safety is required for us to maintain
this performance, delivered through our
ongoing compliance and programme of
SHE campaigns.
SHE leadership
The Board monitors SHE performance at
every meeting. Below Board, the governance
structure comprises our SHE Committee,
functional forums and a comprehensive
programme of divisional meetings, leadership
safety tours and compliance inspections.
This year our Internal Audit function reviewed
the structure and identified some areas
for improvement in our management of
subcontractor RAMS.
Building Safety
We are committed to remediating legacy
buildings within the scope of the Developer
Remediation Contract. Our dedicated
remediation teams and safety team have
introduced procedures and monitoring
processes so that the work is carried out safely.
SHE audit compliance
89.9%
FY22: 87.9%
AIIR
304
FY22: 468
SHE training days
455
FY22: 366
Director safety tours
141
FY22: 144
SHE compliance inspections
599
FY22: 685
FY23 highlights
Slips, trips and falls – introduced
a campaign to refocus site teams
on the benefits of keeping a tidy
workplace for safety reasons and in
turn minimising the waste of materials
through improved storage
Telehandler improvements – our
fleet has been fitted with reversing
cameras to reduce the number
of incidents
Preventing service strikes – a
new permit framework has been
developed for all trades involved in
digging, with much greater emphasis
on properly identifying hazards before
digging takes place
Tool handling – assessed individual
trades on the use of hand tools
and workstation set up with the
aim of reducing injuries to hands
and forearms
Risk Assessments and Method
Statements (RAMS) – introduced
new management processes and
measures to improve the way we
review our subcontractors, as well as
ensure continuity in risk management
when site teams change.
Link to Strategic Priorities
Placemaking & Quality
Operational Eciency
Five-Star Customer Service
Link to Foundations
1
People
2
Sustainability & Social Value
3
Safety, Health & Environment
All telehandlers have been
fitted with reversing cameras
Crest Nicholson 27 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Our People
Our people are at the heart of
everything we do and their commitment
to our purpose and values is critical
to our long-term success.
Training and development
We continue to enhance our development
oering and actively encourage people to
focus on their personal growth. The Crest
Academy introduced a new Management
Development Programme, to complement
our existing Talent Programmes.
Our Management Development Programme
was designed for a wide range of employees,
which includes experienced and new
managers, and employees in the pipeline to
be a future manager. The aim was to provide
our people with the tools to develop their
skills to be the best manager they can be and
bring out the best in their teams.
In addition, we launched our Personal Skills
Training oering a range of resources to
all employees. This enabled our people
to have the chance to take part in a series
of interactive, distilled and bite-sized
training modules.
Health and wellbeing
It is important for our people to feel happy
and healthy at work. We have continued to
invest in various tools that can aid our people
to ensure their health is a priority, both at
work and at home.
We have a dedicated Anity Group for
Mental Health and Wellbeing. This Anity
Group raises awareness and promotes
initiatives to improve people’s health and
wellbeing. Subsequently several campaigns
have been launched across the Group,
including celebrating World Kindness Day.
Female
38%
Employees have been promoted
through the year
61
We have 16 Mental Health First
Aiders trained across the Group.
16
Equality, diversity and inclusion
It is vital that we have a diverse workforce,
thriving in an inclusive culture and
reflecting the communities we serve.
Our Anity Groups were embedded in
FY23 as part of our Diversity and Inclusion
strategy. This is important for us as we
continue our focus on maintaining an
inclusive environment where all our people
are valued, included and empowered to
succeed. The aim of our Anity Groups is to
provide a safe space for discussion, help to
raise awareness and drive change, where
required, within the Group. They provide a
source of support and oer a collective voice
for our people.
As well as supporting employee-led
initiatives and networks, we launched a
dedicated diversity and inclusion intranet
page. We marked notable dates and
religious festivals to raise awareness
and respect for dierent faiths and
important causes.
Male
62%
Catalyst experience
In June 2023 we launched our first Catalyst
immersive experience for a cross-section
of women in the Group. The programme
focused on building resilience, confidence,
self-awareness and networking situations
in a supportive space that challenged
the narrative around gender and
leadership. The participants received
personalised one-to-one coaching with an
external coach.
Participants focused on areas such as:
Personal leadership inspiration
Power and the power of others
Purposeful networking for
career success
Developing a plan for integrating your
whole self.
The course allowed for a lot of self-
reflection and at times, required
you to ask yourself dicult
questions on self-respect.
For me, the biggest takeaway was
recognising I needed more self-
care, both physically and mentally
to be able to be more resilient and
be the best version of myself.
We have concentrated our eorts
championing our people, investing
in their development, personal
growth and prioritising their
wellbeing.
Natalie Shanks
Finance Manager, PSL
Crest Nicholson 28 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Our trainees
We aim to develop our
employees and create a
pipeline of talent. We have
invested heavily in our
Future Talent Programme
designed for trainees.
With the future pipeline of
talent in mind, we’ve increased
our investment in training and
development this year, increasing
the availability of training to all.
Jane Cookson
Group HR Director
We welcomed five new trainees into the
Group this year and these individuals were
enrolled onto our Future Talent Programme.
The first of five cohorts have completed
their development programme. The final
session was our kick down event which
brought the trainees together for
networking with senior management to
celebrate the successful completion of the
programme. Our trainees reviewed the
core topics which guided their learning
journey, enabling them to reflect on their
experience and consider how they will
embed this learning into their careers
going forward.
To demonstrate our commitment to entry-
level careers, we are a member of The 5%
Club and have received the Gold Award
which acknowledges the work we have
undertaken to close the skills gap. The 5%
Club is a movement of employers who are
committed to have 5% of their workforce in
earn and learn positions.
Trainees have gone through our
trainee programme since January 2022
63
Trainees have been promoted since
completing our training programme
21
Gold Accredited member
of The 5% club
5%
I have greatly benefitted from
the Future Talent Programme
as I feel that I am more resilient,
self-aware and productive.
Hassan Ahmed
Company Secretarial Assistant
FY23 employee engagement
Quarterly
Our newsletter
delivers the
latest news and
updates about the
Group. Regular
features included
a business update
from the Chief
Executive, people
news and a ‘day
in the life’ of
employees.
Throughout the
year
The Board visited
developments
individually and as
a group, interacting
with employees
on a collective and
one-to-one basis,
giving greater
insight on what
is important to
employees.
Throughout the
year
Our Anity Groups
met to discuss
the barriers our
people face within
under-represented
groups and
reported back to
the Diversity and
Inclusion Forum
with practical
suggestions.
Throughout the
year
We use timely,
relevant and
targeted
messaging to
communicate
important news
about benefits,
policies, IT
updates, employee
recognition and
other employee
initiatives using the
IT tool Snapcomms.
May and
September 2023
The ELT spent
time with each
division to thank
employees for
their hard work,
discuss how we
are progressing
against our
strategy and
outline our plans
for the future.
Employees were
encouraged to ask
questions in the
sessions or submit
them anonymously
in advance.
May, September
and October 2023
The Employee
Voice forum is
chaired by Louise
Hardy, our Non-
Executive Director
responsible
for employee
engagement,
and attended
by volunteers
from across
the Group. This
forum facilitates
meaningful, regular
dialogue between
the Board and
employees from
across the Group.
July 2023
We asked
employees to
let us know their
thoughts about
the Group’s
culture. These
conversations have
provided important
insight into what
it is like to work at
Crest Nicholson
and will form the
basis of the Culture
Action Plan.
The Exchange Board site visits Diversity
and inclusion
Group
communications
Employee
roadshows
Employee Voice Culture focus
groups and
interviews
Gold
2023/24
Crest Nicholson 29 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Key performance indicators
We use 12 key performance indicators to
monitor our progress against our strategy.
These are how we measure theperformance
and health of our business.
We deliver sustainable growth while
delivering shareholder returns supported by
a robust balance sheet. It is essential that
financial performance does not compromise
the safety, build quality or customer
experience ofthose working on our sites.
To align the focus of the Board and ELT with
the interests of stakeholders, some KPIs
are reflected in our senior management
incentive schemes.
Financial KPIs
Further information onremuneration can
be found on pages81 to 98.
6.3%
Return on capital
employed (ROCE)
1
6.7%
Earnings before
interest and tax
(EBIT) margin
1
2,020
Unit completions
24.0%
Land creditors as
a% of net assets
1
£64.9m
Net
cash
1
23.2%
Land portfolio
gross margin
Definition
Sales of homes recognised in the year including
100% of those held in joint venturesand on an
equivalent unit basis.
Why we measure
Reflects overall business activity andoutput
and enables the Group to forecast future
capacity requirements.
Link to Strategic Priorities,
Foundations and principal risks
4
1
3
5
Definition
EBIT margin (operating profit margin)
reflectsthe adjusted profit before interest,
joint ventures and tax achieved by the
Group, divided by revenue.
Why we measure
Assesses the financial eciency
of our Group operations before
any one-o cost.
Link to Strategic Priorities,
Foundations and principal risks
4
1
3
5
Definition
Adjusted operating profit before
joint ventures divided by average
capital employed.
Why we measure
Illustrates how eective the Group’s
capitalallocation is in delivering returns.
Link to Strategic Priorities,
Foundations and principal risks
4
3
5
Definition
Land creditors divided by net assets.
Why we measure
Ensures that the Group is maintaining
arobust financial position when entering
into future land commitments.
Link to Strategic Priorities,
Foundations and principal risks
4
1
3
5
Definition
Cash and cash-equivalents plus
non-current and current interest-bearing
loans and borrowings.
Why we measure
Illustrates the Group’s overall liquidity
position and general financial resilience.
Link to Strategic Priorities,
Foundations and principal risks
1
3
5
Definition
The forecast gross margin after sales
andmarketing costs of land we hold
inourshort-term land portfolio.
Why we measure
Indicates the earnings potential of
currentand future land development
andthesale ofassociated homes.
Link to Strategic Priorities,
Foundations and principal risks
1
3
5
FY23
FY21
FY22
6.3%
17.2%
22.4%
FY23
FY21
FY22
24.0%
24.7%
22.5%
FY23
FY21
FY22
6.7%
14.6%
15.4%
FY23
FY21
FY22
£64.9m
£252.8m
£276.5m
FY23
FY21
FY22
2,020
2,407
2,734
FY23
FY21
FY22
23.2%
23.4%
25.0%
Crest Nicholson 30 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Key
Non-financial KPIs
Link to Remuneration
KPI used in the annual bonus scheme
KPI used in the Long-Term Incentive Plan
Link to Foundations
1
People
2
Sustainability & Social Value
3
Safety, Health & Environment
4
Financial Targets
Link to principal risks
6
12
1 2 3 4 5
7 8 9 10 11
See pages 35 to 42
See pages 10 to 11
Link to Strategic Priorities
Placemaking & Quality
Land Portfolio
Operational Eciency
Five-Star Customer Service
Multi Channel Approach
1 ROCE, EBIT margin, net cash and land creditors as a percentage of net assets are alternative performance measures. See pages 161 to 162 for further details.
2.09
Greenhouse gas (GHG)
emissions intensity
10.98
Waste intensity
Definition
The percentage of leavers during the
year by reason of resignation or
retirement as aproportion of total
employees at the end of the year.
Why we measure
The quality of our people and the
decisions they make are fundamental
to the successful implementation of our
strategy. Low employee turnover supports
greater depth of experience, continuity
anddevelopment of skills within our teams.
Link to Strategic Priorities, Foundations
and principal risks
1
3
7
Definition
Waste intensity reflects tonnes of
construction waste per 100 sq. m of
completed floor area.
Why we measure
This is one of the key measures we use
totrack our progress on reducing our
impacton the environment. There is
alsoafinancial benefit from the reduced cost
ofmaterials purchased and waste generated
in the construction process.
Link to Strategic Priorities, Foundations
and principal risks
2
9
Definition
The GHG emissions intensity reflects
our scope 1 and 2 emissions (tCO
2
e)
per 100 sq. m of completed floor area.
It includes business travel via company cars,
fuel and energy used on sites and in oces.
Why we measure
This is one of the key measures we use to
track our progress on reducing our impact
on the environment. There is also a financial
benefit from increased operational eciency
and reduced cost of fuel used.
Link to Strategic Priorities, Foundations
and principal risks
2
9
10
Definition
The annual HBF’s customersatisfaction
rating based on theNHBC surveywhich
newhome buyers receive. Survey results are
published in March each year.
Why we measure
Providing Five-Star Customer Serviceis one
of the Group’sstrategic priorities.
Link to Strategic Priorities, Foundations
and principal risks
4
Definition
AIIR represents the number of
accidentsinthe year normalised
per100,000people working on-site.
Why we measure
The safety, health and welfare
ofeveryonewho is part of our
operationsisournumber one priority.
Link to Strategic Priorities, Foundations
and principal risks
3
1
3
5
Definition
Proportion of unit sales of homes
recognisedin the year to the Private
Rented Sector (PRS) or aordable housing.
Why we measure
A Multi Channel Approach is one of
theGroup’s strategic priorities.
Link to Strategic Priorities, Foundations
and principal risks
4
1
19%
Voluntary
employee turnover
4 star
Customer
satisfaction
304
Annual Injury
Incidence Rate (AIIR)
26.0%
PRS/Aordable
unit completions
FY23
FY21
FY22
2.09
2.52
1.82
FY23
FY21
FY22
4
5
5
FY23
FY21
FY22
10.98
9.25
8.72
FY23
FY21
FY22
304
385
468
FY23
FY21
FY22
19%
35%
27%
FY23
FY21
FY22
26.0%
37.1%
35.1%
Crest Nicholson 31 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Financial review
Bill Floydd
Group Finance Director
Revenue
£657.5m
FY22: £913.6m
Net cash
£64.9m
FY22: £276.5m
Adjusted gross profit
£100.6m
FY22: £194.3m
As in previous years, the Group continues to report alternative
performance measures relating to sales, return on capital
employed and ‘adjusted’ performance metrics because of the
exceptional items as detailed in note 4 of the consolidated
financial statements. Exceptional items are those which, in the
opinion of the Directors, are material by size and/or non-recurring
in nature and therefore require separate disclosure within the
consolidated income statement in order to assist the users of
the financial statements to better understand the performance
of the Group, which is also how the Directors internally manage
the business. Alternative performance measures are detailed on
pages 161 to 162.
Our financial
position
Crest Nicholson 32 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
FY23 trading performance
FY23 saw a weakening sales market
compared to FY22 which has impacted levels
of demand for new homes. Supply chain
pressures, labour inflation and rising prices
of raw materials experienced in FY22
eased during FY23 leading to a reduction in
inflationary impacts during the year, albeit still
higher than average historic rates.
Sales prices remained stable, with modest
declines through autumn.
FY23 has been impacted by domestic
political uncertainty. At the end of FY22
the Mini-Budget led to rising interest rates
resulting in a temporary collapse in housing
sales. Confidence gradually returned to the
housing market as increases in interest rates
began to stabilise, with a steadier sales rate
being achieved by spring 2023.
The weakening sales market, driven by
domestic economic uncertainty, increases
in interest rates, modest reductions in sales
prices, build cost inflation and ongoing
challenges at some of our sites have in
combination impacted financial metrics
compared to FY22.
Sales, including joint ventures is down 27.6%
on prior year at £692.1m (FY22: £955.8m).
This comprised £657.5m of statutory revenue
(FY22: £913.6m) and £34.6m of the Group’s
share of revenue through joint ventures
(FY22: £42.2m). The Group entered into a
new joint venture in the year that is expected
to start contributing to Group profit in FY24.
The Group delivered 2,020 (FY22: 2,734)
home completions during the year, down
26.1% on prior year. 1,495 of these were open
market completions (including bulk deals)
(FY22: 2,212), down 32.4% on prior year,
with the balance derived from aordable
completions at 525 (FY22: 522), up 0.6% on
prior year. Current and prior year comparative
values both state joint ventures at full unit
count and include an allocation for any land
sale element that is present in any relevant
completed transaction, referring to this as
being on an equivalent unit basis.
Open market (including bulk) average
selling prices increased to £406,000
(FY22: £388,000) during the year due to the
mix of units recognised.
Adjusted gross profit was £100.6m
(FY22: £194.3m), down 48.3% on prior year,
reflecting the weaker sales environment
and build cost challenges. Adjusted gross
margin was down on prior year at 15.3%
(FY22: 21.3%). As announced in our
November trading statement Brightwells
Yard, Farnham recorded c. £11m incremental
build costs in the year. The Group has
subsequently conducted a comprehensive
review of the costs to complete this project as
well as our other legacy and low margin sites.
Consequently, further additional costs of
£5.5m have been identified, including £2.5m
at Farnham, which have impacted FY23
APBT. The Group has commenced a thorough
plan to improve commercial processes and
controls to mitigate the risk of future cost
overruns. Construction at the Farnham
scheme is now in its final stages. Gross profit
was £86.3m (FY22: £91.8m), down 6.0% on
prior year due to the impact of significantly
higher level of exceptional items in FY22
oset by the impact of the challenging sales
market in FY23.
Net administrative expenses for the year were
£55.8m (FY22: £51.1m). With the expectation
of tougher trading conditions, the Group
undertook a rationalisation exercise in the
second half including the merger of the East
Anglia division with our Eastern division
and the streamlining of operations which is
expected to reduce annualised administrative
expenses by circa £3.0m in FY24.
Included within net administrative expenses
is a restructuring charge of £0.5m which was
substantially completed at the end of the year.
Net impairment losses onnancial assets
were £0.6m (2022: £2.3m). The FY22
charge related to the disposal of the Group’s
50% share in the joint venture containing
the London Chest Hospital to its joint
venture partner.
Adjusted operating profit (or Earnings Before
Interest and Tax – EBIT) decreased in the year
to £44.2m (FY22: £140.9m) with EBIT margin
decreasing from 15.4% to 6.7% due to lower
revenue falling through to margin. Finally,
adjusted profit before tax (APBT) for the year
was £41.4m (FY22: £137.8m), down 70.0% on
prior year and profit before tax after exceptional
items for the year was £23.1m (FY22: £32.8m),
reflecting the impact of the weaker year-
on-year operating profit contribution oset
by the exceptional charge outlined below.
Operating profit was £29.9m (FY22: £38.4m),
down 22.1% on prior year due to the weaker
trading environment and build cost challenges.
Control environment
Commercial controls in two divisions
have not been eective during the year.
Weaknesses were identified in the divisions’
management and forecasting of build costs
and margin of which the most material
example was in Farnham. At the end of FY23,
the Group completed its rollout of a new ERP
system which going forward will strengthen
the key financial and commercial controls
that operate across the business. A new
Group Commercial Assurance team has
been established to monitor key commercial
controls. In addition, the appointment of a
new Chief Operating Ocer from 1 January
2024 will provide additional group oversight.
Exceptional items
As a consequence of signing the Developer
Remediation Contract on 13 March 2023,
the Group has entered into contractual
commitments with the Government to
identify and remediate those buildings it
has developed with possible life-critical fire
safety defects. The combustible materials
charge in FY23 represents changes in
forecast build costs and in the discount rate
applied to the provision. See notes 4 and 22
of the consolidated financial statements for
additional information.
In FY23 the Group recorded an exceptional
total combustible materials related charge of
£5.3m (FY22: £105.0m) representing forecast
changes in build costs and in the provision
discount in the year. This total charge is after
a £10.0m cash receipt from a third party
relating to buildings included within the
combustible materials provision.
The Group also recognised a charge of
£13.0m as it is subject to a legal claim relating
to a low rise apartment, three-storey scheme
built by the Group which was damaged by
fire in 2021. Due to the size and nature of the
claim, and in line with the Group’s accounting
policy, this has been presented as an
exceptional item.
The tax credit on exceptional items is £4.8m
(FY22: £22.4m).
Finance expense and taxation
Adjusted net finance expense of £5.5m
(FY22: £7.1m) is £1.6m lower year-on-year,
and the Group Revolving Credit Facility (RCF)
remained undrawn for the duration of the year.
Net finance expense was £10.1m (FY22: £8.1m).
Income tax charge in the year of £5.2m
(FY22: £6.4m) represented an eective tax
rate of 22.5% (FY22: 19.5%). This increase is
due to the impact of changes in UK tax rates.
Further detail can be found in note 8 of the
consolidated financial statements.
£250m Revolving Credit Facility
The Group’s previous £250m RCF was due
to expire in June 2024. During the prior year
we completed a new Sustainability Linked
Revolving Credit Facility. The £250m facility
expires in October 2026. It is also linked to
the Group’s sustainability strategy with a
lower interest payable if certain targets are
achieved. These targets include:
Reduction in absolute scope 1 and
2 emissions in line with our science-
based targets
Increasing the number of our suppliers
engaging with the Supply Chain
Sustainability School
Reduction in carbon emissions associated
with the use of our homes
Increasing the number of our
employees in trainee positions and on
training programmes.
For FY23 all targets have been met. This will
result in a margin reduction of 0.05%.
Sales
£692.1m
FY22: £955.8m
Home completions
2,020
FY22: 2,734
Crest Nicholson 33 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Financial review continued
Dividend
The Board proposes to pay a final dividend
of 11.5 pence per share for the financial year
ended 31 October 2023 which, subject to
shareholder approval, is expected to be
paid on 23 April 2024 to shareholders on
the Register of Members on 22 March 2024.
This is in addition to the 5.5 pence per share
interim dividend that was paid in October
2023. The Group expects to revert to its
policy of dividend cover of 2.5 times for FY24,
having deviated from policy in FY23 to meet
our commitment to maintain the same cash
dividend as FY22.
Financial position
The Group had net cash of £64.9m
at 31 October 2023 (FY22: £276.5m).
Net cash and land creditors were £(140.6)m
(FY22: £77.8m).
Inventories at 31 October 2023 were £1,164.8m
(FY22: £990.1m), up 17.6% year-on-year.
During FY23 the Group increased investment
in inventories and strategically acquired high
quality land to strengthen its land portfolio,
supported by its strong balance sheet.
This strategic move positions the Group to
capitalise on growth when the market returns
to a more normalised level. Included within
this balance is an NRV provision of £20.2m
(FY22: £12.6m) which principally relates to
the Group’s scheme at Brightwell’s Yard,
Farnham. Completed units at 31 October 2023
were £89.6m (FY22: £30.1m). Further detail
on inventory can be found in note 19 of the
consolidated financial statements.
Net cash outflow from operating activities was
£165.6m (FY22: £51.7m inflow) and return on
capital employed (ROCE) reduced in the year to
6.3% (FY22: 22.4%), reflecting the decrease in
earnings and investment in land. Net assets at
31 October 2023 were £856.3m (FY22: £883.1m),
a decrease of 3.0% on prior year.
Land portfolio
The supply of land continued to tighten in
the year due to the Government changing
the top-down housing targets and planning
issues around nutrients, water neutrality,
recreation zones and air quality constraints.
With the uncertain economic outlook during
FY23 some developers did not complete
planned acquisitions or temporarily
withdrew from the market. The Group took
the opportunity to acquire several highly
desirable sites and strengthening its land
portfolio and securing favourable terms.
The Group’s decision to remain active in the
land market positions it to mitigate planning
delays, ensuring a higher number of outlets
are in place when market conditions improve.
The land acquisition programme will remain
at a reduced level during FY24. FY23 average
outlets were 47 (FY22: 54) and it is expected
that FY24 will be at a similar level, reflecting
the backdrop outlined above. 3,864 plots
have been approved in FY23 for purchase
at a gross margin of 25.2% (after sales and
marketing costs).
The Group’s short-term land portfolio
at 31 October 2023 comprised 14,922
(FY22: 14,250) plots, representing
approximately five years of supply. In addition,
the Group’s strategic land portfolio comprised
18,830 plots (FY22: 22,450), resulting
in a total land portfolio at 31 October
2023 of 33,752 (FY22: 36,700) plots with
a Gross Development Value (GDV) of
£12.2bn (FY22: £12.1bn). During the year
the Group added 3,501 units to the short-
term land portfolio and delivered 2,020
home completions.
Bill Floydd
Group Finance Director
Waterman’s Gate, Arborfield, Berkshire
1 Units based on management estimates of site capacity. Includes joint venture units at full unit count and on an equivalent unit
basis which allocates a proportion of the unit count for a deal to the land sale element where the deal contains a land sale.
2 Gross development value (GDV) is a management estimate calculated on the basis of a number of assumptions, for
example, assumed sale price, number of units within the assumed development and the split between open market and
aordable housing units, and the obtaining of planning permission. These are management’s estimates and do not provide
assurance as to the valuation of the Group’s portfolio. Units based on management estimates of site capacity.
FY23 FY22
Units
1
GDV
2
– £m Units
1
GDV
2
– £m
Short-term housing 14,922 5,054 14,250 4,661
Short-term commercial 60 41
Total short term 14,922 5,114 14,250 4,702
Strategic land 18,830 7,049 22,450 7,409
Total land pipeline 33,752 12,163 36,700 12,111
Crest Nicholson 34 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Principal risks and uncertainties
How we manage risk
Risk appetite
Risk appetite at Crest Nicholson is
the amount of risk that the Board is
prepared to accept in return for achieving
our purpose of building great places
for our customers, communities and
the environment.
Our appetite for risk is based on our
analysis of market context, our strategy
and input from management and advisors.
This is reviewed throughout the year.
In order to achieve the Group’s strategy,
and objectives, the Board takes a prudent
view on risk and has an overall risk
appetite across its portfolio of risks that
reflects this.
We seek to balance our risk
position between:
Maintaining a strong focus on
health, safety and regulatory
compliance matters
Ensuring financial strength by
generating profits and cash through
our operations
Having a balanced portfolio through
our Multi Channel Approach and
being selective in land acquisitions.
This allows us to adapt to cyclical
markets and be flexible in our
investment decisions
Being disciplined in our operational
eciency and future growth
Maintaining the right culture and
shared values.
Risk culture
Risk awareness exists through decision-
making processes and is embedded in
systems, policies, leadership, governance
and behaviours. Aligned to our values, we
maintain a culture where our colleagues are
empowered to make decisions within agreed
parameters in the delivery of our objectives.
We ensure we have the right accountabilities
across the Group, maintaining eective risk-
based decision making.
Emerging risks
Emerging risks have the potential to impact
our strategy but currently are not fully
defined, or are principal risks, which are
particularly elevated or increasing in velocity.
Our emerging risks are identified through
horizon scanning by the Board and ELT
including in relation to industry and macro-
economic trends. This is supported by our
divisional risk review process.
The Group’s performance is subject to
potential risks and uncertainties in the pursuit
of its objectives.
These risks could, either separately or
in combination, have a material impact
on the Group’s performance, customers,
employees, communities, the environment
and shareholder returns.
To continue to be a successful housebuilder
in the long term, our decision making must
be informed by a clear understanding
of our business risks and opportunities.
These include potential likelihood, impact
and outcomes that inform and define our
risk appetite.
Our Risk Management Framework supports
us in providing assurance that we have
identified and are addressing our principal
and emerging risks. Risk management is
embedded throughout our strategy and
decision-making processes.
Our divisional boards consider their
divisional risk registers on a half-yearly
basis. The divisional risk reviews, alongside
the Group’s principal risks, are carefully
considered by the ELT. The Board and Audit
and Risk Committee both have oversight of
the Group’s principal and emerging risks and
regularly assess these against the Group’s
risk appetite and its capacity to handle risk.
Bottom up
Assessment and
mitigation of risk
across divisional and
functional areas
Risk governance framework Board
Has overall responsibility for strategy, risk management
and internal control
Reviews the Group’s principal and emerging risks
Sets the Group’s appetite for risk and strategy
Delegates risk oversight to the Audit and Risk Committee
and to the Executive Committee and divisions.
Audit and
Risk Committee
Responsible for monitoring our risk management processes and
approving relevant disclosures
Monitors financial reporting and internal and external audit activities
Provides assurance to the Board in relation to financial,
operational and compliance controls.
Executive
Committee
Oversees how we are managing the principal, emerging and the
divisional risks within the Group’s risk appetite
Embed risk management within the Group
Monitors divisional performances and development risks.
Divisional
board and site
management
Responsible for control and risk management within the division
or function
Monitors and assesses the divisional and operational risks
Maintains an eective system of control and risk management
at a site level, including SHE and supply chain risks.
Top down
Assessment and
mitigation of risks
at a Group level
Crest Nicholson 35 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
FY23 emerging risks
Economic outlook
We continue to monitor the developing
uncertainties surrounding the political and
economic outlook, rising interest rates and
mortgage availability, which could lead to
lower sales volumes. As a result we have
taken actions to adjust our strategy and
reduce overhead costs.
Build costs
We have continued to review and
discuss risks surrounding our build costs
forecasting. Additional oversight controls
are being implemented and we are
strengthening our reporting through the
ERP system.
Regulatory change
This risk has continued to evolve during
the year and impacts us in several ways.
We have continuously reviewed the
speed of progress on in-scope remedial
fire safety work in addressing our
commitments with the UK Government’s
Developer Remediation Contract.
There can often be challenges with
a shortage in available fire safety
professionals, getting access to sites,
including legal consent, all of which can
aect our ability to progress work as
quickly as possible.
Changes to our principal risks
As part of the Group’s risk review process,
some of the Group’s principal risks have
evolved during the year:
Risk heat map
The Board has identified 12 principal risks that it considers material
to the Group’s performance. They have been mapped on a
residual risk basis considering likelihood and impact.
1
Market conditions
2
Safety, Health & Environment
3
Supply chain
4
Customer service and quality
5
Build cost management
6
Information security and
business continuity
7
Attracting and retaining our skilled people
8
Solvency and liquidity
9
Laws, policies and regulations
10
Climate change
11
Land availability and planning
12
Combustible materials
1
2
9
5
8
10
11
6
7
3
4
12
Increasing likelihood
Increasing impact
Principal risks and uncertainties – How we manage risk continued
Market conditions
Increasing trend
Supply chain
Reducing trend
Customer service and quality
Reducing trend
Build cost management
Increasing trend
Attracting and retaining our skilled people
Reducing trend
Solvency and liquidity
Increasing trend
Laws, policies and regulations
Increasing trend
Land availability and planning
Increasing trend
Board assessment
The Board confirms that it has performed a
robust assessment of the Group’s principal
and emerging risks, with consideration of
the long term.
Actions are in place over the long term to
address specific risks where necessary,
reducing the level of residual risk.
Crest Nicholson 36 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Principal risks and uncertainties
Our principal risks
Market conditions
1
Risk description
A decline in macro-economic conditions in
the UK, which negatively impacts the UK
residential property market and reduces
the ability for people to buy homes, either
through unemployment or low employment,
constraints on mortgage availability.
Decreased sales volumes occurring from
a drop in housing demand, could see
an increasing number of units held as
unreserved and part exchange stock with
apotential loss realised on final sales.
Changes to regulations and taxes, for
example Stamp Duty Land Tax and the
impact of Government schemes such as
Help to Buy and Equity Loan.
Actions/mitigations
We continually evaluate our strategy
which we can flex and adjust as demand
profiles change.
Regular sales forecasts and cost reviews to
manage potential impact on sales volumes.
Forward sales, land expenditure and work-in-
progress are all carefully monitored to ensure
they are aligned to levels of demand.
Our Multi Channel Approach gives us access
to a range of tenure options and earning
resilience in changing market conditions.
We focus on strategic purchase of sites,
continued development of shared ownership
models and engagement with a variety of
incentive schemes.
We actively develop our sales oering by
introducing new and innovative products to
reflect the nature of market conditions.
Development in the year
Demand for housing has deteriorated
during the year, with significant economic
headwinds. Mortgage borrowing has
become significantly more expensive with
noGovernment support for first-time buyers.
We have significantly reduced land activity
during the year and have reduced the
Group’s overhead position. We have
incorporated the newly created East Anglia
division into its existing Eastern division with
revised boundaries.
We continued to build our pipeline of trusted
partners and have negotiated several bulk
deals on appropriate commercial terms with
partners which will provide volume delivery
infuture years.
We have introduced a series of new sales
products and sales schemes that reflect
current market conditions such as Smart
Ownand Family Cashback.
The Group has adequate liquidity to deal
with all plausible downside market scenarios
and continues to focus and monitor its cash
position, ensuring build costs and capital
outlay match sales demand.
Residual High Appetite Medium Movement in year Increasing
Link to our stakeholders
Investors Our people Supply chain Customers Communities and environment Government and other bodies
Safety, Health &
Environment (SHE)
2
Risk description
A significant health and safety event
could result in a fatality, serious injury or a
dangerous situation to an individual.
Significant environmental damage could
be caused by operations on-site or in our
oces (for example, water contamination
from pollution).
Lack of recognition of the importance of the
wellbeing of employees.
These incidents or situations could have
an adverse eect on people aected by
our actions, our reputation and ability to
secure public contracts and/or, if illegal,
prosecution or significant financial losses.
Actions/mitigations
We have eective SHE management systems
in place with increased authority for divisional
build managers and Group SHE advisors
to undertake incident investigations and
implement follow up actions.
We use external independent safety auditors
to conduct regular site safety reviews as
appropriate and without warning.
We have a network of mental health
first aiders and a dedicated Employee
Assistance Programme.
SHE performance is a bonus metric target
used across the Group.
Where appropriate, interim risk mitigation
solutions have been deployed in
buildings where fire safety concerns have
been identified.
Development in the year
We have increased focus to ensure
compliance with subcontractor Risk
Assessment and Method Statements (RAMS).
We have expanded reporting of safety
performance to help assess root causes.
We have continued to expand our training
and communications across our build teams
and provide regular safety bulletins and
guidance updates.
We have expanded our network of mental
health first aiders across our divisions.
Delivering on our commitments contained
in the Developer Remediation Contract, the
Group has continued to identify and risk
assess any buildings impacted by possible
safety issues.
Residual Medium Appetite Low Movement in year No change
Link to our stakeholders
Our people Supply chain Customers Communities and environment
Crest Nicholson 37 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Supply chain
3
Risk description
Changing production levels across the
industry put pressure on our materials
supply chain.
The industry struggles to attract the next
generation of talent into skilled trade
professions. The labour market may not have
the knowledge and skills required to deliver
modern methods of construction projects.
Materials availability can be impacted by
changes in demand, rising energy prices
and dislocation in supply chains due to
external events.
There may be a risk of suppliers and
subcontractors facing insolvency due
toadverse economic conditions.
Actions/mitigations
Established long-term relationships with our
supply chain partners through Group trading
agreements and multi-year subcontractor
framework agreements.
We engage in dialogue with major suppliers
to understand critical supply chain risks and
respond eectively.
We have developed eective procurement
schedules to mitigate supply challenges.
Dierent construction methods are
considered such as timber frame or using
alternative materials such as concrete bricks.
Development in the year
Access to site labour and materials through
the supply chain has improved throughout
the year due to reducing inflation and lower
production levels. We continued to focus on
price competitiveness through re-tendering,
quality and improved product selection.
Where possible and appropriate we forward
order materials to secure supply and also
utilise alternative products if they are
available and it is appropriate to do so.
Residual Medium Appetite Medium/Low Movement in year Reducing
4
Risk description
Customer service and build quality falls
below our required standards, resulting in
reduction of reputation and trust, which
could impact sales and volumes.
Unforeseen product safety or quality
issues or latent defects emerge due to new
construction methods.
Failure to eectively implement or comply
with new regulations on build quality
or customer service requirements and
respond to emerging technologies.
Actions/mitigations
We continue to focus on enhancing build
quality, achieving high customer satisfaction
ratings and a retained commitment to
excellent placemaking.
Enhanced quality and build stage
inspections to monitor adherence to our
quality standards.
Our Legacy Collection house type range
established that reduces complexity and
drives improvements in quality.
There is a central team of quality assurance
and customer relationship managers to cover
all divisions.
Customer service and quality performance is
a bonus metric target used across the Group.
Development in the year
We have continued to enhance our
quality processes and have recruited
additional resources to support the
quality improvements.
We have developed processes and
introduced new technology to support new
regulatory requirements for the Future
Homes Standard – Part L.
We implemented the requirements of the
New Homes Quality Code in February
2023 and made significant changes to our
customer service processes and systems
which are subject to further ongoing review
and monitoring.
We have introduced a wider range of
options and extras for customers and
deployed a 24-hour web chat service along
with online home demonstrations.
Residual High/Medium Appetite Low Movement in year Reducing
Customer service
and quality
Principal risks and uncertainties Our principal risks continued
Link to our stakeholders
Our people Supply chain Customers Communities and environment Government and other bodies
Link to our stakeholders
Supply chain Customers Communities and environment
Crest Nicholson 38 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Build cost management
5
Risk description
Build cost inflation and unforeseen cost
increases driven by demands in the supply
chain or failure to implement adequate cost
control systems.
Lack of awareness and understanding
of external factors that may impact
build costs including complex planning
permissions and emerging sustainability
and environmental regulations.
A lack of quality in the build process could
expose the Group to increased costs,
reduced selling price and volume, and
impact our reputation.
Actions/mitigations
We benchmark our costs against existing
sites to ensure rates remain competitive.
A fair and competitive tender process is in
place and we are committed to paying our
suppliers and subcontractors promptly.
There are regular divisional build cost review
processes and site-based quality reviews.
We continue to investigate alternative
sources of supply where possible and utilise
alternative production methods or materials
where it is appropriate to do so.
Development in the year
We have continued to monitor our
build costs closely, ensuring eective
management of inventory levels and
competitive re-tendering through the
supply chain.
We completed the implementation of
COINS, our new ERP platform. This has
enhanced the reporting and visibility of
build costs across the Group. We are
enhancing the independent assurance of
build costs reporting through a centralised
second line commercial team providing
periodic review and advisory support to
the divisions.
Residual High Appetite Medium/Low Movement in year Increasing
6
Risk description
Cyber security risks such as data breaches,
ransomware or phishing attacks leading to
the loss of operational systems, market-
sensitive information or other critical data
which risks non-compliance with data
privacy requirements.
This in turn could result in a higher risk of
fraud and, as a result, financial penalties
and an impact to reputation.
Actions/mitigations
We employ network security measures and
intrusion detection monitoring, including virus
protection on all computers and systems,
and carry out annual security-breach tests.
We utilise customer relationship management
systems for storing sensitive data to prevent
negligent misuse by employees. We operate
in a cloud environment with resilient IT
providers, reducing centralised and physical
risk exposure.
This is complemented by employee training
on data protection and internet security,
data classification, retention policies and
toolsets with appropriate and responsive
procedures embedded to respond to data
privacy matters; and IT disaster recovery
and business continuity plans. The IT Cyber
Security and Data Sub-Board Committee,
chaired by the Group Finance Director meets
throughout the year to address cyber security
matters, assess threat levels and develop
appropriate policies and procedures.
We are Cyber Essentials Plus certified and
are subject to regular external and internal
audit review.
Development in the year
We continued to utilise a Security
Operations Centre to monitor our networks
and have enhanced our security policies
and procedures with further training
for employees.
We have also provided executive level
training to the Board on Cyber security.
We continued to review emerging risks,
such as Artificial Intelligence and have
developed policies to ensure appropriate
use in the organisation.
Residual Medium Appetite Low Movement in year No change
Information security and
business continuity
Link to our stakeholders
Supply chain Customers
Link to our stakeholders
Our people Customers
Crest Nicholson 39 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Principal risks and uncertainties Our principal risks continued
7
Risk description
An increasing skills gap in the industry at all
levels resulting in diculty with recruiting
the right and diverse mix of people for
vacant positions.
Employee turnover and requirement
to induct and embed new employees,
alongside the cost of wages increasing as a
result of inflation.
Loss of knowledge within the Group which
could result in ineciencies, productivity
loss, delays to business operations,
increasing costs, and an overuse or reliance
on consultants and the supply chain.
Ensuring we have the right culture and
environment to attract and retain talent.
Actions/mitigations
Employee engagement surveys to
enable the Board and ELT to understand
employee feedback.
Continual focus on improving flexible
and agile working arrangements to
support employees.
Programmes of work to develop robust
succession plans and improve diversity and
inclusion across the Group.
We monitor pay structures and market trends
to ensure we remain competitive against
our competitors.
We monitor employee turnover, absence
statistics and feedback from exit interviews.
Development in the year
Continued to evolve our people strategy and
have expanded the range of leadership and
personal skills training across the Group.
We became Gold Accredited through The
5% Club in respect to our recruitment and
development of trainees.
Developed our diversity and inclusion policies
and initiatives and have held a number of
executive sponsored Anity Group meetings.
Established the Women in the
Workplace forum.
We have implemented a new enterprise
wide talent management, recruitment,
HR and payroll system this year.
Residual Medium Appetite Medium/Low Movement in year Reducing
Solvency and liquidity
8
Risk description
Cash generation for the Group is a
key part of our strategy and our cash
headroom could be aected by economic
pressures that result in delayed receipts
and potentially lower sales in the short to
medium term.
Commitments to significant land and
build obligations that are made ahead of
revenue certainty.
Reduction in margins as average
selling prices fall, inability to restructure
appropriately and unsustainable levels of
work-in-progress.
Actions/mitigations
Cash performance is measured against
forecast with a variance analysis issued
weekly. Cash performance is also considered
in detail at a divisional board level.
We scrutinise the cash terms of land
transactions. Private Rented Sector and
bulk sales oer us the potential for early
cash inflow.
The Group has available the use of a £250m
Sustainability Linked Revolving Credit Facility
(RCF).
We generally control strategic land rather
than own it and have limited capital tied up on
the balance sheet. These sites are subject to
regular review and diligent appraisal before
being drawn down.
Development in the year
While net cash has reduced in the year,
the Group continued to benefit from a
strong balance sheet with diverse sources
of funding.
We continued to stress test the Group’s
financial resilience for various scenarios
and are satisfied that adequate funding is
in place. We have maintained a disciplined
focus on cash performance and capital
allocation throughout the year.
Residual High Appetite Low Movement in year Increasing
Attracting and retaining
ourskilled people
Link to our stakeholders
Our people
Link to our stakeholders
Investors Our people Supply chain
Crest Nicholson 40 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Laws, policies and
regulations
9
Risk description
The housebuilding industry is subject to
complex regulation, policy changes and
Government intervention.
Future regulatory changes could impact
our ability to make medium and longer-
term decisions.
Failure to eectively implement new
regulations including the Future Homes
Standard, the Environment Act 2021, New
Homes Quality Code and the Building
Safety Act 2022 could impact the Group.
Actions/mitigations
We engage with the Government directly and
through the HBF, various memberships of
Industry groups and build relationships in key
local authority areas.
We continue to assess and plan for emerging
regulation and developments in readiness for
potential regulatory change.
Development in the year
The pace of regulatory reform has continued
to increase in the housebuilding industry.
We are developing our operating framework
to support various regulatory requirements.
Implemented the New Homes Quality Code
and relaunched the standard housing range
in the spring to comply with Phase 1 of the
Future Homes standard.
Residual High Appetite Medium Movement in year Increasing
Climate change
10
Risk description
The Group will need to further enhance its
sustainable practices and processes as we
transition to a net-zero carbon business
by 2045 and continue to meet evolving
Government regulations and growing
investor expectations.
Climate change could impact our business
through transition and physical risks.
Transition risks include increasing regulatory
change, increased carbon pricing and shifts
in stakeholder preferences.
Physical risks are direct impacts from
a changing climate including rising
temperatures and changing weather patterns.
Failure to manage climate-related risks could
lead to additional costs, build programme
delays and damage to our reputation.
Actions/mitigations
Our Sustainability Committee oversees
our sustainability strategy, including our
approach to climate change. The Committee
monitors performance against our climate
targets and assesses climate-related risks
and opportunities.
We are members of the Future Homes Hub,
an industry-wide initiative to support the
implementation of the Future Homes Delivery
Plan to meet climate and environmental
targets. We also have internal workstreams to
plan for new regulations, including the Future
Homes Standard.
Near and long-term science-based targets
are in place, driving action to reduce
GHG emissions.
Executive Directors have GHG emission
reduction targets within their Long-Term
Incentive Plan.
Development in the year
Implemented the interim update to Part L
of the Building Regulations, which requires
a 31% reduction in carbon emissions
compared to the prior regulations.
Continued to collaborate with our energy
assessors, supply chain and wider industry
to prepare for the Future Homes Standard.
Our Sustainability Linked RCF incorporated
targets to reduce GHG emissions
associated with our operations and the
use of our homes. We achieved both RCF
climate-related targets.
Residual Medium Appetite Low Movement in year No change
Link to our stakeholders
Investors Our people Supply chain Customers Communities and environment Government and other bodies
Link to our stakeholders
Investors Supply chain Customers Communities and environment Government and other bodies
Crest Nicholson 41 Annual Report andnancial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Principal risks and uncertainties Our principal risks continued
11
Risk description
Maintaining a supply of suitable strategic
and consented land at the right economic
terms to support our growth ambitions.
Acquired land is delayed in the planning
process where local authorities and public
sector resources are constrained.
The regulatory planning and environmental
requirements continue to evolve with the
national policy framework developments.
Environmental requirements such as
nutrients, water neutrality and biodiversity
obligations are increasing. This increases
the challenge of providing quality and
aordable homes in the locations required.
Actions/mitigations
Expertise within our Land teams to ensure
we acquire sites in the best locations
and that allow us to demonstrate our
placemaking credentials.
Formal relationships with key land suppliers,
landowners and agents and local authorities.
Land acquisitions are subject to formal
appraisal and viability assessment prior to bid
submission and exchange of contracts.
The planning status of all our sites are
regularly reviewed.
We undertake close consultation with the
Government on planning reform.
Development in the year
Our strategy has increased focus on
achieving planning consent on land under
our control as we have reduced land
acquisitions and acquiring new sites.
The planning process continues to be
highly complex and time consuming with
ongoing demands relating to aordable
housing, Section 106 obligations and the
community infrastructure levy. There has
been a particular challenge in some of our
divisions regarding nutrients and water
neutrality which has impacted the speed
of planning approvals. These complexities
increase the cost of development and
the time taken to move land through the
planning process, which is also impacted
by resource constraints in local authority
planning departments.
Residual High Appetite Medium/Low Movement in year Increasing
Combustible materials
12
Risk description
Failure to plan and implement the changes
required by the Government in respect of
combustible materials and fire safety in a
timely manner, which could significantly
impact our reputation.
This is a complex area where it is often
dicult to identify and implement remedies
quickly. The rapidly changing landscape
of regulatory guidance and the need
to engage with multiple stakeholders
contribute to this complexity, as does the
limited availability of qualified resource
to oversee work performed. Given this,
costs can be dicult to estimate and could
be subject to considerable variability and
Government legislation, or regulation
could further change increasing the
scope of legacy buildings and required
remedial works.
Actions/mitigations
A dedicated specialist team is in place
with controls and processes in respect of
combustible materials. There is a regular
review process in place which is overseen by
the Chief Executive, Group Finance Director
and the internal project team responsible for
this area.
There is a detailed risk register of all
schemes under review including any
safety considerations, recent customer or
stakeholder correspondence and considers
how the Group may choose to respond.
In addition, the central team assesses
whether faulty workmanship or design was
a factor in the potential remedial works, and,
if appropriate, seeks to recover these costs
directly from the subcontractor or consultant
involved, or through engagement of external
legal counsel.
Development in the year
The Group continued to review the risk
register of legacy buildings in scope,
assessing the latest guidelines against
each aected building, advice from
technical or legal advisors along with
relevant notifications from a variety of
stakeholders. We monitor and report
progress of remedial work to DLUHC on a
periodic basis. Management has considered
the progress of any remedial works and
adjusted the financial provision to reflect the
Group’s best estimate of any future costs.
We continue to review the appropriateness
of our combustible materials provision.
The Board signed the Developers
Remediation contract and we are now
contractually obligated to the pledge.
Residual Medium Appetite Low Movement in year No change
Land availability
and planning
Link to our stakeholders
Investors Customers Communities and environment Government and other bodies
Link to our stakeholders
Supply chain Customers Communities and environment Government and other bodies
Crest Nicholson 42 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Against a backdrop of increasing GHG
emissions and the growing challenge to
limit temperature rise to 1.5°C, we remain
committed to reducing our GHG emissions.
Our target is aligned with a 1.5°C trajectory,
aiming for net-zero across our value chain by
2045. This cannot be delivered in isolation,
and we are collaborating throughout our
value chain in support of decarbonising
the business.
Recognising climate change as a principal
risk for the Group since FY21, we published
our voluntary TCFD disclosure that year,
followed by our first comprehensive
disclosure in FY22. Ongoing collaboration
with external climate change experts
reinforces our commitment to enhance our
climate risk analysis. Given the uncertainties
surrounding the potential future impacts
of climate change, we will continue to
adapt our response as scientific and
economic understandings evolve, alongside
advancements in methodologies and risk
management tools.
The following pages detail our disclosures
aligned with the TCFD recommendations.
In accordance with Listing Rule 9.8.6R,
our consistency with the 11 TCFD
recommendations is outlined in the table
below, with references to page numbers
for additional information. Set out below is
the progress achieved in the past year and
the actions planned for FY24 to enhance
our approach.
In our assessment of consistency, we
voluntarily referred to the ‘Implementing
the Recommendations of the Task Force
on Climate-related Financial Disclosures
document published by the TCFD in
October 2021.
Further information on the TCFD is
available on the Financial Stability
Board’s website www.fsb-tcfd.org
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures
We are focused on reducing greenhouse gas emissions while
responding to the potential risks and opportunities relating to
achanging climate.
The table below provides the location for content related to the TCFD recommendations
TCFD pillar Recommended disclosure Page(s)
Governance
Disclose the
organisation’s
governance around
climate-related risks
andopportunities.
a) Board oversight
44
b) Managements role
44
Strategy
Disclose the actual
andpotential impacts
of climate-related
risksand opportunities
on the organisation’s
businesses, strategy,
and financial planning
where such information
ismaterial.
a) Risks and opportunities
4547
b) Impact on organisation
4547
c) Resilience of strategy considering
climate scenario analysis
4547
Risk management
Disclose how the
organisation identifies,
assesses and manages
climate-related risks.
a) Risk identification and
assessment process
48
b) Risk management processes
48
c) Integration into overall
risk management
48
Metrics and targets
Disclose the metrics
andtargets used to
assess and manage
relevant climate-related
risks and opportunities
where such information
is material.
a) Climate-related metrics
49–50
b) Scope 1, 2, 3 GHG emissions
49–50
c) Climate-related targets
49–50
Consistency with TCFD recommendations:
Not consistent Partially consistent Consistent
FY23 progress
Continued to engage with our
supply chain on climate-related
issues and preparation for the Future
Homes Standard
Conducted whole life carbon
analysis on a selection of our Legacy
Collection homes
Evolved our climate scenario analysis
to gain better insight into potential
risks and opportunities
Continued progress in reducing
GHG emissions.
FY24 areas of focus
Further investigation, and trialling
of technologies to support the
delivery of the forthcoming Future
Homes Standard
Continue to engage with our supply
chain and wider industry to support
improved GHG emission data and
decarbonisation initiatives
Development of transition plan
Continue to evolve the assessment
and quantification of our climate-
related risks and opportunities.
Crest Nicholson 43 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Governance
A. Board’s oversight of climate-related
risks and opportunities
The Board is responsible for risk
management, including climate-related risks
and opportunities. This oversight involves
semi-annual reviews and updates to the
Group’s principal risks. Climate change
remains one of the Group’s principal risks
and is governed by our Risk Management
Framework detailed on page 35.
The Board receives updates on the Group’s
approach to climate change and sustainability
matters. This encompasses progress against
climate-related KPIs, including our science-
based targets. During the year the Board
received a comprehensive update on current
and emerging environmental regulations,
performance against our targets and our
transition to net-zero.
Supporting the Board in its governance are
three Board Committees which oversee
sustainability matters. See diagram below.
With delegated authority from the Board
and Executive Committee, the Sustainability
Committee is responsible for overseeing
the development and delivery of strategic
aims and initiatives to enhance sustainability
performance. Chaired by our Chief
Executive, it met four times during FY23 and
provided regular updates to the Board and
Executive Committee.
B. Management’s role in assessing and
managing climate-related risks and
opportunities
Our Group Operations Director, with
executive responsibility for sustainability
and climate-related risk, is a member
of both the Executive Committee and
Sustainability Committee. Overseeing the
Group’s disciplines supporting climate-
related outputs, the Group Operations
Director is responsible for the assessment
and management of climate-related
risks, alongside the realisation of
business opportunities.
Regular reports are submitted to the
Board and Executive Committee meetings,
providing updates on performance against
climate-related targets and highlighting
forthcoming regulatory changes.
The Group Operations function possesses in-
depth knowledge of climate-related matters,
including current and emerging regulation.
Team members actively participate in
external working groups, including the Future
Homes Hub and Supply Chain Sustainability
School, fostering knowledge development
and industry engagement.
At a divisional level, responsibility is assigned
for considering how climate-related risks and
opportunities may impact developments.
Divisions report on these aspects within
their divisional risk registers, which undergo
semi-annual reviews as part of the Group’s
Risk Management Framework. Climate-
related considerations, such as flood risk
assessments during site selection, are taken
into account at the project level.
The diagram below provides an overview of
our governance framework and how climate-
related matters are considered throughout
the Group.
Governance framework and climate touch points
Board and
Executive
Committee
oversight
Audit and Risk Committee
Conducts formal reviews of principal
and emerging risks semi-annually,
including climate-related risks
Oversees the Internal Audit
Plan which includes climate-
related audits.
Remuneration Committee
Responsible for including climate-
related targets within employees’
remuneration arrangements
Approves climate-related targets in
long-term pay incentives for ELT and
senior management.
Nomination Committee
Considers a broad range of skills
and experiences the Board will
need. Climate change experience is
considered as part of this process.
Sustainability Committee
Met four times in FY23
Oversees the development
and delivery of strategic aims
and initiatives to improve
sustainability performance.
SHE Committee
Met five times in FY23
Oversees the management of the
Group’s SHE risks and SHE strategy,
including environmental risk
management on-site.
Divisional boards
Meet monthly and responsible for
key risks, including climate change,
within the division. Reviews and
updates the divisional risk register
semi-annually.
Executive Committee
Considers the Group’s principal risks and oversees the divisional risk process, with support from functional representatives.
Climate Risk Working Group
Responsible for assessing climate-
related risks and opportunities
Membership composition includes
representatives from the Finance,
Procurement, Sustainability,
Technical and Internal Audit teams.
Group Operations team
Subject matter experts on
sustainability and climate change
Responsible for developing the
Group’s sustainability strategy and
supports the divisions in
driving its implementation.
Functional Forums
Meet quarterly and are responsible
for delivering initiatives, achieving
targets and embedding procedures
within the Group
Functional Forums include SHE &
Build, Technical, Commercial, Sales
& Marketing, Land & Planning and
Customer Service.
Management
oversight
TCFD continued
The Board
Oversight of the Group’s sustainability strategy and its performance
Overall responsibility for risk management, including climate-related risks and opportunities.
Crest Nicholson 44 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategy
A. Climate-related risks and opportunities
identified over the short, medium and long
term
While we are taking action to reduce our
GHG emissions across our value chain,
climate change presents a range of risks and
opportunities to our business. The extent
and severity of risks will vary depending
on the actions taken both at UK and
international level.
The eects of climate change and how they
impact our business are both uncertain
and evolving. Over the last two years the
Group has engaged external consultants,
Verco Advisory Services, to support the
identification of potential climate-related risks
and opportunities alongside the application
of scenario analysis to understand how the
risks and opportunities may arise over the
short, medium and long term.
Scenario analysis
Scenario analysis supports the Group’s
understanding of potential climate change
impacts on our business. It is important to
note that climate scenarios are not intended
to be forecasts but rather hypothetical future
states designed to be plausible, improving
our comprehension of possible climate
outcomes and their potential implications
for our operations. This in turn informs our
strategy and business planning, increasing
our resilience to climate change.
In accordance with TCFD recommendations,
we have identified climate-related risks and
opportunities against:
Transition risks: related to the transition
to a low carbon economy to avoid
the worst physical impacts of climate
change. Examples of transition risks
include regulatory changes, carbon
taxation, new technology and shifting
stakeholder expectations.
Physical risks: resulting from a changing
climate are broken down by acute risk (event-
driven, including increased severity of storms
and floods) and chronic risk (longer-term
shifts in climate patterns, including higher
temperatures, rising sea levels, chronic
heatwaves and droughts).
The risk management section on pages 48
to 49 details our processes for identifying
climate-related risks and opportunities.
In FY23 we retained the climate scenarios
from the previous year, each representing
distinct pathways:
Orderly transition: well-coordinated early
action to achieve a net-zero economy by
2050 with limited warming of 1.5°C.
Disorderly transition: late and disruptive
action to limit warming to below 2°C.
Hot house earth: late action leads to a
warming of around 4°C by 2100 bringing
increased exposure to physical risks.
The information on pages 47 to 48 describes
the primary climate-related risks and
opportunities we have identified and sets out
our management’s response to each one.
Time horizons
We have considered climate-related risks and
opportunities over three time horizons:
Short term (0–3 years)
Medium term (3–10 years)
Long term (10 years plus).
The time horizons have been selected to
allow the Group to consider multiple risks
and opportunities, including instances
where physical and transition risks are
more dominant. The table below provides
further detail on why these time horizons
were selected.
These scenarios encompass a range of
future climate states with varying transition
and physical impacts. Leveraging insights
from our external consultants and utilising
a diverse set of internal and external data
sources, including global, regional and local
datasets, we applied a range of assumptions
to determine potential climate change
impacts. An overview of each scenario and
their specific impacts on our business is
detailed in the table on the next page.
Time horizon Time period Description
Short term 0–3 years This covers the current operating climate and aligns with our business planning cycle.
Existing legislation is likely to be in place for most of this time horizon.
Medium term 3–10 years This covers the period where legislation currently under consideration is more likely
totakeeect and have an impact on the business. It also aligns with the time period
forour2030 science-based targets.
Long term 10 years plus This period is challenging to predict. While it is clear the climate has already changed,
andthis is going to continue, the physical risks relating to climate change are likely to have
amore significant impact in the long term.
Considering risks out to 2050 prompted exploratory discussions on the likelihood and
impact of a range of risks and opportunities that are dierent or more severe thanthose
experienced today.
Crest Nicholson 45 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Climate scenarios summary
Scenario 1:
Orderly transition
Scenario 2:
Disorderly transition
Scenario 3:
Hot house earth
Scenario source SSP1/RCP1.9-2.6 SSP1/2/RCP2.6 SSP5/RCP8.5
Scenario description Well coordinated and eective
global response to climate change.
Rapid progress in the 2020s limits
warming to around 1.5°C by 2100.
The global response to climate
change is disorderly and annual
emissions do not decrease until
2030. The pace of regulatory
change is more manageable in the
short term but it results in faster,
stronger changes to limit warming
to below 2°C by 2100.
The global response to climate
change is poorly coordinated and
ineective, resulting in warming of
over 4°C by 2100.
Transition risk Moderate High Low
Physical risk Low Low/moderate High
Business impacts Products and services: climate-related risks and opportunities influence our product development.
Under scenarios 1 and 2 we anticipate increased emissions reduction regulations. Conversely, fewer regulatory
requirements are expected under scenario 3.
Supply chain: our supply chain, responsible for approximately one-third of our carbon footprint, faces potential
challenges in the transition to net-zero. Scenarios 1 and 2 anticipate higher carbon prices, leading to increased
material costs. Additionally, there may be heightened demand for lower carbon products, potentially aecting
costs. A disorderly transition may result in a steeper rise in carbon prices. In scenario 3, the supply chain is
expected to experience the most severe physical impacts, including acute events like storms and chronic
changes, potentially necessitating supplier relocations and causing productivity reductions.
Operations: under scenarios 1 and 2, we anticipate increased energy and fuel costs, driven by rising carbon
prices and heightened demand for lower carbon alternatives. In scenario 3, our sites may face greater
disruption due to increased risks of severe events, including heatwaves and more frequent and severe storms.
Additionally, flood risk is expected to rise, potentially limiting available land for development.
Access to capital: in scenarios 1 and 2, accessing aordable capital may become more challenging unless we
can eectively demonstrate our climate risk management.
Customers and markets: in scenarios 1 and 2, there may be greater demand for lower carbon homes.
To successfully transition to new low carbon homes with added technologies, high levels of customer
engagement are crucial. In scenario 3, customers are more likely to be aected by physical impacts.
B. Impact of climate-related risks and
opportunities on business, strategy and
financial planning
In FY23 our climate-related risk analysis
identified potential implications on our business,
including on our products and services,
operations, supply chain and market perception.
To address these risks and capitalise on
opportunities, we remain committed to reducing
GHG emissions throughout our value chain while
adapting our response to evolving regulations
and other climate-related impacts.
In FY23 we evolved our home designs,
prioritising enhancements in energy eciency
and reducing GHG emissions. We set a
requirement for all houses in our Legacy
Collection to achieve a minimum Energy
Performance Certificate (EPC) rating of B.
We continue to research and develop solutions
to achieve the Future Homes Standard and the
anticipated additional build costs are accounted
for in our new project acquisition appraisals.
While maintaining a high level decarbonisation
roadmap consistent with our science-based
targets, we recognise the need for a more
detailed net-zero transition plan. In FY24 we
are planning to produce a comprehensive
plan, guided by the Transition Plan Taskforce
1 Shared Socioeconomic Pathways (SSPs) describe possible future development pathways for society. Representative Concentration Pathways (RCPs) are trajectories of greenhouse gas
concentrations that provide a broad range of climate outcomes. The combination of SSP scenarios and RCP climate projections provides a framework to consider potential future climate impacts.
recommendations. This plan will provide a more
granular view of our path to net-zero emissions.
C. Resilience of strategy, taking into
consideration dierent climate-related
scenarios, including 2°C or lower
We have considered the potential for the
Group’s financial statements to be impacted
by climate change. Our assessment indicates
that there is no material financial risk to our
business in the short term. Our strategy, which
includes research and development of lower
carbon homes, remains relevant considering
changing climate risks.
Physical risks associated with climate change
will increase, particularly under the high
carbon hot house earth scenario. Risks such as
flooding, overheating and disruption to site and
supply chain activities are anticipated to grow
over time, with a greater impact in the longer
term. There is significant uncertainty about
the extent and impact of these risks to the
Group and we continue to assess and monitor
these risks. Although we do not believe that
we are significantly exposed to physical risks
in the short term, we continue to take action to
mitigate risk through flood risk and overheating
assessments and regular dialogue with our
key suppliers.
We believe that transition risks pose the
most substantial threat in the medium term,
notably the potential for an increasing price
of carbon. Carbon taxes are expected to
rise under scenarios 1 and 2 and we are
engaging with our suppliers to gain further
insight in this area. While we acknowledge
exposure to some short-term climate-related
risks, including emerging regulations, their
impact is not considered material due to the
mitigations the Group has in place.
The anticipated costs related to the delivery
of the Future Homes Standard are included
in new project acquisition appraisals.
Further information on our climate-related
risks and opportunities is provided overleaf.
There has been no material impact on the
financial reporting judgements and estimates
applied in the preparation of the FY23
Annual Report and financial statements.
Additional details can be found in our accounting
policies on pages 115 to 121. We remain
committed to evolving our assessment and
quantification of climate-related risks and
opportunities over time. This includes horizon
scanning and engagement with the divisions
and relevant functions to identify any additional
emerging risks and opportunities.
TCFD continued
Crest Nicholson 46 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Transition risks
Risk description Financial driver Management response
Policy and legal
Impact of carbon pricing mechanisms on internal operations and supply chain
Carbon taxes and other pricing mechanisms
serve as a policy tool to curb GHG emissions.
This provides a policy lever for governments
to transition economies towards net-zero.
The escalation of carbon prices has the potential to
impact our direct fuel and energy consumption and
those associated with our supply chain.
Highest impact scenario: Disorderly transition
Increased cost of sales
Time horizon: Medium to
long term
Potential impact under
disorderly transition:
Short term: Low
Medium term: Low
Long term: Moderate
We are committed to reducing our GHG emissions
across all scopes in line with our science-based
targets. We are engaging with supply chain partners
to reduce upstream scope 3 emissions, reducing
the impact of potential carbon taxes and other
pricing mechanisms.
Emerging regulations
Emerging regulations targeting emissions
reduction poses a potential impact on our home
specifications. The Group proactively considered
additional build costs linked to the Future Homes
Standard. Further low carbon requirements
mandated by Government or Local Authorities
may arise. Additionally, we anticipate increased
reporting requirements and potential future
regulations addressing embodied carbon.
Highest impact scenario: Disorderly transition
Increased cost of sales
Time horizon: Short to long term
Potential impact under
disorderly transition:
Short term: Low
Medium term: Moderate
Long term: High
Relevant departments review and respond to
potential regulatory changes and consultations.
Our active engagement with Government, the
HBF and the Future Homes Hub enhances
our understanding and ability to implement
future policies. We collaborate with Local
Authorities, partners and expert consultants
to achieve consensus and cost-eective
outcomes. Anticipated costs related to the Future
Homes Standard are included in new project
acquisition appraisals.
Technology
Transition to low carbon technology
As we adopt lower carbon technologies in our
homes, customers may encounter unfamiliar
systems. Rising demand could strain supply and
result in a shortage of skilled labour for installation
and maintenance, potentially leading to additional
after-sales costs. Additionally, certain locations
may face electrical capacity constraints on the grid,
necessitating infrastructure upgrades.
Highest impact scenario: Disorderly transition
Increased cost of sales and
potential for reduced revenue
through project delays
Time horizon: Medium to
long term
Potential impact under
disorderly transition:
Short term: Low
Medium term: Low
Long term: Low
We engage with our supply chain to review low
carbon technologies for our homes and we are
trialling low carbon heating solutions prior to the
implementation of the Future Homes Standard.
We collaborate with Local Authorities and energy
providers to address potential electrical capacity
constraints. By engaging in early discussions,
we aim to anticipate and plan for infrastructure
requirements early in the planning process.
Market
Increasing cost of raw materials
Growing global demand for materials with lower
embodied carbon, driven by governments and
corporations seeking emissions reduction, poses a
potential risk. This heightened demand may lead to
increased prices for raw materials, such as timber.
Escalating physical risks may also lead to disruption
within the supply chain, further impacting material
availability and costs.
Highest impact scenario: Disorderly transition
Increased cost of sales
Time horizon: Medium to
long term
Potential impact under
disorderly transition:
Short term: Low
Medium term: Moderate
Long term: Moderate
We regularly engage with our supply chain partners
to mitigate material availability risks and assess their
climate risk and sustainability performance.
Crest Nicholson 47 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Risk Management
A. Processes for identifying and assessing
climate-related risks
Climate-related risks and opportunities are
reviewed as part of our Group-wide Risk
Management Framework. Our governance
structure, including the Board, Executive
Committee and divisional boards conduct
formal risk assessments semi-annually.
In FY22 we conducted a comprehensive
climate change risk assessment in
collaboration with external consultants
and our Climate Change Working Group.
This involved a peer review, internal
expertise and consultant support to develop
an extensive list of climate-related risks and
opportunities. Each risk was evaluated based
on likelihood, potential impact to the Group
and the relevant timeframe.
In FY23 we used the same external
consultant to conduct a review, utilising
qualitative and quantitative modelling
techniques to assess the impacts of climate
change over short, medium and long-term
time periods. Our risk assessment considered
current and emerging regulations, evolving
consumer preferences, modelling on physical
climate change impacts and potential future
carbon pricing mechanisms. The outcome
of this review was a short list of prioritised
risks and opportunities, accompanied by
gathering information to quantify their
potential financial impacts under dierent
climate scenarios.
B. Processes for managing
climate-related risks
Climate change is classified as a principal
risk, underscoring its significance to our
strategy. To eectively manage the most
material climate-related risks, we leverage a
combination of internal expertise from across
the Group and external specialists.
TCFD continued
Physical risks
Risk description Financial driver Management response
Chronic physical
Rising mean temperatures
Higher temperatures could increase the risk of
overheating within our homes. As a result, there
may be greater mitigation requirements that could
impact the specification of our homes.
Highest impact scenario: Hot house earth
Increased cost of sales
Time horizon: Long term
Potential impact under hot
house earth:
Short term: Low
Medium term: Low
Long term: Moderate
Our Group Technical team collaborates closely with
energy consultants to mitigate the risk of overheating
through thoughtful design considerations.
Key factors such as window size, orientation and
ventilation are reviewed to limit solar gains in the
summer while providing adequate means to remove
heat from the home.
Changing precipitation patterns
Changing precipitation patterns may lead to
more frequent occurrences of droughts and
floods. This may impact planning requirements,
necessitating greater focus on flood mitigation and
water eciency requirements.
Highest impact scenario: Hot house earth
Increased cost of sales
Time horizon: Long term
Potential impact under
hot house earth:
Short term: Low
Medium term: Low
Long term: Moderate
Flood risk assessments are conducted for all
developments during the land acquisition process to
identify and address flood mitigation requirements.
To mitigate water stress, our homes are designed
to use less than 105 litres per person per day,
surpassing current Building Regulations. Our Land
teams collaborate closely with the Group Technical
team to assess planning requirements and ensure
project deliverability.
Opportunities
Risk description Financial driver Management response
Products and services
Greater demand for sustainable homes
As the world transitions towards net-zero we
anticipate there will be greater demand for energy
ecient and low carbon homes. The availability of
financial tools, such as green home mortgages, is
expected to further drive the demand for homes
with lower carbon footprints.
Highest impact scenario: Orderly transition
Increased revenue through
greater demand for low
emission products
Time horizon: Short to long term
Potential impact under
orderly transition:
Short term: Moderate
Medium term: Moderate
Long term: High
We are actively reducing emissions associated with
the operational use of our homes while increasing
energy eciency. As a result, the majority of our
homes qualify for green mortgages. We provide
explanations of energy ecient features to
customers during the sales process.
Green finance
There is increased ability to attract green finance,
such as sustainability linked loans that provide
access to lower interest rates. Additionally,
investors are increasingly considering climate-
related risks, opportunities and progress in
reducing emissions when reviewing portfolios.
Highest impact scenario: Orderly transition
Increased access to finance at
lower cost
Time horizon: Long term
Potential impact under
orderly transition:
Short term: Low
Medium term: Moderate
Long term: Moderate
We maintain open and transparent communication
with investors, informing them about our strategy
and performance. Additionally, our Revolving Credit
Facility is linked to our sustainability performance.
Crest Nicholson 48 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Our risk management process involves a
thorough consideration of climate-related
risks, examining their potential impact on our
strategy in both the short term and beyond.
To address these risks, we are committed
to designing and implementing necessary
mitigating actions. For a detailed breakdown
of our existing risk mitigation actions, please
refer to our climate risk table on pages 47
to 48.
More information on our risk management
process, which includes the consideration
of climate-related risks, can be found on
page 41.
C. Processes for identifying, assessing
and managing climate-related risks are
integrated into the organisation’s overall risk
management
As one of our principal risks, climate change
is integrated into our Risk Management
Framework. During the semi-annual review
of principal risks by the Board, Audit and Risk
Committee and Executive Committee, climate
change is considered within the evolving
risk landscape alongside other key risks.
These discussions and assessments play an
important role in the broader evaluation of
the ongoing viability of the Group.
For more information on our principal risks
and the Risk Management Framework see
pages 35 to 42.
Metrics and targets
A. Metrics used to assess climate-related
risks and opportunities in line with its
strategy and risk management process, and
C. Targets used to manage climate-related
risks and opportunities and performance
against targets
We monitor and disclose a range of
metrics and targets as part of our ongoing
commitment to assess and manage climate-
related risks and opportunities. These metrics
are chosen to directly address the climate
challenges and opportunities the Group
faces. We focus on areas where our actions
can have the most substantial impact,
providing a targeted and eective approach
to climate risk management.
Target/metric Performance
Link to climate-related
risks and opportunities
Climate action
GHG emissions
Reduce absolute scope
1 and 2 GHG emissions
by 60% by 2030
(FY19base year)
55% reduction in absolute scope 1 and 2 GHG emissions
compared to FY19.
Carbon pricing mechanisms
Emerging regulations
Greater demand for sustainable homes
Green financing and
partnership opportunities.
Reduce scope 3 GHG
emissions intensity
by 55%by 2030
(FY19base year)
3% increase in scope 3 GHG emissions per sq. m completed
floorarea compared to FY19.
Achieve net zero
acrossthe value chain
by 2045
Reduction in GHG emissions as detailed above.
Continued supply chain engagement and investigating
furthercarbon reduction opportunities.
Environmental Impact
Rating of our homes
96% of our homes built in FY23 received an Environmental
Impact rating of A or B.
Energy
Procure 100% renewable
electricity by 2025
89% of scope 2 electricity is procured from renewable taris. Carbon pricing mechanisms
Greater demand for sustainable homes
Green financing and
partnership opportunities.
Natural resources and waste
Waste
Reduce waste intensity
(t/100 sq. m) by 15% by
2025 (FY19 base year)
14% increase in waste intensity compared to FY19. Carbon pricing mechanisms
Greater demand for sustainable homes
Green financing and
partnership opportunities.
Divert at least 95% ofwaste
from landfill
Diverted 98% of waste from landfill.
Water
Homes designed to use
105 litres per person
perday (lpppd)
Standard house type specification is 105 lpppd. Changing precipitation patterns
Greater demand for sustainable homes.
Crest Nicholson 49 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
B. Scope 1, 2 and 3 greenhouse gas emissions and energy consumption statement
GHG scope 1 and 2 emissions data
FY23
Location-based
FY23
Market-based
FY22
Location-based
FY22
Market-based
Scope 1 (tCO
2
e) 2,848 2,848 3,070 3,070
Scope 2 (tCO
2
e) 956 202 1,379 234
Total scope 1 and 2 (tCO
2
e) 3,803 3,050 4,449 3,304
Scope 1 and 2 intensity (tCO
2
e/100 sq. m) 2.09 1.68 1.82 1.35
GHG scope 3 emissions data
FY23
Location-based
FY22
Location-based
Scope 3 (tCO
2
e) 479,972 593,055
Purchased goods and services
and capital goods 170,073 185,898
Use of sold products 300,334 393,328
Other scope 3
1
9,565 13,829
Scope 3 intensity (tCO
2
e/sq. m) 2.64 2.42
Energy consumption data FY23 FY22
Scope 1 and 2 Group-wide energy use (kWh) 24,027,259 26,162,348
Scope 1 and 2 energy use intensity (kWh/100 sq. m) 13,203 10,683
1 Other scope 3 emissions have been grouped together within the table. The categories included are: 3. Fuel and energy-related activities; 4. Upstream transportation and distribution;
5.Waste generated in operations; 6. Business travel; 7. Employee commuting; 12. End of life treatment of sold products.
TCFD continued
GHG emissions calculation
methodology
We have reported on the emission sources
required under the Companies Act 2006
(Strategic Report and Directors’ Reports)
Regulations 2013. These sources fall within
our operational control. GHG emissions are
also referred to as carbon emissions within
the report.
In accordance with the GHG Protocol’s
Corporate Standard, we have reported
both location and market-based scope 2
emissions. Location-based emissions are
calculated using the Government’s GHG
Conversion Factors for Company Reporting.
Market-based emissions are calculated
using tari specific factors from our energy
suppliers, which may be more or less carbon
intensive than the location-based factor.
All electricity and gas data from sites and
oces under our control is supplied by our
utilities management partner. For non-plot
supplies, they visit sites on a quarterly
basis to obtain meter readings. Plot data
is obtained at the point of handover to the
customer. Shared oce data is obtained
from the relevant management company
responsible for the oce utilities and is
apportioned based on the floor area we
occupy. Site diesel and LPG data is obtained
directly from suppliers. Business travel data
is obtained from both fuel-card data and our
expense claim system.
Scope 3 emissions are reviewed in
accordance with the GHG protocol and
include nine categories relevant to our
Group operations. The most significant
categories are category 1 ‘purchased goods
and services’, category 2 ‘capital goods’
and category 11 ‘use of sold products’.
Category 1 includes emissions associated
with our supply chain that are not accounted
for in our standard house type material bill
of quantities. They are calculated using
a spend-based approach. Category 2
includes all material included in our bill of
quantities and emissions are calculated
using the OneClick LCA tool. Category 11
includes emissions related to regulated
and unregulated energy. Emissions from
regulated energy are calculated using the
dwelling emission rate, which is calculated in
line with Building Regulations. Emissions from
unregulated energy are based on guidance
given by the RICS professional statement
for whole life carbon assessment for the
built environment and adapted to estimate
for residential energy consumption in the
absence of primary data.
For operational joint ventures we have
included GHG emissions from our own
site compounds for the parts of the
sites we are developing, and the homes
delivered by ourselves. We use the GHG
Protocol Corporate Accounting and
Reporting Standard (revised edition) and
emission factors from UK Government’s
GHG Conversion Factors for Company
Reporting 2023.
Streamlined Energy and Carbon
Reporting disclosure
Our Streamlined Energy and Carbon
Reporting disclosure includes GHG data in
line with our methodology above. Our annual
energy consumption data covers scope 1
and 2 components and includes our site and
oce electricity, gas, diesel and LPG and
business travel with our Group-operated
fleet. All figures relate to emissions and
energy consumed in the UK. For details
on our actions taken to reduce energy
consumption see pages 21 to 23.
Verification statement by Verco Advisory
Services
Verco Advisory Services Ltd has reviewed
Crest Nicholson’s GHG calculations using
the World Resources Institute (WRI) and
World Business Council for Sustainable
Development (WBCSD) GHG Protocol:
A Corporate Accounting and Reporting
Standard. Verco has provided limited
assurance for all emission scopes and
operational energy consumption data against
ISO 14064. Based on its review of Crest
Nicholson’s GHG emissions inventory for
1 November 2022 to 31 October 2023, Verco
has determined that there is no evidence that
the GHG assertion is not materially correct.
Furthermore, Verco finds no evidence that
Crest Nicholson’s assertion is not a fair and
accurate representation of Crest Nicholson’s
actual emissions. Verco finds that the
information submitted by Crest Nicholson
is consistent with the WRI/WBCSD GHG
Protocol’s methodology and reporting
guidance, and conforms to generally
accepted GHG accounting standards.
Crest Nicholson 50 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Non-financial and sustainability
information statement
The following table summarises the information required by sections
414CA and 414CB of the Companies Act 2006 and sets out where
relevant information can be found throughout this report.
1 Policies and standards are available on our corporate website: www.crestnicholson.com
Reporting requirement
Description of policies and standards
1
Related principal
risks
Relevant information to
understand our impact, policy,
due diligence and outcomes Page
Environmental
matters
Sustainability policy
Climate change policy
Sustainable procurement policy
Sustainable timber policy
Supply Chain Code of Conduct.
Our policies are designed to support
activities that preserve and enhance
the natural environment.
2 Safety, Health &
Environment
9 Laws, policies
and regulations
10 Climate change
Protecting the environment
Task Force on Climate-
related Financial Disclosures
Principal risks and
uncertainties
21–24
43–50
35–42
Employees Corporate health and safety policy
Speaking Up policy
Equality and diversity policy.
Our policies set out our commitment to
developing our employees and to providing
a safe and diverse working environment.
2 Safety, Health &
Environment
7 Attracting and
retaining our
skilled people
Stakeholder relations
Safety, Health & Environment
Our people
Principal risks and
uncertainties
Board and leadership
diversity
16–19
27
28–29
35–42
71
Human rights Anti-slavery and human tracking statement
Human rights policy
Speaking Up policy
Supply Chain Code of Conduct
Privacy policy.
Our policies set out our commitment to human
rights and the steps taken to reduce risk.
2 Safety, Health &
Environment
3 Supply chain
7 Attracting and
retaining our
skilled people
Stakeholder relations
Operate our business
responsibly
Whistleblowing
16–19
26
80
Social matters Sustainability policy
Supply Chain Code of Conduct.
Our policies demonstrate our commitment to
maintaining high social standards throughout
our value chain and delivering lasting societal
value for our stakeholders.
2 Safety, Health &
Environment
4 Customer service
& quality
12 Combustible
materials
Stakeholder relations
Making a positive impact
on our communities
Our people
Principal risks and
uncertainties
16–19
25
28–29
35–42
Anti-bribery and
corruption
Anti-bribery and corruption policy
Speaking Up policy
Supply Chain Code of Conduct.
Our policies detail the expected conduct
of our employees and supply chain.
9 Laws, policies
and regulations
Anti-fraud and anti-bribery
Whistleblowing
80
80
Business model 14–15
Non-financial KPIs 31
Principal risks and
uncertainties
35–42
Climate-related
financial disclosures
43–50
Crest Nicholson 51 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Strategic Report
Viability statement and Going Concern
In accordance with the UK Corporate Governance Code, the
Directors and the Executive Leadership Team have assessed
the Groups current position and its emerging and principal
risks and uncertainties over a longer period than the
12 months required by the going concern statement.
The following statement is made in
accordance with the UK Corporate
Governance Code. The Board
considers that a three-year period
continues to remain an appropriate
timeframe for this assessment.
How we assess our viability
While the nature of the material issues,
opportunities and risks faced by the Group
limits the Directors’ ability to reliably
predict the longer term, detailed trading
and cash flow forecasts are maintained and
regularly scrutinised over the three-year
period. The Group owns or controls a high
proportion of the land required to meet unit
forecasts during this time and is therefore
able to forecast future cash outflows with a
reasonable degree of confidence based on
current market conditions.
The Group also benefits from a forward
order book of sales which provides a level
of confidence in near-term revenue delivery.
These inputs allow the Group to maintain
a rolling three-year forecast for the income
statement, balance sheet, cash flow and key
financial ratios for every periodic reporting
date. These forecasts are considered to be
the ‘base case’ for performance assessment.
In recognition of the challenging economic
backdrop throughout FY23, characterised by
high inflation, high interest rates and reduced
levels of disposable income, the Directors
have reduced their expectations for FY24
trading. Accordingly, a prudent volume of
home completions and achieved selling
prices have been forecast into the base case
for next year.
During FY22 the Group completed a new
Sustainability Linked Revolving Credit
Facility (RCF) for £250.0m which expires in
October 2026. Despite the reductions in
financial forecasts factored into the base
case, the Group is forecast to comfortably
comply with all its RCF and senior loan note
debt covenants across the viability period.
The Directors have also concluded that
there is adequatenancial headroom, and
appropriate mitigations if needed, to manage
through a much tougher market scenario
while continuing to meet the Group’s
combustible materials obligations and deliver
the Group’s growth ambitions, albeit over a
longer timeframe. Furthermore the Group
has assumed that the RCF can be refinanced
in the near over the viability period, given it
currently expires in October 2026.
Stress testing viability through simulated
scenarios
While the Group’s base case forecast
provides assurance that its financial
performance and position remains strong for
the foreseeable future, the Directors have
then applied stress tests to this forecast
(without double counting those already
embedded in the base case), to satisfy
themselves that this will remain true in more
challenging market conditions.
The identification of these plausible adverse
trading conditions has been derived from the
Group’s principal risks set out on pages 35
to 42, and their impact on the solvency and
liquidity of the Group. The most likely source
of this challenge lies in the severity and
duration of the UK macro-economic outlook.
If high inflation persists then confidence
in the housing market will remain weak.
Mortgage lending will remain expensive,
compounding the aordability challenge,
particularly for first time buyers or those with
low levels of equity.
If consumers believe the housing market is
about to undergo a significant correction they
postpone their buying intentions until further
clarity as to the market’s health emerges.
For those house sellers who have no choice
about the timing of their sale, either because
of unaordable and rising mortgage costs
or the impact of life events, they have no
option but to cut the price of their property
to achieve a sale. This in turn leads to a more
widespread lack of confidence in the market
as buyers seek bigger discounts and lenders
protect themselves through reduced home
valuations and increased stress testing of
their own. The Directors have therefore
modelled stress tests relating to further
volume and prices declines than those
assumed in the base forecast.
In addition, the construction sector has
experienced high levels of build cost inflation
throughout FY22 and much of FY23. In the
final quarter of FY23 build cost inflation
has broadly ceased, but it is possible that
high levels of build cost inflation return and
therefore the Directors have also modelled a
third stress test to reflect this possibility.
In addition to applying the impact of each of
these stress tests, the Directors have also
considered the impact of a ‘plausible but
severe’ downside case which includes the
sales price and sales volume falls detailed
above applying together.
In all scenarios, individually and in aggregate,
the Group continues to remain compliant
with its debt covenants without the need
to fully implement the eect of all available
mitigations to achieve this.
Finally, the Directors have then also
exaggerated each of the three stress
tests referred to above to a level beyond
that which is considered to be a plausible
‘downside’ scenario, to find the point at which
any of these stress tests would cause a
covenant failure.
Conclusion
Based on the results of this assessment, the
Directors have a reasonable expectation
that the Group will be able to continue in
operation and meet its liabilities as they fall
due over the period of their assessment to
31 October 2026.
Going Concern
Having assessed the principal risks and all
other relevant matters, the Directors consider
it appropriate to adopt the going concern
basis of accounting in preparing the financial
statements of the Company.
Further details can be found in note 1 to the
consolidated financial statements.
Crest Nicholson 52 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
In this section
54 Corporate Governance Report
70 Nomination Committee Report
74 Audit and Risk Committee Report
81 Directors’ Remuneration Report
99 Directors’ Report
Strong
governance to
deliver our strategy
Good corporate governance
practices and strong leadership
are essential for delivering
long-term sustainable success
to our stakeholders.
Governance
Crest Nicholson 53 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
As Chairman of Crest Nicholson,
I am pleased to present this year’s
Corporate Governance Report. The
following pages explain the eective
leadership of the Group and the
oversight and application of high
governance standards as we deliver
our strategy.
Trading conditions have become increasingly
dicult for the housebuilding sector and the
Group’s performance has been impacted
by a number of external factors. The Board
has had to carefully review and adapt the
Group’s strategy to respond to the changes
in the trading environment. By making
tough decisions, we have positioned Crest
Nicholson, so that we can continue to
operate eectively and deliver long-term
sustainable growth.
Our culture
The Board plays an important role in setting
the Group’s strategy, purpose, culture
and values. The Board spends time at
our meetings reflecting on these areas.
Each Director recognises their role in
setting the tone from the top to embed the
Group’s values.
The Board encouraged management
to undertake a review of the Group’s
culture. During the year an independent
consultant was appointed and they spent
time talking and listening to a cross-section
of employees about the business and its
culture. The work is ongoing but preliminary
reports have provided positive feedback
on our culture. This has enabled the Board
to better understand where culture is
performing well and where there are areas
for further development.
Board changes
During the year Duncan Cooper informed the
Board of his intention to leave the Group and
Lucinda Bell decided to retire from the Board.
I would like to thank Duncan and Lucinda for
their contribution to the Group during their
time on the Board.
We were delighted to welcome Bill Floydd
to the Board as Group Finance Director on
13 November 2023 and Maggie Semple as
Non-Executive Director on 1 January 2024.
Details on the appointment process and the
induction procedures are set out on page 73.
The Board continues to be diverse with
Directors from a range of backgrounds
and experience. The Board met the FTSE
Women Leaders requirements for Board
gender diversity.
Chairmans introduction
Governance overview
Board leadership andcompanypurpose
Outlines the leadership of Crest Nicholson,
the main Board activities and how the
Board has considered its responsibilities
to its stakeholders.
Division of responsibilities
Provides an overview of the governance
framework of the Group, composition of
the Board, roles of each Director, Board
balance, delegation and Non-Executive
Director independence.
Composition, succession andevaluation
Outlines the Board’s evaluation process
and outcomes and includes the report of
the work of the Nomination Committee for
the year.
Audit, risk and internal control
Describes the role of the Board and the
Audit and Risk Committee in ensuring the
integrity of the financial statements, how
they monitor the eectiveness of the Group’s
internal controls, and the assessment of the
external auditor.
Remuneration
Provides detail of the remuneration
arrangements for the Directors and
the workforce during the year.
For more information
Chairman’s introduction – 54
Board of Directors – 56
Executive Leadership Team – 58
Our purpose, values and culture – 59
Our stakeholders – 61
Employee engagement – 63
Board activity – 64
For more information
Board evaluation – 68
Nomination Committee Report – 70
For more information
Board composition – 66
For more information
Audit and Risk Committee Report – 74
For more information
Remuneration Committee Chair letter – 81
Alignment with strategy – 83
Remuneration at a glance – 84
Summary of the Remuneration Policy – 85
Implementation of the Policy in FY24 – 86
Annual Report on remuneration – 89
Crest Nicholson 54 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
The Board takes its responsibility for the
Groups long-term sustainable success
seriously, recognising that it generates
value for shareholders, while contributing
more widely to society.
Board eectiveness
The Board undertook an internal evaluation
this year to review its eectiveness and
performance. The results are set out on
pages 68 to 69 and an action plan has
beendeveloped to implement the findings
ofthe review.
Sustainability
We continue to focus on operating
sustainably. During the year the Group’s new
science-based targets, aimed at reducing
the Group’s carbon footprint, were validated
by the Science Based Targets initiative.
The Board received regular updates on
progress against these targets and other
sustainability matters.
Stakeholder engagement
Stakeholder engagement is a priority for
the Board. The Board received reports on
stakeholder groups and engagement with
them at each meeting.
Extensive discussions were held on how
the Group performed against industry
benchmarks and it received feedback on
customer and supplier relations.
The Board was pleased Crest Nicholson
achieved accreditation as a Living Wage
Employer. In addition, we received the Gold
Award for The 5% Club due to the Group’s
focus on training and supporting trainees
joining the industry. These achievements
demonstrate our continued commitment to
all our employees and those who work within
our supply chain.
Shareholder engagement
An important area of stakeholder
engagement is dialogue with shareholders.
I have been pleased to meet with a number of
our shareholders during the year to discuss
a range of topics and understand their views
and their priorities.
We invite shareholders to our AGM in 2024.
Further details are set out in the Notice of
AGM which accompanies this Annual Report.
On behalf of the Board, I would like to thank
shareholders for their continued support and
the Board welcomes further engagement
during 2024.
Iain Ferguson CBE
Chairman
Iain Ferguson
CBE
Chairman
Compliance with the UK Corporate Governance Code
The Group complied in full with the UK Corporate Governance Code
(Code) for the financial year ended 31 October 2023.
The Code is available on the FRC’s website, www.frc.org.uk
Crest Nicholson 55 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Board of Directors
Key to Committee membership
A
Audit and Risk Committee
N
Nomination Committee
R
Remuneration Committee
E
Executive Committee
Chair of Committee
Board composition
1
One Chairman
independent on appointment
Two Executive
Directors
Four independent
Non-Executive
Directors
1 2 3
4 5 6
7
1 As at 23 January 2024.
Tenure (years) 0–1 1–2 2–3 3–4 4–5 5–6 6–7
Iain Ferguson
Peter Truscott
Bill Floydd
Octavia Morley
David Arnold
Louise Hardy
Maggie Semple
Board tenure
1
Crest Nicholson 56 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
1 Iain Ferguson CBE
Chairman
N R
Appointed September 2019
Experience: Iain was Chief Executive Ocer
of Tate & Lyle plc, later chairing Berendsen
plc and Stobart Group Ltd. He was also
Senior Independent Director of Balfour
Beatty plc and Non-Executive Director at
Greggs plc.
Iain is currently Chairman of Genus plc
and externally managed investment trust,
Personal Assets Trust plc. In addition,
Iain was Lead Independent Director at
the Department for Environment, Food
and Rural Aairs (DEFRA), Chair of
Wilton Park (Agency of the Foreign and
Commonwealth Oce) and a Member of the
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP UK Advisory
Board. In 2003 Iain became a Commander
of the British Empire for his services to the
food industry.
What Iain brings to the Board: Iain is a highly
experienced public company Chairman, Non-
Executive Director and former FTSE 100 CEO.
He has extensive and diverse leadership
experience and a sound and practical
understanding of corporate governance.
Iain has a deep appreciation of capital
markets and investor sentiment which
he brings to Board deliberations, in
addition to financial expertise and
construction experience.
External appointments: Chairman of Genus
plc and Chairman at externally managed
investment trust Personal Assets Trust plc
and Pro Chancellor, Cranfield University
4 Octavia Morley
Senior Independent Director
N RA
Appointed May 2017
Experience: After working in management
roles at companies including Asda Stores Ltd,
Laura Ashley plc and Woolworths plc, Octavia
was Chief Executive then Chair at LighterLife
UK Ltd, Managing Director at Crew Clothing
Co. and Chief Executive at OKA Direct Ltd.
Octavia also served as a Non-Executive
Director and Chair of the Remuneration
Committee at John Menzies plc.
What Octavia brings to the Board: Octavia
has a variety of experience in senior
operational and non-executive roles in retail
and multi-site companies, both privately
owned and publicly listed. She brings
customer experience insight to the Board,
gleaned through her previous retail and
consumer roles.
External appointments: Chair of Banner Ltd,
Senior Independent Director of Marston’s plc
and Non-Executive Director of Ascensos Ltd
2 Peter Truscott
Chief Executive
E
Appointed September 2019
Experience: Peter was formerly Chief
Executive of Galliford Try plc. Peter also
worked at Taylor Wimpey plc for 30 years
where he held various positions including
divisional Chairman. He was also a member
of its Group Management Team. Previously,
he worked for CALA Homes.
What Peter brings to the Board: Peter has
extensive experience in the housebuilding
industry across a range of models and
tenures. He brings valuable operational
and public company experience to lead
the Group and is highly experienced at
delivering a broad range of housing needs
to stakeholders.
External appointments: Non-Executive
Director of Anchor Housing Group
5 David Arnold
Non-Executive Director
N RA
Appointed September 2021
Experience: David is Chief Financial Ocer
of Grafton Group plc, having joined Grafton
in September 2013. He was previously
Group Finance Director of Enterprise plc,
the UK maintenance and support services
business, from 2010 to 2013 and Group
Finance Director of Redrow plc, from 2003
to 2010. David has previously held senior
finance positions with Six Continents plc and
Tarmac plc.
What David brings to the Board: David is an
established plc Board director, who brings
extensive finance, property and commercial
experience to the Group.
External appointments: Chief Financial
Ocer of Grafton Group plc
6 Louise Hardy
Non-Executive Director
N RA
Appointed January 2018
Experience: Louise was European Project
Excellence Director at Aecom and
Infrastructure Director for CLM, which was
the consortium partner for the London 2012
Olympic Delivery Authority. Louise has been
a Non-Executive Director at the Defence
Infrastructure Organisation for the Ministry of
Defence. Louise is a fellow of the Institution
of Civil Engineers and of the Chartered
Management Institute.
What Louise brings to the Board: Louise
has a wealth of relevant experience in the
delivery of complex infrastructure projects
and experience as a non-executive director
of other publicly listed companies. Louise is
the Non-Executive Director responsible for
employee engagement.
External appointments: Non-Executive
Director of Severfield plc, Balfour Beatty plc
and Travis Perkins plc
3 Bill Floydd
Group Finance Director
E
Appointed November 2023
Experience: Bill joined the Group from a
consumer-focused listed background having
been Chief Financial Ocer at Watches of
Switzerland Group plc and Rank Group plc.
Prior to this, he was the Chief Financial Ocer
responsible for the UK & Ireland business of
Experian plc and held a number of senior finance
roles at Logica plc. Bill is a chartered accountant,
having qualified with Price Waterhouse.
What Bill brings to the Board: Bill brings a
wealth of senior financial and commercial
expertise having previously served as Chief
Financial Ocer across a range of sectors.
He has extensive experience within the public
listed environment and strong leadership
qualities essential to delivering growth.
External appointments: None
7 Dr Maggie Semple OBE
Non-Executive Director
N RA
Appointed January 2024
Experience: Formerly an academic, Maggie
began advising governments on education
in 1990s. She went on to hold several Non-
Executive Director positions in dierent
organisations such as Her Majestys
Court Service, the Criminal Cases Review
Commission, the Ministry of Justice (Chair of
Audit, Risk & Compliance) and McDonald’s
Restaurants. Currently, Maggie is a Non-
Executive Director at Phoenix Holdings
plc and Jamaica National Bank UK Ltd.
She is also the owner of three business – The
Experience Corps Limited, a global niche
consultancy firm, Maggie Semple Limited,
a luxury bespoke womens-wear brand and
is the co-founder of I-Cubed Group Limited.
Maggie is an author and she writes on
inclusion matters.
What Maggie brings to the Board: Maggie
has a wealth of experience in executive and
non-executive roles across a number of
dierent sectors and oers great insight to
the Board.
External appointments: Non-Executive
Director of Phoenix Group Holdings plc
and Jamaica National Bank UK Limited,
Chief Executive of The Experience Corps
Limited, Owner of Maggie Semple Limited,
Co-Founder of I-Cubed Group Limited and
Honorary Bencher of Middle Temple
Departures since 31 October 2023
Duncan Cooper, Group Finance Director,
on 13 December 2023.
Lucinda Bell, Non-Executive Director, on
31 December 2023.
Crest Nicholson 57 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Executive Leadership Team
Peter Truscott
Chief Executive
See biography on page 57
Bill Floydd
Group Finance Director
See biography on page 57
David Marchant
Group Operations Director
Joined ELT March 2019
Experience: David has over 36 years’
construction and housebuilding industry
experience in design and leadership roles.
He was previously a Group Director of
Bellway plc where he was responsible for
group design, technical, R&D, procurement,
commercial and quality strategies. Prior to
that David spent 25 years in engineering
design practice as a structural engineer
and at the National House Building Council
(NHBC). At the NHBC he was a Director of
their Approved Inspector business.
David is a structural engineer and
chartered builder.
Penny Thomas
Group Company Secretary
Joined ELT January 2024
Experience: Penny joined Crest Nicholson
in September 2023 and is a chartered
company secretary and governance
professional. She has significant
experience as a company secretary in
FTSE 250 companies, including the real
estate sector. Penny spent 14 years at
Shaftesbury plc, and more recently at
SEGRO plc, Moonpig Group plc and Close
Brothers Group plc.
Jane Cookson
Group HR Director
Joined ELT January 2021
Experience: Jane joined Crest Nicholson
in June 2002 as an HR Manager and
became HR Director in January 2013.
Jane has a deep understanding of the
industry, the Group and its people.
Jane has responsibility for all areas of HR
including diversity and inclusion, talent and
performance management.
Jane is MCIPD qualified and has been
in the housebuilding industry for over
20 years.
Heather O’Sullivan
Group General Counsel
Joined ELT September 2023
Experience: Heather joined Crest
Nicholson in November 2019 as Company
Solicitor leading to her appointment as
Group General Counsel in September
2023. Heather has significant experience
in the housebuilding sector having
specialised in the field since qualification
in 1998. She previously worked both in-
house for Linden Homes and Galliford Try
Partnerships and, prior to that, for leading
UK housebuilder clients in private practice.
Kieran Daya
Chief Operating Ocer
Joined ELT January 2021
Experience: Kieran joined Crest Nicholson
in January 2020 as Managing Director
of the Partnerships and Strategic
Land Division and joined the ELT
shortly thereafter.
In January 2024 Kieran was appointed
Chief Operating Ocer. He is a qualified
solicitor who has worked with some of the
country’s largest developers. Kieran has
experience in significant land acquisitions,
working on joint ventures and partnership
deals having taken a lead on some of the
larger transactions in the housebuilding
industry within recent years.
Crest Nicholson 58 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Our purpose, values and culture
Our culture
The Board monitors the culture of the Group through a range of
indicators including:
Safety, Health & Environment (SHE):
The Board wants all colleagues and
others aected by the Group’s activities
to be healthy and go home safely to
their families every day. The Board
is updated regularly on SHE matters,
incidents and on new or ongoing
investigations and their outcomes.
Engagement with employees
The Board creates opportunities for
the Non-Executive Directors to meet
employees at various times during
the year through visits to the Group’s
oces and sites.
Louise Hardy, the Non-Executive
Director responsible for employee
engagement, attends Employee Voice
and other forums to engage with
employees. She shares employees
views in Board meetings.
Employee policies
The Board and its Committees review
key employee policies to ensure they
appropriately capture and reflect the
Group’s values and culture.
Customer experience
This is considered and assessed
at every meeting using customer
satisfaction survey responses.
Recommendation scores are regularly
reported to the Board and discussed.
Supplier activity
The Board reviews how the Group
supports and manages subcontractors
and constituents of the supply
chain. This includes an awareness
of challenges in the supply chain.
The Group’s payment practices are
monitored by the Board.
Business conduct
The Board reviews business conduct
including whistleblowing reports and
Internal Audit reviews. The Board can
identify and address any incidents and
areas for improvement.
Our purpose
Building great places for our customers,
communities and the environment.
We invest in placemaking, delivering
attractive homes and incorporating
sustainable and energy-ecient
features in our developments.
We strive to make a positive dierence
to people’s lives.
Our values
The Board recognises the importance of taking the lead to enhance
the Group’s culture. It embodies the Group’s values by actions taken
within the Boardroom, as follows:
Leaving a positive legacy
The Board considers financial and non-
financial KPIs to assess performance.
The Board supports management
in delivering great placemaking and
high quality homes to our customers,
which in turn generates long-term
sustainable performance.
Being the best we canbe
The Board expects high performance
leadership and focus in meetings.
There is a commitment to deliver strong
operational and financial performance.
Time is spent developing succession
plans so that the Group has the
right talent both now and
in the future.
Championing our people
The Board sponsors a number of
initiatives to support the development
of the Group’s employees.
Employees presenting at Board meetings
always receive a warm welcome, are
listened to and given time to ask
and respond to questions.
Working together
Non-Executive Directors draw upon their
own personal knowledge and experience
to support the Executive Directors in
finding solutions to deliver
the Group’s strategy.
Doing the right thing
The Board sometimes needs to make
decisions at pace but it will always reflect
and consider the Group’s stakeholders.
Directors treat each other with respect
and open dialogue and constructive
challenge is welcomed in meetings.
1
2
4
5
3
Crest Nicholson 59 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Our purpose, values and culture continued
Workforce culture perception study
The Board recognises the importance of a
strong culture which is essential for delivering
the Group’s purpose. Culture shapes the
Group’s operations, engagement with its
stakeholders and impacts the delivery of the
Group’s strategy.
The Board initiated a culture perception
study of the Group’s workforce undertaken
by an independent third party. The aim
was to consider how employees feel about
working at Crest Nicholson and highlight any
opportunities for change.
Following completion of this process, a
summary of the feedback was presented to
the Board.
The results highlighted the perception of
the Group’s culture by internal and external
stakeholders and the opportunities for
improvement. The recommendations
were considered and acknowledged by
the Board.
The Board agreed that the next step was
to encourage senior management to be
involved in developing the solutions and
that the Annual Leadership Conference
provided this opportunity for the team to
work together. See opposite.
The Board agreed the below process for conducting this study:
One to one
interviews with the
Board and Senior
Leadership Team
One to one
interviews with
external partners
Focus groups
with employees
Benchmarking
against peers
1 2 3 4
Annual Leadership Conference
The Annual Group Conference was held in November 2023 for members of the
ELT and senior management. Time was spent considering the outcome of the
culture perception study. The meeting recognised the positive aspects from the
study. Attendees considered opportunities to strengthen the Group’s culture
and way of working across the workforce. Everyone was asked to suggest
improvements to be incorporated into an action plan for the Board to consider.
This feedback will be consolidated and used to frame a culture action plan, the
progress of which will be monitored by the Board.
How the study was conducted
2023 Annual Leadership Conference
Crest Nicholson 60 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Crest
Nicholson
stakeholders
Investors
Government
and other
bodies
Customers
Our people
Suppliers
Communities
and the
environment
Our stakeholders
The Group’s stakeholders are an integral
part of the business model. The Board and
senior management engage directly with
stakeholders in dierent ways to understand
what is important to them and to reflect their
interests in the Group’s long-term strategy.
The Group’s key stakeholders are set
out below.
Our Section 172 statement together with
additional information about our key
stakeholders and why they are important to
us is on pages 16 to 19.
Consideration of stakeholders in decision
making is illustrated in the following case studies.
Expansion plans and land acquisition
At the Group’s full-year results in January 2023, the Group reported
strong progress with divisional expansion plans in Yorkshire and
East Anglia, and continued investment in land.
As 2023 progressed, the UK economy and the housebuilding
industry in particular observed challenging trading conditions.
Some housebuilders withdrew from the land acquisition market.
The Board decided to continue acquiring land with the support of
a strong balance sheet. The Group progressed acquisitions of high
quality sites in desirable locations such as Brackley, Windsor and
Oxford to add to the land portfolio.
Following further monitoring of market conditions which had
deteriorated, the Board decided that it would moderate the pace
of growth across the Group. The Board agreed to incorporate the
East Anglia division into the existing Eastern division but retain the
Yorkshire division, with 300 to 350 units anticipated during 2026.
The Board monitors the external environment and the decisions
that have been made, mean the Group is well-positioned to trade
through changing market conditions.
Roadmap to restore Crest’s five-star customer experience
The Board monitors the Group’s customer satisfaction survey results
which drive the achievement of a five-star rating under the Home
Builders Federation (HBF) scheme.
In 2022 the Group’s customer service standards fell below
the Board’s expectations and understandably, our customers
reflected this in lower NHBC customer satisfaction survey ratings.
Recognising the importance of the Group’s customers and delivery of
a high quality product, the Board asked management to implement
a customer service recovery plan in tandem with the oversight
of the implementation of the New Homes Quality Code (NHQC).
Following significant investment in FY23, in people, processes and
systems, there are encouraging signs that quality and customer
service standards are improving. If this level of service can be
maintained and the divisions can build upon the work initiated to
improve customer experience, Crest Nicholson will be on track to
regain its HBF five-star status in 2025.
Regular updates have been provided to the Board on the
implementation of the NHQC and the Board receives progress
updates on the customer service recovery plan at each
Board meeting.
Link to our stakeholders
Investors Our people Customers
Link to our stakeholders
Investors Customers
Communities and environment
Brackley, Northamptonshire
Crest Nicholson 61 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Our stakeholders continued
Shareholder engagement
The Chief Executive and Group Finance
Director engage proactively and
constructively with shareholders throughout
the year.
The Chairman and Senior Independent
Director are available to shareholders
to discuss governance and strategic
matters. During the year the Chairman and
Senior Independent Director consulted
with the Group’s major investors about
governance matters.
Committee Chairs are available to engage
with shareholders on significant matters
related to their area of responsibility.
AGM
All Directors, including the Chairs of the
Committees, attend the AGM and are
available to answer shareholder questions.
The Notice of AGM and related information
are circulated to all shareholders at least 20
business days before the meeting.
The AGM enables the Directors to meet with
individual shareholders.
Engagement with lenders
We meet with our lenders and keep them
updated throughout the year about the
financial and operational progress of the
Group. During the year time was spent
discussing sustainability and governance
matters and providing details of the Group’s
results as well as market feedback.
Investor relations
The Head of Investor Relations is the
principal contact for institutional
shareholders, sell-side analysts and the
financial media.
The Chief Executive, Group Finance Director
and Head of Investor Relations manage and
develop the Group’s external relationships
with shareholders.
They follow a comprehensive programme
of investor meetings and calls, particularly
following the release of full and half-year
results and trading updates. There are
formal events throughout the year, along
with a regular series of one-to-one and
group meetings.
Regular updates and feedback is provided
to the Board.
The Groups Investor Relations programme
The Chief Executive or Group Finance Director attended
62 investor meetings, engaging with over half of current
shareholders (by shareholding value).
The Group’s investor website is kept up to date with analyst
consensus forecasts and trading updates on the Group’s strategy.
Timetable
Event Date
FY23 results
announcement
23 January 2024
FY23 investor
roadshow
23 to 29 January 2024
AGM 19 March 2024
HY24 results
announcement
13 June 2024
HY24 investor
roadshow
13 to 18 June 2024
FY24 year end 31 October 2024
Key themes discussed included the Group’s strategy and the progress
against its priorities, the housebuilding sector, capital allocation, dividend
policy and other matters raised by individual parties.
Investor roadshows were organised in person or virtually,
with investors primarily based in the UK.
Crest Nicholson 62 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Employee engagement
Employee engagement is important for the Board
to understand the views of employees and for the
development of the Group’s culture. By listening to
employees’ views, the Board can address any concerns.
Employee Voice
I met with the Employee Voice
Forum six times during the year
and have been pleased with how
these forums have matured over
the course of the last year since
our initial meetings. The output
from the meetings has been
invaluable to the Board.
Louise Hardy
Non-Executive Director responsible
for employee engagement
Our Employee Voice Forum is chaired by
Louise Hardy and made up of volunteers
from across the divisions.
Communication with employees is an
important topic across all the Employee
Voice Forums. Work has been undertaken
to improve communications, including an
employee newsletter, ‘The Exchange’.
An internal communications manager has
been recruited to develop and manage
employee communication strategies at
Group and divisional levels.
Once implemented, we expect these
strategies to evolve as we continue our
work to understand and develop our
corporate culture.
Anity Groups
Our Anity Groups were launched in 2022,
to empower our people to raise concerns that
impact them, so that we can make positive
change for our people.
The Disability Anity Group has developed
its objectives and working principles,
and made change to the way site plans
are labelled.
Colleagues and customers with sight
impairments, colour blindness and/or dyslexia
can find identifying the correct site plan
challenging, especially in busy environments.
By making a simple change to include
symbols and icons as well as numbers
and words as identifiers on-site plans, we
aim to make life on-site more inclusive for
our people.
Board site visits
In September the Board and I visited
our Ackender Hill development in Alton,
Hampshire, a development of 290, two to
five bedroom, houses with one-third of the
development complete and the remainder
still under construction.
Situated in the South division, we were
introduced to the site and sales teams.
The team talked to us about their overall
performance. They explained the challenges
and opportunities at the development we
were visiting. We heard about the sales
strategy for Ackender Hill, who our typical
customers are and what they are looking for
when searching for their new home.
We also had the pleasure of sharing
lunch with the site team, listening to their
experiences of working at Crest Nicholson
and at Ackender Hill, before being taken
on a walk round the development by the
site manager.
As part of our Board visits,
I always look forward to talking with
employees as we walk about site.
Their openness and pride in their job
is something I’m really proud of.”
Iain Ferguson CBE
Chairman
I was pleased to join the Disability
Anity Group as executive sponsor
this year. The level of engagement
and positivity from all the groups
has been inspiring. The other ELT
sponsors and I all look forward to
working with the Anity Groups
moving forward.
Peter Truscott
Chief Executive
Crest Nicholson 63 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Strategy, operations andfinance
Meetings of the Board
The Board held six scheduled meetings
during the year. Set out below are the topics
that the Board received updates on and
made decisions about.
In between scheduled meetings, the Board
held monthly update calls, which enabled the
Board to consider operational performance
and external market developments.
Time was also scheduled for the Non-
Executive Directors to meet without the
Executive Directors present.
Conflicts of interest
The Board has a policy to identify and
manage Directors’ conflicts or potential
conflicts of interest, including those
resulting from significant shareholdings,
so that the influence of third parties
does not compromise or override
independent judgement.
Directors’ interests were reviewed by the
Board at each meeting. New conflicts arising
between meetings are dealt with at the
time between the Chairman and the Group
Company Secretary. The Board confirmed
that there are no appointments or interests
held by the Directors that are current conflicts
of interest, or that the Board considers will
be conflicts in the future. Should conflicts of
interest arise in future, measures will be put in
place accordingly.
How time was spent
A Strategy, operations and finance 40%
B Governance and legal 20%
C Leadership and people 20%
D Internal control and risk management 20%
A
B
C
D
External appointments
and overboarding
Careful consideration was given to
each of the Non-Executive Directors’
existing commitments and time required
to fulfil their obligations to the Group
including with respect to any changes to
external appointments.
Iain Ferguson holds two Chair mandates in
FTSE 250 listed entities (Crest Nicholson
Holdings plc and Genus plc). He holds
a further Chair mandate at an externally
managed investment trust, Personal
Assets Trust plc. Taking into account the
externally managed nature of the trust
and the corresponding reduction in time
commitment required compared to FTSE
250 appointments, the Board is satisfied
that the third appointment represents
half the commitment of a FTSE 250 Chair
appointment. The external appointments do
not impede the Chairman’s ability to allocate
sucient time to the Company to discharge
his responsibilities. The Board remained
satisfied that these appointments do not
result in overboarding and do not count as
conflicts of interest.
Board Strategy Day
Each year the Board dedicates a day to
reflect on the Group’s strategy. It considers
the appropriateness of the current
strategy and the operating and economic
environment. Time is spent reviewing
performance of the delivery of strategy
and how the strategy is being received
by investors.
This year’s Strategy Day began with
an overview of the macro-economic
environment from the Group’s real estate
advisors, Savills plc. They provided external
insight on the housing market as well as
key trends and the outlook for the future.
A further external speaker provided insight
into investor sentiment for the sector.
The Board reflected upon the drivers
impacting the planning environment and the
challenges that the PSL team faces.
There was an update on regulatory changes
including the Future Homes Standard and
the NHQC.
The Board spent time considering the
Group’s customer experience and initiatives
to improve this.
The external consultant appointed to
undertake the workforce culture perception
review presented alongside the Group
HR Director on the output of their work.
The Board discussed the next steps and
agreed to consider a culture action plan to
implement proposals from the review at its
next meeting.
Matters considered
Continuously reviewed progress
against the Group’s strategy and
considered the housing market and
ongoing economic uncertainty
Monitored trading performance
throughout the year
Reviewed SHE performance and
initiatives to reduce slips, trips and falls
Reviewed the Group’s annual budget
including current market consensus and
build cost experience
Considered the Group’s financing
arrangements, capital allocation and
tax strategy
Reflected on the land market and
considered the Group’s approach to
land acquisition
Reviewed the Group’s customer
experience performance
Considered progress against the
Group’s sustainability targets.
Outcomes
Approved the annual budget, business
plan and KPIs
Reviewed and approved the Group’s
FY22 and HY23 financial statements
Approved the Group’s FY22
Annual Report
Approved a FY22 final dividend and
HY23 interim dividend
Approved the active approach to
land purchase and growth to the
land portfolio
Approved the implementation of a
customer experience plan.
Stakeholders considered
Investors
Our people
Supply chain
Customers
Communities and environment
Government and other bodies
Board activity
Crest Nicholson 64 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance and legal Leadership and people Internal control and
risk management
Matters considered
Regular updates on significant legal
matters relating to the Group
Continual review of the Group’s
approach and remedial work in relation
to building safety and combustible
materials matters
A legal and governance update
including developments in
corporate reporting
Reviewed the anti-slavery and human
tracking statement for publication
Received reports on engagement
with investors and other stakeholders
throughout the year
Continued to focus on the composition,
balance and eectiveness of the Board
Considered Group succession planning
Carried out an internally facilitated
Board evaluation covering the
Board’s eectiveness, processes and
ways of working and review of the
Chairman’s performance
Received regular updates from the
Chairs of the Audit and Risk Committee,
Nomination Committee, Remuneration
Committee, SHE Committee and
Sustainability Committee
Regular feedback from, and discussion
with, the Non-Executive Director
responsible for employee engagement.
Outcomes
Considered the impact on stakeholders
in the Board’s decision making
Reviewed compliance with the Code
through robust decision making
Approved and published the anti-
slavery and human tracking statement
for FY23
Progressed a range of agreed actions
arising from the FY22 Board evaluation
Concluded that the Board and its
Committees continued to operate
eectively during FY23 and set actions
for FY24.
Stakeholders considered
Investors
Our people
Supply chain
Communities and environment
Matters considered
Received regular updates in relation
to people, employee engagement and
diversity and inclusion activities
Regular feedback from Employee
Voice meetings
Regularly reviewed the Group’s
employee voluntary turnover rate and
initiatives to reduce this
Considered the Group’s culture and
how this is implemented across
the workforce
Anity Group updates.
Outcomes
Development of the Group’s
cultural framework
Empowered the Anity Groups.
Stakeholders considered
Investors
Our people
Matters considered
Debated the risk appetite and
significant and emerging risks
Reviewed the Group’s risk
management framework, principal risks
and uncertainties
Provided oversight to the Operating
Framework Review.
Outcomes
Considered and approved the Group’s
risk management framework
Approved the principal and
emerging risks
Confirmed the Group’s viability
statement and going concern status.
Stakeholders considered
Investors
Our people
Supply chain
Customers
Attendance at scheduled Board meetings
Director Board
Audit and Risk
Committee
Nomination
Committee
Remuneration
Committee
Iain Ferguson 6/6 3/3 5/5
Peter Truscott 6/6
Duncan Cooper 6/6
Octavia Morley 6/6 4/4 3/3 5/5
David Arnold 6/6 4/4 3/3 5/5
Lucinda Bell 6/6 4/4 3/3 5/5
Louise Hardy 6/6 4/4 3/3 5/5
Crest Nicholson 65 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Iain Ferguson CBE
Chairman
Peter Truscott
Chief Executive
Bill Floydd
Group Finance
Director
Octavia Morley
Senior Independent
Director
David Arnold, Louise Hardy
and Maggie Semple OBE
Independent Non-Executive Directors
Penny Thomas
Group Company
Secretary
The Board Roles and responsibilities
The Board sets the Group’s strategy
to promote the long-term sustainable
success of the Group in line with the
purpose, values and culture.
The Board provides leadership within a framework
of strong governance, risk management and
eective controls. It oversees the performance
and progress of the Group against business plans,
utilising KPIs to support it in its assessment.
The Board has a schedule of matters reserved
for its own decision which includes setting
profit expectations and dividend policy and
approving major acquisitions, capital expenditure
and financing.
Leads the Board, major shareholder and other
stakeholder engagement
Supports the Chief Executive’s management of
the business
Applies independent and objective judgement
Sets agendas that enable appropriate coverage of
all areas material to the Board and which support
eective and balanced decision making
Ensures that the Board receives accurate and
timely information to aid decision making
Facilitates an environment for eective and
constructive relationships between all Directors
Drives a culture that supports constructive
discussion, challenge, debate and decision making
Contributes to the Board’s succession planning,
induction and composition deliberations while
promoting equality, opportunity, diversity
and inclusion
Ensures the views of stakeholders are considered
appropriately in Board discussions
Responsible for the eectiveness of the Board and
its governance
Prioritises the development of the Group’s strategy.
Responsible for the leadership of the Group and
implementing the Group’s strategy
Maintains communication with the Chairman in
relation to strategic considerations
Manages the overall performance of the
business and provides eective leadership to
members of the ELT
Proposes and leads the delivery of strategy as
agreed by the Board
Leads the Executive Committee which oversees
operational and financial performance
Communicates and provides feedback about
the implementation of Group policies and their
impact on behaviours and culture
Leads and supports the Group’s divisions and its
support functions
Engages with institutional shareholders and key
stakeholder groups including the Government
Responsible to the Board for sustainability
policies and practices of the Group.
Provides leadership, direction
and management of Group
Finance and oversees divisional
financial control functions
Responsible for the Group’s
financial statements, financial
control mechanisms and
tax strategy
Delivers investor relations
communications to
capital markets
Manages the Group’s risk
profile and establishes eective
internal controls
Oversees the implementation
of the Group’s risk
management actions
Manages the Group’s
relationship with the
external auditor.
Acts as a sounding board for
the Chairman and a trusted
intermediary for other Directors
Available to discuss concerns
with stakeholders that cannot
be resolved through the normal
channels of the Chairman or the
Executive Directors
Responsible for
leading the Chairman’s
performance evaluation.
Bring an external perspective, sound judgement
and objectivity to the Board’s deliberations and
decision making
Scrutinise, measure and review the performance of
the Executive Directors
Constructively challenge and assist in the
development of Group strategy
Provide independent insight, support and any
specialist advice
Monitor the implementation of the Group’s
strategy within its risk and control framework and
consider the integrity of financial reporting.
Provides advice and assistance
to the Chairman and
other Directors
Supports the Chairman on
shareholder governance and
engagement matters
Develops agendas for
Board meetings
Oversees processes for
providing information to
the Board
Advises the Board on all
corporate governance matters
Considers Board eectiveness
and Directors’ training needs in
conjunction with the Chairman
Ensures compliance with
relevant statutory and
regulatory requirements.
Executive Committee
Provides executive leadership to
deliver the Group’s strategy and
manages the operations of the Group
on a day-to-day basis.
Monitors SHE compliance and responses to
incidents and near misses
Continually focuses on customer service and
quality performance
Leads operational and financial matters
Develops and monitors the Group’s
sustainability strategy
Considers legal matters, business ethics and
culture and how this operates within the Group
Oversees the People strategy including, talent
management, diversity and inclusion initiatives
and employee engagement.
Management committees
Divisional boards
Safety, Health & Environment
Committee
Sustainability Committee
Each division is run by a divisional board
comprising directors responsible for
specific disciplines.
They consider the operational matters and key
risks of the division, monitor and control costs
at a divisional level and ensures high levels of
customer service and SHE performance.
Further detail on our divisions can be found
on page 3.
The SHE Committee oversees the management
of the Group’s SHE risks. It monitors performance
against the Group’s SHE strategy and sets
associated policies, procedures and initiatives.
The Sustainability Committee oversees the
management of the Group’s sustainability risks.
It monitors performance against the Group’s
sustainability strategy and recommends
associated targets, policies and initiatives to
the Board.
Board Committees
Audit and Risk Committee
Nomination Committee Remuneration Committee
Oversees external financial reporting and
disclosures, and monitors internal controls
and risk management. The Audit and Risk
Committee reviews the eectiveness
and independence of the external and
internal auditors.
Reviews the balance, diversity, independence
and eectiveness of the Board. The Nomination
Committee oversees the selection and
appointment of new Directors to the Board and
monitors succession planning for the Board and the
ELT, alongside talent management.
Sets the remuneration policy for the Board and
ELT, with focus on aligning remuneration with
the enhancement of shareholder value and
delivery of the Group’s strategy.
The Remuneration Committee considers
employee pay, when setting remuneration for
the Executive Directors.
Board composition
There is a clear corporate governance framework to enable
decision making at appropriate levels within the Group.
Crest Nicholson 66 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Iain Ferguson CBE
Chairman
Peter Truscott
Chief Executive
Bill Floydd
Group Finance
Director
Octavia Morley
Senior Independent
Director
David Arnold, Louise Hardy
and Maggie Semple OBE
Independent Non-Executive Directors
Penny Thomas
Group Company
Secretary
The Board Roles and responsibilities
The Board sets the Group’s strategy
to promote the long-term sustainable
success of the Group in line with the
purpose, values and culture.
The Board provides leadership within a framework
of strong governance, risk management and
eective controls. It oversees the performance
and progress of the Group against business plans,
utilising KPIs to support it in its assessment.
The Board has a schedule of matters reserved
for its own decision which includes setting
profit expectations and dividend policy and
approving major acquisitions, capital expenditure
and financing.
Leads the Board, major shareholder and other
stakeholder engagement
Supports the Chief Executive’s management of
the business
Applies independent and objective judgement
Sets agendas that enable appropriate coverage of
all areas material to the Board and which support
eective and balanced decision making
Ensures that the Board receives accurate and
timely information to aid decision making
Facilitates an environment for eective and
constructive relationships between all Directors
Drives a culture that supports constructive
discussion, challenge, debate and decision making
Contributes to the Board’s succession planning,
induction and composition deliberations while
promoting equality, opportunity, diversity
and inclusion
Ensures the views of stakeholders are considered
appropriately in Board discussions
Responsible for the eectiveness of the Board and
its governance
Prioritises the development of the Group’s strategy.
Responsible for the leadership of the Group and
implementing the Group’s strategy
Maintains communication with the Chairman in
relation to strategic considerations
Manages the overall performance of the
business and provides eective leadership to
members of the ELT
Proposes and leads the delivery of strategy as
agreed by the Board
Leads the Executive Committee which oversees
operational and financial performance
Communicates and provides feedback about
the implementation of Group policies and their
impact on behaviours and culture
Leads and supports the Group’s divisions and its
support functions
Engages with institutional shareholders and key
stakeholder groups including the Government
Responsible to the Board for sustainability
policies and practices of the Group.
Provides leadership, direction
and management of Group
Finance and oversees divisional
financial control functions
Responsible for the Group’s
financial statements, financial
control mechanisms and
tax strategy
Delivers investor relations
communications to
capital markets
Manages the Group’s risk
profile and establishes eective
internal controls
Oversees the implementation
of the Group’s risk
management actions
Manages the Group’s
relationship with the
external auditor.
Acts as a sounding board for
the Chairman and a trusted
intermediary for other Directors
Available to discuss concerns
with stakeholders that cannot
be resolved through the normal
channels of the Chairman or the
Executive Directors
Responsible for
leading the Chairman’s
performance evaluation.
Bring an external perspective, sound judgement
and objectivity to the Board’s deliberations and
decision making
Scrutinise, measure and review the performance of
the Executive Directors
Constructively challenge and assist in the
development of Group strategy
Provide independent insight, support and any
specialist advice
Monitor the implementation of the Group’s
strategy within its risk and control framework and
consider the integrity of financial reporting.
Provides advice and assistance
to the Chairman and
other Directors
Supports the Chairman on
shareholder governance and
engagement matters
Develops agendas for
Board meetings
Oversees processes for
providing information to
the Board
Advises the Board on all
corporate governance matters
Considers Board eectiveness
and Directors’ training needs in
conjunction with the Chairman
Ensures compliance with
relevant statutory and
regulatory requirements.
Management committees
Divisional boards
Safety, Health & Environment
Committee
Sustainability Committee
Each division is run by a divisional board
comprising directors responsible for
specific disciplines.
They consider the operational matters and key
risks of the division, monitor and control costs
at a divisional level and ensures high levels of
customer service and SHE performance.
Further detail on our divisions can be found
on page 3.
The SHE Committee oversees the management
of the Group’s SHE risks. It monitors performance
against the Group’s SHE strategy and sets
associated policies, procedures and initiatives.
The Sustainability Committee oversees the
management of the Group’s sustainability risks.
It monitors performance against the Group’s
sustainability strategy and recommends
associated targets, policies and initiatives to
the Board.
Land acquisition process
There is a clear dedicated approval process for
acquiring land.
There are three key stages:
Assessment and feasibility stage
Bid stage
Contract stage.
The Investment Committee provides the relevant
authority to acquire land.
The process enables the Group to act quickly
while ensuring an appropriate level of diligence is
applied to significant capital allocation decisions.
Board Committees
Audit and Risk Committee
Nomination Committee Remuneration Committee
Oversees external financial reporting and
disclosures, and monitors internal controls
and risk management. The Audit and Risk
Committee reviews the eectiveness
and independence of the external and
internal auditors.
Reviews the balance, diversity, independence
and eectiveness of the Board. The Nomination
Committee oversees the selection and
appointment of new Directors to the Board and
monitors succession planning for the Board and the
ELT, alongside talent management.
Sets the remuneration policy for the Board and
ELT, with focus on aligning remuneration with
the enhancement of shareholder value and
delivery of the Group’s strategy.
The Remuneration Committee considers
employee pay, when setting remuneration for
the Executive Directors.
Further detail on the work of the
Audit and Risk Committee can
be found on pages 74 to 80
Further detail on the work of the
Nomination Committee can be
found on pages 70 to 73
Further detail on the work of the
Remuneration Committee can
be found on pages 81 to 98
Crest Nicholson 67 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Board evaluation cycle
FY23 activity in response to the FY22 Board evaluation
Board evaluation
FY21
Externally facilitated
evaluation carried out by
Gould Consulting (who
have no connection with
the Group or Directors)
FY22
Internally facilitated
evaluation led by
the Chairman
FY23
Internally facilitated
evaluation led by
the Chairman
Culture and values
Initiated a culture perception study
Provided opportunities for the
Non-Executive Directors to meet
with members of the ELT outside of
formal meetings
Enhanced feedback and
regular reporting of employee
engagement activities.
Board meetings
The Board continued the use of update
calls between Board meetings
Spent further time on ‘horizon scanning’
emerging risks facing the Group.
Succession planning
Board and ELT succession planning
continued to be a key priority
Investment in the Crest Academy at both
entry-level and senior management.
In accordance with the Code, the Board undertakes a formal
and rigorous evaluation annually to assess the eectiveness of
its Directors, its Committees and the Board as a whole. The evaluation
process is externally facilitated every three years. This years
evaluation process was conducted internally led by the Chairman
and facilitated by Gould Consulting.
Crest Nicholson 68 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
The evaluation process concluded that the Board and its Committees operated eectively and
had made good progress with its actions in the prior year. The Board agreed to focus on the
following matters during FY24.
Culture and values
The Group will continue
to build on the work
undertaken on culture
during FY23. A culture
action plan will be
developed. See page 60
The Board will continue to
prioritise opportunities for
Non-Executive Directors
to meet with members
of the ELT outside of
formal meetings.
Succession planning
The Board, ELT and
divisional boards’
succession plans will
continue to be a key
priority in FY24
The Chairman to oversee
the onboarding for new
members of the Board
including the Group
Finance Director and
Non-Executive Director.
The induction programme
for Bill Floydd and Maggie
Semple is set out on
page 73.
Strategic Priorities
The Board will strengthen
its focus on customers and
quality to deliver five-star
customer experience.
Committee evaluations
Each Board Committee
continues to operate
eectively and all
recommendations are
covered in the Board
action plan.
Stage 3
– November 2023
The Board agreed this year’s process would again be an internal evaluation led by
the Chairman.
Following good engagement with Gould Consulting with the external evaluation in FY21
and their support to the Chairman during the FY22 evaluation, the Nomination Committee
proposed that their services be used for the internal evaluation this year. There was a tailored
questionnaire in a similar form to last year which enabled year-on-year comparison to standard
questions together with additional questions to address current topics of interest to the Board.
The Chairman agreed the form of questions.
It was agreed that review of the Chairman’s performance would be led by Octavia Morley
inher capacity as Senior Independent Director.
The evaluation was conducted as follows:
All Directors completed the questionnaire online. Questions covered key Board matters with
questions also covering each of the Board Committees
A shorter survey was completed by the ELT
The results were analysed, summarising the comments and identifying key themes, which
were shared at a meeting with the Chairman
One-to-one meetings were held by the Chairman with each of the Directors
A Non-Executive Director meeting was led by the Senior Independent Director to consider
the Chairman’s performance, with the Chairman not present.
The Chairman presented the output from the evaluation at the following Nomination
Committee and Board meetings.
The Senior Independent Director presented the output of the Chairman’s performance from
the meeting with the Non-Executive Directors.
The Board considered the key findings and agreed an action plan.
3
4
1
2
Board evaluation process
Nomination
Committee
and Board
discussion
Stage 1 – July 2023
Meeting with the
Nomination Committee
and Board
Output
Focused
questionnaire
and meetings
Stage 2
– September 2023
Stage 4 – FY24
Crest Nicholson 69 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Nomination Committee Report
An appropriately balanced Board and
Executive Leadership Team with the right skills
experience and diversity, is essential for our
performance both now and in the future.
Iain Ferguson CBE
Nomination Committee
Chair
David Arnold
Non-Executive
Director
Maggie Semple OBE
Non-Executive
Director
Louise Hardy
Non-Executive
Director
Octavia Morley
Senior Independent
Director
For further information on the search and
selection processes for both the Group
Finance Director and Non-Executive Director
see page 73.
Diversity and inclusion
We continue to recognise and embrace
the benefits of having a diverse Board and
senior management team. The dierent
perspectives, backgrounds and experiences
enhance Board discussions and bring
tangible value to the long-term future of Crest
Nicholson. While appointments are made on
merit, we consider background, experience,
age, ethnicity and gender in our reviews
of the composition of the Board and the
Executive Committee.
Iain Ferguson CBE
Nomination Committee Chair
Membership
The Committee has been chaired by Iain
Ferguson, the Chairman of the Company,
since 2019. All other members of the
Committee are Non-Executive Directors.
Lucinda Bell was a member of the
Committee until 31 December 2023.
Maggie Semple joined the Committee
on1 January 2024.
Individual meeting attendance is set out
on page 65.
Attendees
The Chief Executive, Group HR Director and
Group Company Secretary are invited to
attend scheduled Committee meetings.
Committee overview
I am pleased to present this years
Nomination Committee Report. The report
sets out how the Committee discharged
its responsibilities during the year, which
includes ensuring the Group has eective
leadership, with the right balance of skills,
experience, diversity, independence and
knowledge at the Board and Executive
Leadership Team levels.
Board changes
In July 2023 we announced that Duncan
Cooper, our Group Finance Director would be
resigning from the Group. Duncan left Crest
Nicholson in December 2023. During his
tenure he played a vital role in the strategic
and operational turnaround of the business.
The Committee are grateful for Duncan’s
significant contribution to the Group and
we wish him all the best for the future.
The Committee undertook a search
process for a new Group Finance Director.
Bill Floydd was appointed on 13 November
2023 and brings significant chief financial
ocer experience from the listed
companies environment.
In November 2023 Lucinda Bell advised
the Board it was her intention to step
down as Non-Executive Director having
completed six years with the Company.
The Committee thanks Lucinda for her time
and commitment to the Board during her
tenure. The Committee commenced a search
process for a Non-Executive Director and
was pleased to welcome Maggie Semple to
the Board on 1 January 2024.
Committee members
Crest Nicholson 70 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Key responsibilities and activities of
the Committee
The Committee is responsible for reviewing
the structure, size and composition of the
Board to ensure that it remains eective,
balanced and qualified to deliver the Group’s
strategy. To achieve this, the Committee is
responsible for the nomination, induction and
evaluation of Directors.
The Committee is also responsible for
succession planning for the Executive
Directors, ELT and senior management.
The Committee leads the Board’s approach
to diversity and inclusion and identifies and
oversees its initiatives in this area.
Highlights and key decisions
made during the year
The Committee led the selection and
recruitment process for the appointment of
a new Group Finance Director, considering
carefully the Group’s priorities for the
medium to long term
Concluded the search for a Non-
Executive Director
Considered Executive Committee
composition, including the changes to its
membership during the year
Supported and endorsed the Group’s
diversity and inclusion initiatives, which
included the development of the Anity
Groups, that were launched during FY22
Reviewed and approved the Board and
Leadership Diversity Policy, and the
approach to meeting its targets
Agreed and made recommendations to
strengthen succession plans, including
specific development and coaching needs
for key talent
Reflective of the current market
challenges, reviewed the talent
management programmes, balancing
financial constraints with the need to
develop and support the Group’s key talent
Oversaw the Board and Committee
internal evaluation process and reviewed
the results
Reviewed the Committees’ composition,
and agreed that they remain appropriate
Reviewed the Committee’s terms
of reference.
Developing talent
The Committee remains committed to
investment in the Crest Academy, which was
launched in 2021 to support and develop
employees. While the external environment
remains challenging, the Committee needs
to ensure that when the market recovers the
Group can respond to market need eectively
and that the Group has committed, capable
employees who have the capacity to deliver
results. Further detail on developing our
people can be found on pages 28 to 29.
Succession planning
The Committee plays a vital role in the
eectiveness of the Board and its ability to
deliver the long-term success of the Group.
This includes continually reviewing the
balance of skills, experience, independence
and knowledge to ensure the right individuals
are in place to support the eective planning
and implementation of the Group’s strategy.
Along with considering Board succession, the
Committee also reviews the capability of the
ELT and senior management roles, so that
there is a talented and diverse pipeline of
future leaders.
The Committee considers succession plans for
ELT members and divisional board members.
These succession plans are complemented
by a performance and development review
process. The Group partners with a specialist
external advisor, to provide training and
coaching programmes for the Group’s
nominated talent. Through a structured
approach to development opportunities, the
Group is committed to focusing on retaining
and developing its high-potential individuals
and emerging talent.
Emergency succession planning
The Committee considered the Emergency
Succession Plan for the ELT. This is a high-
level contingency plan to respond to an
immediate and unexpected lack of availability
of the Chief Executive, another member of
the ELT, or a divisional Managing Director,
where such absence would be reasonably
expected to be more than two weeks.
Board and Leadership Diversity
Policy
The Group has a Board and Leadership
Diversity Policy which is reviewed annually
by the Committee and applied in a similar
way to senior management. The Policy
reflects a recognition that a diverse Board,
Board Committees and leadership improves
operational performance. The Policy has
targets for at least:
40% of the Board to be female
At least one of the Senior Board positions
(comprised of either Chairman, Chief
Executive, Senior Independent Director or
Group Finance Director) to be female
One Director to be appointed to the Board
from an ethnic minority background by end
of 2024 (in line with the Parker Review)
40% female representation across senior
management by end of 2025
13% ethnic minority background
representation across senior management
by end of 2027.
The full terms of reference for theCommittee can be found at
www.crestnicholson.com/investors/corporate-governance
The Board meets the requirements of the
Board and Leadership Diversity Policy
and is working towards meeting its senior
management targets.
The policy also outlines the Group’s
recruitment approach that aims to attract
and encourage candidates from diverse
backgrounds. It has a requirement that all
search firms used for Board recruitment are
members of the Voluntary Code of Conduct
for Executive Search Firms and commit to
broadening their search and ensuring that
short lists reflect a clear range of ethnicity,
gender and social characteristics.
The Committee is updated at each of its
meetings on actions being undertaken by
the Group to develop female talent and
talent from other under-represented groups.
In recognition of the barriers women face
when rising to senior management, the Group
has launched a talent programme specifically
designed for females. Further detail is
available on page 28. There are also Anity
Groups that report into a Diversity and
Inclusion Forum, to raise awareness, develop
ideas and feedback concerns related to
their area of focus. Further details of these
initiatives can be found on pages 28 to 29.
How time was spent
A Succession planning 20%
B Diversity and inclusion 15%
C Directors’ appointments 25%
D Shareholder engagement 15%
E Governance matters 15%
F Board evaluation 10%
A
B
C
D
E
F
Crest Nicholson 71 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
1 The numerical data detailing gender identity and ethnic background is as disclosed by the relevant individuals. The chosen reference date for the purposes of LR9.8R(9)(a), is 31 October for
gender background reporting and 31 December for ethnic background reporting.
2 Chief Executive, Group Finance Director, Chairman and Senior Independent Director.
3 Comprises all members of the Executive Committee as shown on page 58, as well as their direct reports.
4 Comprises all employees of the Group including senior management.
The Board’s skills and experience
The Committee recognises the importance of diversity within the Board, ELT and senior
management teams. Each Director’s skills and experience bring dierent insights and contributions to
the Board and are set out below:
Independence, election and
re-election to the Board
The Committee reviews the eectiveness
and commitment of all Directors before
recommending their election or re-election
toshareholders at the AGM.
The Committee considers the independence
of the Non-Executive Directors.
The Committee discusses the additional
commitments of all Directors (including
the Chairman) before recommending their
approval to the Board. It also considers
potential conflict issues as part of
that assessment.
The Committee has undertaken a review
and is satisfied with the contributions and
time commitment of all the Directors during
the year.
The Board is considered independent.
Bill Floydd and Maggie Semple are standing
for election by shareholders at the AGM, with
all other Directors standing for re-election at
the AGM in March 2024 with the support of
the Board.
Nomination Committee Report continued
Gender identity reporting
1
Number of
Board
members
Percentage
of the
Board
Number of
senior positions
on the Board
2
Number
in executive
management
3
Percentage
of executive
management
3
Number of
employees
4
Percentage
of
employees
4
Men 4 57% 3 31 62% 451 62%
Women 3 43% 1 19 38% 272 38%
Not specified/prefer not to say
Diversity within the Group
Ethnic background reporting
1
Number of
Board
members
Percentage
of the
Board
Number of
senior positions
on the Board
2
Number
in executive
management
3
Percentage
of executive
management
3
Number of
employees
4
Percentage
of
employees
4
White British or other White
(including minority groups) 7 100% 4 44 88% 600 86%
Mixed/Multiple ethnic groups 1 2% 14 2%
Asian/Asian British 2 4% 26 4%
Black/African/Caribbean/Black British 3 6% 30 4%
Other ethnic group, including Arab 4 1%
Not specified/prefer not to say 25 3%
Direct experience
Indirect experience
Housebuilding
Industry/
sector
Engineering and infrastructure
Construction
UK listed companies
Remuneration Committee chair experience
Company chair experience
Audit and Risk Committee chair experience
Senior Independent Director experience
Nomination Committee chair experience
Strategy
Management and leadership
Finance
Joint ventures and partnerships
Marketing
Investors
Government and industry
ESG (including climate)
People
Customer service
Supply chain
2
2
3
Stakeholder
experience
3
1
4
3
2
1
1
2
7
7
7
7
7
2
4
4
5
3
3
3
2
5 2
5 2
4
5
GovernanceStrategic and
operational
Crest Nicholson 72 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Board appointment process
The Committee was responsible for the oversight of the selection process for a new Group Finance Director and Non-Executive Director.
The Committee reviewed and approved detailed descriptions for both roles having considered the particular skills, experience and background
required, mindful of both operational needs and compliance with the Code. The Committee prioritised the Board and Leadership Diversity
Policy and the Parker Review recommendations during both processes.
Bill Floydd’s induction programme
Bill’s induction specifically related to the Group financial controls,
risk management, capital markets and cyber security, and included
the following elements:
One-to-one meetings with members of the ELT covering strategy,
operational and financial matters, people and culture and values
Welcome meeting with the Group and divisional Finance teams
providing an overview of roles and responsibilities
Meeting with the Head of Internal Audit with respect to the FY24
Internal Audit Plan
Meeting with the external auditor, PwC, to receive an update on
the FY23 audit
Met the divisional boards and attended divisional meetings
Visited a wide range of sites across the Group’s divisions
Introductory meetings with the Group’s corporate advisors
and brokers.
Maggie Semples induction programme
Maggie’s induction is focusing on Board and Committee areas and
further detail on Maggie’s induction will be outlined in the FY24
Annual Report.
Induction plans
Tailored induction plans are developed for Directors.
All newly appointed Directors received information on
the following:
We are Crest Nicholson
Welcome meeting from the Chief Executive on the
Group’s strategy and operational challenges
Site visits with the ELT and divisional boards
Specific focused sessions for each Director on their role
within the Group.
Governance and culture
Welcome meeting from the Chairman on Board operations
and current areas of focus
Welcome meeting with the Non-Executive Directors
Meeting with the Group HR Director on People matters
Briefing from the Group Company Secretary on
Board governance.
There are regular touchpoints with the Chairman and Group
Company Secretary to monitor progress and ensure that
Directors receive all the information required to fulfil their roles.
The search commenced in July 2023 in conjunction with
Russell Reynolds. Russell Reynolds have no connection with
the Company.
A shortlist of candidates was interviewed by the Chairman and
Chief Executive. Bill Floydd was selected to be taken forward
to the final stage of the process. This included meeting with
the Senior Independent Director and Chair of the Audit and
Risk Committee.
Following consideration of the feedback, the Committee went on
to recommend the appointment of Bill Floydd as Group Finance
Director due to his:
Broad plc experience
Strong financial leadership
Proven commercial expertise.
The search commenced in May 2023 in conjunction with Korn
Ferry. A separate division of Korn Ferry acts as independent
advisor to the Remuneration Committee. The Committee, Board
and Remuneration Committee are satisfied that the advice they
receive from Korn Ferry is independent and objective at all times.
After interviewing a range of strong and diverse candidates,
Maggie Semple was selected to be taken forward to the final
stage of the process.
Following consideration of the feedback, the Committee
recommended the appointment of Maggie Semple as Non-
Executive Director due to her:
Non-Executive Director experience
Wide-ranging sector expertise
Extensive interest on customer experience, people
and culture.
Dr Maggie Semple, OBE
Non-Executive Director
Bill Floydd
Group Finance Director
Since joining the Board I have
received a comprehensive induction,
visited several of our sites and met a
number of colleagues which has given
me a detailed insight into the business
as I started my role.
Bill Floydd
Group Finance Director
Crest Nicholson 73 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Audit and Risk Committee Report
The Committee supports the interests of shareholders
and stakeholders by providing independent challenge
and oversight to financial reporting, risk management
and internal control processes.
David Arnold
Audit and Risk Committee
Chair
Committee members
Louise Hardy
Non-Executive Director
Committee overview
As Chair of the Committee, I am pleased to
present this years Audit and Risk Committee
Report. I will outline how the Committee
discharged its responsibilities, predominantly
monitoring the integrity of financial reporting,
the eectiveness of risk management and
internal control processes and governance
and compliance matters.
This financial year has been characterised by
a challenging external trading environment
requiring commercial discipline and proactive
management. The Committee oversees the
Group’s risk management processes and
internal controls so that the Group is well-
placed to deliver ongoing value creation for
shareholders and capitalise on future growth
opportunities as they arise.
The Internal Audit function continued to
perform well, and the Committee is pleased
with the support it receives, benefiting from
their insight and challenge.
Following the appointment last year of an
Operational Framework Director, progress has
been made to ensure our Group operating
policies and internal controls are further
developed and appropriate for the organisation.
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (PwC) remain
our external auditor. I was in regular contact
with Darryl Phillips, the audit partner, to
discuss the audit process and findings. We are
making arrangements to tender the external
auditor contract during the course of FY24.
As part of our ongoing commitments, under
the Government’s Building Safety Pledge, time
was spent by the Committee on assessing
the appropriateness and composition of the
provision in respect to combustible materials.
More detail is available on page 76.
The Committee were disappointed that
control shortcomings were identified in two
divisions specifically around costs and margin
forecasting. These matters came to light
towards the end of the financial year and the
ELT continue to take steps to remedy these
deficiencies, which the Committee will monitor
over the course of the coming year.
The Group’s Annual Report and financial
statements for FY22 were reviewed by
the Financial Reporting Council (FRC) in
accordance with Part 2 of the FRC Corporate
Reporting Review Operational Review
Operating Procedures. I am pleased to report
that following their review we have considered
their recommendations and reflected
where appropriate.
I am pleased to confirm the Committee
continues to meet the FRC Guidance on
Audit Committees and the FRC Minimum
Standard for Audit Committees. We remain
committed to ensuring that the accountability
principles set out within the Code are applied
and that the interests of shareholders and
other stakeholders are properly protected in
these areas.
Finally, my fellow Committee members and
I would like to extend our thanks to Duncan
Cooper, Group Finance Director, who left the
Group on 13 December 2023 and wish him
well for the future. The Committee and I look
forward to working with Bill Floydd during the
coming year.
David Arnold
Audit and Risk Committee Chair
Membership
The Committee has been chaired by
David Arnold, since September 2021.
All the members are independent Non-
Executive Directors.
David Arnold is the Director with recent
and relevant financial experience.
The Board is satisfied that the Committee
as a whole has competence relevant to
the sector.
Lucinda Bell was a member of the
Committee until 31 December 2023.
Maggie Semple joined the Committee on
1 January 2024.
Individual meeting attendance is set out
on page 65.
Attendees
The Chairman, Chief Executive, Group
Finance Director, Group HR Director,
Group Company Secretary, Group
Financial Controller, the Head of
Internal Audit, Group Tax Director and
representatives from our external auditor,
PwC, are invited to attend scheduled
Committee meetings as required.
Maggie Semple OBE
Non-Executive Director
Octavia Morley
Senior Independent
Director
Crest Nicholson 74 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Activity during the year
Financial reporting
Reviewed reports from the Group Finance team, management’s significant accounting
judgements and the policies applied, recommendations were made to the Board to approve
the FY22 and HY23 results, associated announcement and the FY22 Annual Report.
Reviewed the basis of preparation of the FY22 financial statements as a going concern as set out in
the accounting policies and recommended that the Board support the going concern statement.
Considered the long-term viability statement in the FY22 Annual Report, with focus on the
judgements, estimates and testing, with a recommendation to the Board to support the long-
term viability statement.
Recommendation made to the Board that the FY22 Annual Report was a fair, balanced and
understandable assessment of the Group’s position and prospects.
External audit
Assessed the eectiveness of the FY22 external audit and concluded that the audit was eective
and agreed that PwC should be proposed for reappointment as the external auditor at the
2023 AGM.
Considered and approved PwC’s Group audit plan for the FY23 financial results and the
recommended Audit Quality Indicators.
Received PwC’s findings from the FY22 external audit and the HY23 interim review.
Recommendation made to the Board to approve the letter of representation to PwC in
respect to the FY22 and HY23 results.
Approved the services and fees for non-audit related services provided by PwC for the FY23
financial year. The Committee agreed that the policy for the provision of non-audit services
by the external auditor remained appropriate.
Negotiated and agreed the statutory audit fee for the FY23 financial year.
Considered and approved the approach for an external audit tender.
Risk management and internal control environment
Reviewed the eectiveness of the risk management activities and the Group’s
internal controls.
Considered the principal and emerging risks together with their associated mitigating
actions. Recommended to the Board the risks to be included in the FY22 and HY23
financial results.
Reviewed progress by management on the Operating Framework Review.
Internal Audit
Reviewed and approved the Group’s Internal Audit Charter.
Agreed that the Internal Audit plan for FY24 and proposed audits were relevant and
appropriate in the light of the Group’s principal and emerging risks.
Considered Internal Audit reports, findings and agreed actions.
Reviewed the scope, quality and eectiveness of Internal Audit. Concluded that the Internal
Audit function has provided independent and objective assurance over the internal controls
based on the Internal Audit Plan.
Governance matters
Terms of reference for the Committee were considered and it was agreed they remained in
line with best practice and complied with the Code.
Monitored compliance in respect to data privacy, anti-money laundering, bribery and
corruption, whistleblowing reports and investigations and other compliance matters.
The full terms of reference for theCommittee can be found at
www.crestnicholson.com/investors/corporate-governance
Key responsibilities and activities
of the Committee
The Audit and Risk Committee is responsible
for reviewing the eectiveness of the Group’s
internal controls and risk management.
This includes the Group’s procedures for
detecting fraud, its processes and controls
for the prevention of bribery and the
eectiveness of the Group’s anti-money
laundering systems.
The Committee monitors and reviews the
independence, objectivity and eectiveness
of Internal Audit. It evaluates and agrees
the Group’s Internal Audit plans and
receives regular update reports on Internal
Audit’s findings.
The Committee monitors the integrity of
the Group’s financial statements and any
significant announcements relating to
its financial performance. This includes
assessing significant financial reporting
judgements contained within the financial
statements and announcements.
The Committee is responsible for monitoring
and reviewing the eectiveness of the
external auditor. The Committee advises
on matters related to the external auditor
including their appointment and re-
appointment, their fees, and reviewing
and monitoring their independence and
objectivity which includes the extent of any
non-audit services provided.
How time was spent
A Financial reporting 20%
B External audit 25%
C Risk management and
internal control environment
20%
D Internal Audit 20%
E Governance matters 15%
A
B
C
D
E
FRC Review
The Group’s Annual Report and financial statements for FY22 were reviewed by the Financial Reporting Council (FRC) in accordance with
Part 2 of the FRC Corporate Reporting Review Operational Review Operating Procedures.
The FRC noted certain matters where it believes users of the Annual Report would benefit from improvements in existing disclosures.
The Committee has reviewed these matters and has ensured that they have been addressed through amendments to the current year
disclosures, where relevant and appropriate. The FRC’s letter only considered compliance with reporting requirements and does not verify
the accounts nor provide any assurance that the Annual Report and financial statements are correct in all material respects and accepts no
liability for reliance on their review by the Group or any third party, including but not limited to shareholders.
Crest Nicholson 75 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Key financial and internal control matters
During FY23 the Committee considered the following key financial and internal control matters in relation to the Group’s financial statements
and disclosures with input from management and the external auditor.
Keynancial
and internal
control matters How the Committee has addressed these matters
Valuation of
inventory
Inventory is the most significant balance on the consolidated statement of financial position and is held at the lower of
cost and net realisable value (NRV). A forecast is maintained for the NRV of each development and this contains several
key assumptions. Due to the influence of external factors and the cyclical nature of the housing market, there is a risk
that the calculation of the developments’ NRV may be subject to estimation error, leading to inventory being held at an
incorrect value when an impairment charge to reduce its value would be appropriate. Management regularly review the
selling prices and build costs of all the Group’s housing stock, including the impact on future forecasts for developments
not yet under construction, considering latest market valuations. Where forecasts determine that a site may no longer
generate a margin, any impairment is recognised in the consolidated income statement. During FY23 £13.4m of
impairment has been charged, mainly relating to the legacy Farnham development already held at zero margin, and,
£5.8m of impairment has been used in the year on housing units sold, resulting in a net movement in the NRV provision
of £7.6m in the year.
The Committee understands the controls in place concerning NRV, including the minimum hurdle rates management
require before projects are approved and how management monitors NRV on an ongoing basis. Where impairment
has been recognised during FY23, the Committee challenged management to ensure that appropriate assumptions
were in place, in particular around expected levels of sales prices and build costs. The Committee was satisfied that the
inventory carrying value, and associated impairment, was appropriate.
Margin
forecasting and
inventory
The Group’s margin recognition framework is based on the margin forecast for each phase of development.
These margins, which drive the recognition of costs as revenue is taken, reflect estimated selling prices and costs
for each development. This methodology then guides the allocation of total forecast costs, matching both land and
build costs of a development, to each component of revenue. There is a risk that the margin forecast for the site and
the margin subsequently recognised on revenue is not appropriate and reflective of the actual final profit that will be
recognised on a development. Sales prices and build costs are inherently uncertain as they are influenced by changes
in external market factors, such as the availability and aordability of mortgages, changes in customer demand due to
market uncertainty and availability of labour and materials.
The Committee continues to review managements internal control processes, the main areas of estimation and
challenges management. The Committee reviewed management’s assessment of controls in two divisions which were
not eective during the year, and understood the additional work performed by management to gain comfort over build
cost position.
Combustible
materials
provision
The Group has recognised a net exceptional combustibles materials related charge of £5.3m in the year, in addition
to that recognised in prior years. The year end provision balance is £144.8m. The charges relate to forecast costs
associated with remedial works to be performed on legacy buildings with potential fire safety issues due to combustible
materials and where the Group has a legal or constructive obligation to remediate.
The combustible materials provision has increased by £4.0m in the year. This increase reflects forecast changes in build
costs and the imputed interest on the provision balance, net of amounts spent in the year. As a consequence of signing
the Developer Remediation Contract on 13 March 2023, the Group has entered into contractual commitments with the
UK Government to identify and remediate those buildings it has developed with possible life-critical fire safety defects
going back 30 years to 1992. The Directors have used Building Safety Fund (BSF) cost information, other external
information and internal assessments as a basis for the estimated remedial costs, as well as considering the impacts
of build cost inflation. These estimates are inherently uncertain due to the highly complex and bespoke nature of the
buildings, actual costs diering to the amounts notified by the BSF costed projects, and that fire safety assessments in
progress may require dierent levels of remediation and associated costs than those currently estimated.
This is a highly complex area with judgements in respect of the extent of those properties within the scope of the
Group’s combustible materials guidance and the provision could be extended as the interpretation of Government
guidance continues to evolve or due to cost estimation changes. By contrast, the Group expects to recover some costs
from architects and subcontractors involved in the construction of these schemes but does not recognise these benefits
until they are received.
The Committee reviewed and challenged the appropriateness, quantum, adequacy and completeness of the provision
taking into account Government guidance in this area, experience gained since 2019 and potential exposure over the
population of legacy developments. The Committee agreed that there was no certainty over the potential quantum
of the contingent liability associated with sites not yet identified or provided for. The Committee was satisfied that the
provision and related disclosures are appropriate.
Due to the size and nature of the individual items within the charge, the Committee has agreed with management’s
opinion to continue to treat the combustible materials charge, and associated recoveries, as an exceptional item.
Audit and Risk Committee Report continued
Crest Nicholson 76 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Viability and going concern
The Committee reviewed management’s
consideration in relation to the prospects of the
Group. It satisfied itself that the going concern
basis of preparation continues to be appropriate
and made recommendations to the Board in this
regard. The Company’s viability statement can
be found on page 52.
Further information on the Group’s going
concern assessment can be found in note 1 to
the consolidated financial statements.
Fair, balanced and understandable
At the request of the Board, the Committee has
considered whether the FY23 Annual Report
and financial statements is fair, balanced and
understandable and whether the information
provided is necessary for stakeholders to
assess the Group’s strategy performance and
business model.
The FY23 Annual Report and financial
statements is focused on the Group’s key
strategic messages and it is important that an
assessment is undertaken to ensure these
messages are fairly summarised and provide an
accurate description of performance.
The fair, balanced and understandable process
was led by the Group Finance Director, supported
by members of Group Finance, Company
Secretariat, Investor Relations, Sustainability,
HR and Marketing functions. This group was
responsible for regularly reviewing the process
and ensuring balanced reporting with appropriate
links between key messages and sections of
the Annual Report and financial statements.
A recommendation was made from this group to
the Committee confirming that they considered
the Annual Report and financial statements to be
fair, balanced and understandable.
The Committee received a full draft of the
Annual Report and financial statements and
provided feedback on it. The draft feedback
was incorporated into the report prior to final
Board approval.
In particular, the Committee considered:
Fair Balanced Understandable
Provided a comprehensive review of the
Group’s activities and its strategy which
was communicated clearly and was
consistent throughout.
Provided a balanced view with
emphasis on both the key positive and
negative points.
Provided a clear and structured framework
for the Annual Report with key messages
appropriately outlined throughout.
Described current operational performance,
including market trends surrounding customer
service levels, market uncertainty, mortgage
availability and aordability and build inflation.
The principal risks faced by the Group and the
actions taken to mitigate this were considered
and explained.
Clearly outlined the key accounting
judgements and estimates in the
Committee’s report, consistent with those
outlined in the financial statements, and
how these reflected the external auditor’s
key audit matters.
Clearly and concisely presented the
information, alongside the Group’s
key performance indicators which
are considered most relevant to the
Group’s stakeholders.
Highlighted key messages in the narrative
report that were aligned with the
financial results.
Reflected appropriate events over the year
and acknowledged the material issues
faced by the Group.
Provided clear linkages and signposting
throughout the report.
Following review, the Committee is satisfied that, taken as a whole, the Annual Report and financial statements is fair, balanced and understandable.
External audit
External auditor
PwC was appointed as external auditor for the
year ended 31 October 2015 following a tender
process in 2014. Darryl Phillips, the Group’s lead
audit partner, is in the fourth year of his tenure
in FY23. The Group is currently undertaking
a tender exercise in accordance with the EU
Audit Regulation and Directive (as it forms part
of UK law), and subject to suitably qualified
tender participants, expects the tender to be
complete by the end of FY24.
The Group complies with the requirements
of the Statutory Audit Services for Large
Companies Market Investigation (Mandatory
Use of Competitive Tender Processes and
Audit Committee Responsibilities) Order
2014 with respect to both the approach to the
tender of the external audit and the provision
of non-audit services.
The external audit process
The Committee, on behalf of the Board, is
responsible for the relationship with the
external auditor. PwC presented the strategy
and scope of the FY23 audit alongside
proposed Audit Quality Indicators (AQIs).
AQIs are designed to assess the quality of
the audit and have been developed by PwC
alongside management.
AQIs assist the Committee in measuring both
managements and PwCs performance.
Committee meetings allow time for the
Committee and the external auditor to meet
without management being present. PwC also
meet with the Group Finance Director and the
Group Finance team at regular intervals during
the annual audit process.
External auditor eectiveness
An annual review of external audit
eectiveness is undertaken at the conclusion
of the year end audit. The review includes
assessing the audit process and the audit
firm. Feedback on the FY22 audit was
received from Committee members, Chief
Executive, Group Finance Director and
from Group and divisional representatives.
The Committee Chair also requested
PwC review and comment on the Group’s
internal process.
The review concluded that the audit process
and the audit team continue to perform well.
Their key strengths included a good quality
audit plan, with good communication and
with the Committee being kept informed
throughout the process. It was agreed that
going forward the planning process for
the divisional audits would be more clearly
communicated to the divisions.
Independence and non-audit services
The Committee keeps the independence of
the external auditor under regular review.
It considers PwC’s independence at least
once a year, receiving reports from PwC on its
internal quality controls and independence.
In assessing the independence of the auditor
from the Group, the Committee considers
the information and assurances provided by
the auditor confirming that all its partners
and employees involved with the audit are
independent of any links to the Group.
PwC confirmed their continued
independence as external auditor.
The Committee carefully considers the
non-audit services provided by PwC.
Where non-audit services are to be provided
by PwC, both the Group and PwC have
robust processes in place to prevent auditor
independence being compromised.
The Group operates a policy for the provision
of non-audit services that is reviewed annually
and is consistent with the regulatory framework
for statutory audit. The policy sets out the
types of non-audit service for which the use
of the external auditor is prohibited (including
accounting and valuation services) and provides
a list of activities that are ‘Permitted Non-Audit
Services’ that require the specific approval of the
Committee prior to any service being provided.
Crest Nicholson 77 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Operational Framework summary plan
The summary plan to complete the Operational Framework project is as follows:
Operational Framework project
Scoping and risk
assessment
Information
gap analysis
Information
gaps closed
Process mapping
and control
identification
Controls testing
and remediation
System design,
build and
implementation
System
go live
Non-audit fees
The Committee has a policy to pre-approve
permitted non-audit services where these are
below £50,000 per year. In the current year
the Committee approved all non-audit services
which were provided. Non-audit services
include PwCs interim review of the half-
year results which the Committee considers
supports PwCs work on the statutory full year
audit. PwC also provide non-audit assurance
services for sustainability reporting, Total fees
payable for these non-audit services were
£154,000 (FY22: £95,000). PwC also provides
audit services to the Group’s defined benefit
pension scheme and the associated fees are
met by the scheme. For further information
please see note 5 to the consolidated
financial statements.
2023 2022
Audit fees (£’000) 985 890
Non-audit fees
(£’000) 154 95
Ratio of non-audit
fees to audit fees 0.16:1 0.11:1
External auditor re-appointment
The Committee considers that PwC was
objective and independent throughout FY23
and is proposing that PwC be re-appointed
as external auditor to the Company at the
AGM. There are no contractual obligations
that restrict the Committee’s choice of auditor
and the recommendation is free from third-
party influence.
Risk management and control
environment
The Committee recognises that eective
risk management is key to the long-term
sustainable success of the Group and for
achieving the Group’s strategic priorities.
The Group’s principal and emerging risks are
considered by the Board. The Committee
regularly reviews the eectiveness of the risk
management process on behalf of the Board.
Both the Board and the Committee undertook
dedicated risk review sessions on the Group’s
principal and emerging risks during FY23 and
were satisfied that risk management processes
were appropriate and the control environment
as it applied to material controls was adequate.
There were specific weaknesses in the control
environments within two divisions over costs
and forecasting which were identified towards
the end of the financial year. The ELT continues
to take steps to address these issues which
have had oversight from the Committee.
Risk management approach
Risk review sessions are held at divisional
board level and reviewed and consolidated
into the Executive Committee’s Group risk
review. This then feeds into the information and
assurance processes of the Committee and into
the Board’s assessment of risk exposures and
the strategies to manage these risks.
The Board (with input from the Committee)
has carried out an assessment of the principal
and emerging risks facing the Group and how
those risks aect the prospects of the Group
alongside the mitigations in place.
During the year the Board, with support
from the Committee, reviewed its risk
appetite, which was themed around market,
operational and governance matters.
The Board’s regular review of its risk appetite
ensures the Executive Committee and divisional
boards are better placed in their decision making.
More information about our approach to risk and
our principal risks is found on pages 35 to 42.
To support the Board, the Committee reviews
the Group’s control environment alongside
the principal risks.
Eectiveness of risk management and
internal controls
The Group Finance Director has executive
responsibility for risk management and the
control environment. He is supported in this
role by the Group Head of Internal Audit,
the Group Financial Controller, the Group
Commercial Finance Director, and Group
Company Secretary.
Overall accountability for risk management and
internal controls sits with the Committee, and
they review pertinent risk management and
internal control information at every meeting.
Further details can be found on page 75.
The Group’s internal controls are designed
to mitigate, rather than eliminate, the risk
of not achieving the Group’s strategy
and objectives. As such, they can only
provide reasonable, and not absolute,
assurance against material misstatement
or loss. Further detail of our internal control
framework and assessment is below.
Last year the Group commenced a project to develop its
Operational Framework. The Operational Framework aims to
provide a visual overview of the Group’s end-to-end processes as
well as standardised key operational information that will be used
to induct new joiners, improve productivity for all employees and
provide a consistent operating environment.
During the year the project has focused on reviewing and updating
policies and procedures and producing a consistent set of
operational information for key process areas within the Group.
The project team is identifying and documenting key financial
controls across the Group, so that these are clearly stated within the
Operational Framework and can be regularly monitored and tested.
This work is planned to complete during 2024 and all operational
information will be easily accessible, enabling the Group to continue
to eectively mitigate financial risks and operate in a consistent way.
Audit and Risk Committee Report continued
Crest Nicholson 78 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Key financial and internal control matters
The Committee considered the following key financial and internal control matters in relation to the Group’s financial statements and disclosures
with input from management and the external auditor.
.
The Group has an internal control framework which defines
roles and responsibilities for managing risks and operating
internal controls at all levels of the Group:
Policies and procedures are in place for the main functions
of the Group to govern and explain why, what and how
we operate
Approval levels and limits are governed by the Group’s
Delegated Authority Manual and these are built into the
Group’s financial and operating systems
Employees are aware of the delegated authority limits set
by the Board and confirm their understanding of relevant
internal policies which are held on the Group’s intranet
Employees have annual performance development reviews
with training requirements identified and agreed
The Group operates a Speaking Up (whistleblowing) policy
which includes access to an independent helpline for
anonymous reporting of concerns
Group Finance has identified divisional key controls which
every division is required to adhere to
Monthly management reporting and half-yearly financial
reporting processes enable financial performance to be
regularly reviewed against budget and forecasts at both
divisional and Group levels
Cost and Value Reconciliation (CVR) processes enabling
operational performance for each site to be regularly
reviewed against budget
A three-year rolling forecast is maintained monthly and a
five-year strategic plan is prepared annually. Scenario plans
and sensitivity analyses are regularly produced and
presented to the Board
Accounts payable verifies any changes to supplier
bank accounts
Stage-approval processes are in place for invoices and
transactions and sucient evidence is required by the
Group Finance team which is subject to validation before
payments are made
Payroll is managed by an experienced team, segregated
from the HR team, with appropriate controls prior to payment
being made. A third-party payroll provider is used for
payroll processing
All major balance sheet and income statement accounts are
reconciled as part of the monthly management accounting
process and reconciling items are identified and resolved in
the month with detailed variance analysis to prior periods
and budget being performed
Land for development is only acquired after thorough
due diligence of its commercial potential and risks and
subsequent approval by the Investment Committee
Board approval is required for high value acquisitions
We use national supplier agreements and preferred supplier
lists to maintain control of the Group’s major materials and
labour spend
Work by subcontractors is appropriately tendered and
awarded with background vetting being performed
Sales discounts and incentives are approved in
line with approval limits, and amendments to sales
prices are restricted to authorised employees in the
finance department
All financial transactions are recorded and, where required,
approved utilising finance systems or automated workflows
Role-based access is in place for all financial systems and
there are appropriate security controls in place.
The risks identified with respect to financial fraud and error
are mitigated through the following key controls:
The Group’s fraud risk register was reviewed in detail during
the year to confirm that risks remain relevant and complete,
and controls remain appropriate
The Group’s stance on fraud is implemented via several
Group policies and procedures, including the Group’s
Code of Conduct, anti-bribery and corruption, anti-money
laundering, gifts and entertainment, Speaking Up, expenses,
cyber security and share dealing
Financial systems have appropriate segregation of duties
following predefined approval limits and the ability to
maintain vendors’ details is segregated from purchasing,
goods receipt.
Internal assurance activities
Board, Board Committees and management committees:
monitor performance against strategy, recommend policies,
procedures and initiatives and oversee the management of
risks and the operation of internal controls
Internal Audit: the Internal Audit Plan covers the specific
key risks of the Group and is approved by the Committee
annually. The plan is executed by an eective in-house
Internal Audit team
Functional Forums: each divisional function of the Group
meets on a regular basis to review new and emerging risks,
including new regulations. They also review and update
policies, procedures, and recommend improvements to
internal controls
Divisional key control attestation: the Managing Directors
and Finance Directors of each division are required to sign
o compliance with the established divisional key controls
every year
Safety, Health & Environment (SHE) function: drives
continual improvement in SHE performance across the
Group’s sites. It engages with the business via SHE
inspections, the provision of training, information and advice
to all employees and by reporting to the SHE Committee
with the Board considering appropriate SHE-related matters
Sustainability function: drives continual improvement
in sustainability performance across the Group and is
responsible for driving performance against targets
Fraud: where instances of fraud are suspected or alleged,
Internal Audit will investigate the circumstances and report
to the Committee and management with agreed actions to
be taken.
External assurance activities
The external audit performed by PwC. The audit opinion
sets out the scope and nature of their work
The carbon emissions data receives third-party assurance to
ISO 14064 standard
We engage external independent safety auditors to conduct
regular and unannounced site safety reviews
We utilise a Security Operations Centre (SOC) to monitor
the Group’s networks and have Cyber Essentials
Plus certification.
Internal control
framework
The Group’s internal
controls are designed to
mitigate the risk of not
achieving the Group’s
strategy and objectives.
As such, they provide
reasonable assurance
against material
misstatement or loss
Key assurance
activities
The Committee continues to believe that the Group’s risk management and internal control systems, including the control and compliance culture
within the business, provide a reasonable level of assurance that the financial statements are free from material error and misstatement. While two
of the Group’s divisions experienced control shortcomings during the year, which are being addressed, the Committee is satisfied that for all other
divisions of the Group, and at the central level, that the relevant systems and processes have been in place and have operated eectively during
the financial year.
Crest Nicholson 79 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Internal Audit
The Internal Audit function is a key element
of the Group’s corporate governance
framework. Its role is to provide independent
and objective assurance, advice and insight
on governance, risk management and
internal control to the Committee, as well
asto the Board and Executive Committee.
There is an in-house Internal Audit team
which reports directly to the Committee
Chair, and is supported by external specialist
resource where required.
The Internal Audit function reviews the
eectiveness and eciency of internal
controls in place, providing assurance that
internal controls remain fit for purpose and
to ensure they are applied consistently
throughout the Group. In addition to
reviewing the eectiveness of these areas
and reporting on aspects of the Group’s
compliance with them, the Internal Audit
function agrees actions with management
toaddress any key observations and
improve processes. Internal Audit monitors
their implementation and reports regularly
totheCommittee on progress made.
Internal Audit plan
The Group’s Internal Audit plan is approved
by the Committee, including the scope of
individual audits which are aligned to the
principal risks faced by the Group. The plan
is continually assessed against progress
and any emerging risks reflecting any
amendments to the plan where necessary.
The Committee considers the internal
control recommendations raised by the
external auditor during the external audit
andincorporates these recommendations
into the Internal Audit plan as appropriate.
An internal audit methodology is in place
which aligns with the Institute of Internal
Auditors Code of Practice and International
Professional Practice Framework (IPPF).
This provides a quality benchmark for
theperformance of internal audit work.
Internal audit reports are reviewed on a
regular basis by the Executive Committee
and management responsible for the area
assessed. Management is responsible
for ensuring actions are implemented as
agreed. Follow up and escalation processes
are in place to ensure recommendations
are implemented and fully embedded in
atimely manner.
There are also a range of functions and
roles which are also an important source
of assurance. These include Company
Secretariat, IT, Group Finance, SHE and
Quality Assurance. The Committee may
request assurance reports from these
functions or explore specific risks and
mitigations with the functional leads.
Processes carried out by these functions
aresubject to review from Internal Audit.
Internal Audit eectiveness
The Committee continually reviews Internal
Audit’s eectiveness considering the quality,
objectivity and expertise of the Internal
Audit function. To support the Committee in
evaluating the eectiveness of the Internal
Audit function, feedback is received from
key stakeholders including the Board,
Committee, ELT, divisional and functional
management. Following an evaluation of
the services provided in respect of Internal
Audit, the Committee confirms that both the
processes and management of the Internal
Audit function are appropriate and eective.
Internal Audit independence
The Committee continually reviews the
independence of the Internal Audit function.
Through reporting lines to the Chair of
the Committee, the Head of Internal Audit
can report any impairment to objectivity
or independence. The Internal Audit
function also liaises with PwC, the external
auditor, discussing relevant aspects of
their respective activities which ultimately
supports the assurance provided to the
Committee and the Board.
Ethical behaviours
The Board and Committee are committed to the
highest standards of ethical behaviour, honesty
and integrity in the Group’s business practices.
Employees and supply chain partners are
made aware of the Group’s strategy and
how their behaviours impact delivery.
Everyone working for the Group is expected
to work in line with the Group’s values.
Anti-fraud and anti-bribery
The Group has an anti-bribery and corruption
policy which all employees must follow and
is supported by mandatory online training
that employees must complete annually.
Supporting policies and processes exist to
monitor compliance and prevent bribery being
committed on the Group’s behalf. As part of
this, employees are required to comply with
the Group’s gifts and entertainment policy
which only permits employees to accept or
give proportionate and reasonable hospitality
for legitimate business purposes.
The Group has in place robust anti-money
laundering policies, processes and oversight,
supported by anti-money laundering
guidance and training to all divisions.
The Group operates and maintains several
policies and procedures which set out what
is expected of employees and supply chain
partners to protect themselves as well as the
Group’s reputation and assets. These policies
and procedures are supported by online
training which employees are required to
complete on a regular basis. Supply chain
partners are required to agree to the
Group’s Supply Chain Code of Conduct.
The Committee oversees the implementation
of these policies, reviews any incidents
arising and training progress.
FY23 Internal Audit plan
A risk-based Internal Audit plan
is developed in consultation with
the Executive Committee and key
stakeholders, assessing key risks and areas
of strategic development, any emerging
themes from previous audit work and
evaluation against external benchmarks.
The plan is subject to further review and
ultimate approval by the Committee.
The FY23 Internal Audit plan focused
on specific key and emerging risk areas
across the Group. Key examples during
the year included:
A rolling audit programme assessing
the eectiveness of monthly
divisional build cost reviews and
associated controls
An audit of the design and operating
eectiveness of controls and
improvement areas to factor in the
move to a new HR and payroll system
A focused review to assess the design
and operating eectiveness of IT
general controls covering key financial
and forecasting systems
Agile programme audits and
advisory controls to support the
ERP implementation
A review of compliance with
requirements with the New Homes
Quality Code and Part L of the
Building Regulations
A review of eectiveness of Group
and divisional arrangements over
validation of the strategic land bank,
its progression, transfer and divisional
land development monitoring
and reporting
A review focusing on the maturity and
quality of reporting and eectiveness
of controls over reporting and
disclosures of sustainability-
related risks.
Speaking Up
The Board is responsible for the Group’s
arrangements with regard to reporting
incidents and allegations and receives
updates on any matters raised at each of its
meetings. The Committee is responsible for
reviewing the adequacy and eectiveness of
the Group’s whistleblowing arrangements.
The Group’s Speaking Up policy has
been written in an accessible language
to support employees, supply chain and
subcontractors and is made available at all
sites. Employees and supply chain partners
are encouraged to report any concerns of
malpractice in an open and honest way.
The policy provides details of a free
independent helpline that can be used to
report concerns and includes confidential
support services that individuals could use if
they need assistance in making a report.
Audit and Risk Committee Report continued
Crest Nicholson 80 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Committee members
Committee overview
Directors
Remuneration Report
David Arnold
Non-Executive
Director
Louise Hardy
Non-Executive
Director
Octavia Morley
Chair
Iain Ferguson CBE
Chairman
FY23 remuneration outcomes
Annual bonus
The FY23 bonus was based 50% on
adjusted profit before tax, 20% on net
cash, and 30% on a range of non-financial
measures focusing on customer service,
voluntary employee turnover, reduction in
waste and SHE leadership.
As a result of performance during the year
which was impacted by persistently high
inflation and rising interest rates along
with build cost movements, the adjusted
profit before tax and net cash targets were
not achieved.
Good progress was made against the
ESG targets related to employee turnover.
The metric for reduction in waste was
achieved as total construction waste
decreased. However, waste intensity
increased partly due to the reduced number
of completions. The Committee decided to
override the formula and reduce the award
to zero for this measure as this was a more
appropriate outcome. The threshold for the
customer service metric was not met.
The Group’s performance resulted in an
overall formulaic payout level against the
non-financial measures. However, the
Committee agreed with management
that no annual bonus would be paid as
the financial metrics had not been met.
The Committee therefore exercised
discretion to reduce the bonus to nil.
Membership
Octavia Morley has chaired the Committee
since October 2017. Members of the
Committee are independent Non-Executive
Directors and the Chairman, who was
independent on appointment.
Lucinda Bell was a member of the
Committee until 31 December 2023.
MaggieSemple joined the Committee
on1January 2024.
Individual meeting attendance is set out
on page 65.
Attendees
Other regular attendees at meetings at
the invitation of the Committee include the
Chief Executive, Group HR Director, Group
Company Secretary and Korn Ferry.
I am pleased to introduce our Directors’
Remuneration Report for the year ended
31 October 2023.
The Directors’ Remuneration Policy (Policy)
that was set out in the 2022 Annual Report
received strong support from shareholders
at our 2023 AGM. 97.28% of shareholders
approved its adoption. A summary of the
Policy is included in this report on page 85.
The Policy contained no significant changes
to the existing remuneration framework and
it is our view that the Policy works eectively,
is aligned to the Group’s strategy and
provides a good link between reward and
performance. The Policy applied to the FY23
remuneration outcomes.
FY23 saw weaker performance in our
key financial measures due to generally
challenging economic conditions and market
uncertainty demonstrated by a lack of
mortgage availability and lower confidence
in the housing market. We continued to
progress our key strategic objectives and
took proactive steps to reduce the cost base
of the Group.
Maggie Semple OBE
Non-Executive
Director
How time was spent
A Remuneration policy and disclosure 15%
B Risk and reward 25%
C Annual remuneration discussions 30%
D Governance 30%
A
B
C
D
Crest Nicholson 81 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Directors’ Remuneration Report continued
FY24 remuneration approach
For FY24 we propose to make minimal
changes to the performance measures for
variable pay while ensuring that they are
subject to stretching performance targets
linked to the Group’s strategy and outlook.
Salary
The average salary increase applied in January
2024 was 2.6% for employees. The Committee
and Peter Truscott agreed that there would be
no increase to his salary in 2024. Bill Floydd
does not qualify for an increase in 2024 as he
recently joined the Group.
Annual bonus
The annual bonus opportunity will remain
unchanged, based on 70% financial measures
(adjusted profit before tax and net cash)
and 30% non-financial measures (customer
service and waste reduction).
LTIP
The performance measures will remain
unchanged with 50% TSR, 35% ROCE and
15% ESG measures to incentivise further
reductions in scope 1 and 2 emissions
by FY26.
The Committee has reviewed the LTIP
measures to ensure that these combined
measures continue to align with the
strategy of the Group as well as meeting
the Committee’s priority for simplicity
and transparency.
It is intended to make awards to Executive
Directors at 150% of salary as in prior years.
The Committee will review this decision in
light of the prevailing share price at the date
of grant. The Committee would consider a
potential scale-back at the time of vesting
depending on conditions at that time.
LTIP
The 2021 LTIP award measured performance
over the three financial years FY21 to FY23.
Actual performance against target is set
out below:
Target range (to be
achieved in FY23) Performance Vesting
TSR Median
to Upper
Quartile
Below
median
0.0% out
of 40.0%
ROCE 17% – 20% 6.3% 0.0% out
of 30.0%
EBIT
1
14.5% – 16.5% 6.7% 0.0% out
of 30.0%
1 EBIT Margin
The 2021 LTIP award will lapse in full.
In considering remuneration for FY23,
the Committee is satisfied the Policy
has operated as intended in relation to
performance and remuneration outcomes
for FY23.
The Committee considered overall
performance and the incentives payable
across the Group, the relativities in pay
between employees and Executive Directors,
noting the impact of roles and seniority on
pay, and the wider stakeholder experience.
Board Changes
Duncan Cooper stepped down from his role
as Group Finance Director on 13 December
2023. His leaving arrangements are in line
with the Policy and treatment for leavers
and is set out on page 94 of this report.
No discretion was used by the Committee
when agreeing these arrangements.
Bill Floydd joined as Group Finance Director
with eect from 13 November 2023.
The Committee agreed a remuneration
package in line with the Policy and this is set
out below. His fixed pay is lower than that
of Duncan Cooper had he remained in post.
His variable pay will be in line with Policy and
he will receive an award of options in 2024
under the LTIP at the same time as Peter
Truscott and on the same basis.
The total remuneration package provides:
Salary of £400,000 per annum.
Annual bonus opportunity of 125% of salary
LTIP award of 150% of salary
Pension of 6% of salary
Benefits aligned with wider workforce.
Committee engagement
We consider shareholder feedback and
employee experience and apply best
practice in our approach to remuneration.
I am available to shareholders to discuss
remuneration matters.
Remuneration structures
are set out clearly in the
Remuneration Report
Performance targets
are fully disclosed
(retrospectively, where
commercially sensitive)
Simple methodology for
annual bonus and LTIP
Clearly articulated
measures, targets
and narrative in the
Remuneration Report
Discretion can be applied
to variable pay outcomes to
ensure these are consistent
with the underlying
Group performance and
stakeholder experience
Withholding and recovery
terms apply to variable pay
Higher weighting to variable
pay with delivery of higher
variable pay at higher
performance levels
Link to strategy set out
against performance
measures in the
Remuneration Report
Committee discretion to
override outcomes
Strategic KPIs link reward
to strategy and align with
stakeholders and employees
People, ESG targets
and SHE focus on non-
financial priorities
Bonus scheme framework
and measures align to
employee schemes
Our approach
to remuneration
Alignment with culture
Risk
Proportionality
Clarity
Predictability
Simplicity
Award limits set out in Policy
and Remuneration Report
Illustration of the application
of the Policy for the following
year reported annually
Crest Nicholson 82 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Conclusion
I would like to thank our shareholders for
their ongoing support on our approach to
remuneration. During the year there were no
remuneration-related matters that required
shareholder engagement. The Committee
continues to welcome shareholder feedback
and will proactively engage in relation to
any significant changes to the application
of our Policy. We will continue to align our
remuneration approach with our strategy and
ensure that all measures will be subject to the
achievement of stretching targets.
We hope that you will be able to support the
advisory vote on the Directors’ Remuneration
Report at the 2024 AGM.
Octavia Morley
Remuneration Committee Chair
23 January 2024
The full terms of reference for the
Committee can be found at
www.crestnicholson.com/investors/
corporate-governance
Fair Pay
Employee remuneration continued to be an
area of focus for the Committee during the year.
We reviewed how pay and benefits cascade
through the Group along with the measures
used for the wider employee bonus plans and
how they operate. We were pleased to see that
there continued to be good alignment with the
Executive Directors.
We are pleased to have been formally
accredited by the Living Wage Foundation
during FY23. This is a significant step
towards our commitment to our employees,
including those who work in our supply chain,
their wellbeing and directly aligns with our
values and aspirations for fairness and social
responsibility. The real Living Wage exceeds
the Government’s National Minimum Wage, is
independently calculated based on the cost
of living, and extends to all Crest Nicholson
employees and subcontractors.
We ensure our employees’ remuneration
packages are attractive, aligned to
our strategy and to enable us to retain
our workforce.
Activity during the year
Engaged with employees on
remuneration matters
Considered FY23 bonus scheme outcomes
and final vesting of LTIP awards
Reviewed the pay of Executive Directors
and Chairman
Determined the annual bonus scheme
structure for FY24
Reviewed 2023 AGM outcomes and
feedback from shareholders
Determined leaver terms for an
Executive Director and other senior
management roles
Agreed remuneration for incoming
Company Secretary and Executive Director
Considered FY24 LTIP measures
and targets
Reviewed employee pay and benefits.
Looking ahead
Ongoing consideration of employee pay
taking into account the current cost-of-
living challenges
Monitor performance of in-flight incentive
awards during the year and consider
FY24 outcomes
Consider annual bonus and LTIP measures
and targets for FY25
Review ESG measures link to remuneration
in context of the Group’s strategy.
Alignment with strategy – FY23 performance
Links to strategy Performance Achievement against target
Annual bonus
Adjusted profit before tax (50%)
4
£41.4m
Net Cash (20%)
4
£64.9m
Customer service (15%)
4
87.00%
Reduction in voluntary employee turnover (7.5%)
1
19.39%
Reduction in waste metric (7.5%)¹
2
6.47%
SHE Leadership (-10%)
3
LTIP
TSR (40%)
2
4
Lower
ROCE (30%)
4
6.3%
EBIT Margin (30%)
4
6.7%
Key
Link to Foundations
1
People
2
Sustainability & Social Value
3
Safety, Health & Environment
4
Financial Targets
See pages 10 to 11
Link to Strategic Priorities
Placemaking & Quality
Land Portfolio
Operational Eciency
Five-Star Customer Service
Multi Channel Approach
Threshold Stretch
1 While total construction waste decreased in FY23, waste intensity increased partly due to the reduced number of completions. The Committee decided to override the formula and reduce
the award to zero for this measure as this was a more appropriate outcome.
Crest Nicholson 83 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Remuneration at a glance
Remuneration
FY23
Peter Truscott Duncan Cooper
Total pay
(single figure)
Details on
page 89
1. Fixed £769,177
2. Variable £0
3. Total pay £769,177
1. Fixed £437,833
2. Variable £0
3. Total pay £437,833
FY23 outcomes
vs performance
scenarios
Fixed remuneration
Bonus and LTIP
FY23 Performance scenarios
1
Expected minimum performance
FY23 Actual performance
Total pay (Single Figure)
Expected maximum performance
Expected on-target performance
£774,000
£769,177
£2,708,000
£1,741,000
FY23 Performance scenarios
1
£441,000
Expected minimum performance
£437,833
FY23 Actual performance
Total pay (Single Figure)
£1,526,000
Expected maximum performance
£984,000
Expected on-target performance
1 Each Directors’ Remuneration Report contains performance scenario graphs for the following year. The scenario graphs presented here are those previously
published on page 110 of the Annual Integrated Report 2022.
2023 LTIP
Details on
page 87
Awarded 150% salary
Subject to the achievement of performance conditions
Awarded 150% salary
Subject to the achievement of performance conditions
FY23 annual
bonus outcome
Details on
page 91
£0 £0
Not eligible for bonus due to leaver status
FY21 LTIP
outcome
Details on
page 91
0% of the award will vest in 2024 Award forfeited due to leaver status
Shareholding
Details on
page 92
132% 68%
48% 152%
Progress towards holding requirement Balance to achieve 200% shareholding requirement
Remuneration
for FY24
2024 LTIP
Details on
page 86
Award of 150% salary
Performance measures
TSR 50%
ROCE 35%
ESG 15%
FY24 annual
bonus
Details on
page 87
Maximum 125% salary
1
2
1 Financial 70%
Adjusted operating profit before tax 40%
Net cash 30%
2 Non-financial 30%
Customer service and quality 20%
Waste reduction 10%
SHE Leadership up to -10%
Our employees
Details on
page 96
Sharesave participation
across all plans
51%
Average salary
increase for 2024
2.6%
Crest Nicholson 84 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Element of remuneration 2024 2025 2026 2027 2028 Link to Strategy Framework
Fixed Base salary Attracts, retains and incentivises
the best people in the market to
execute the Group’s strategy.
Provides an appropriate level of
fixed remuneration without over-
reliance on variable elements.
Reviewed annually or when change in position or
responsibility. Increases usually in line with market
and general increases across the Group.
Benefits A range of competitive benefits in line with what is
available to our employees.
Pension
contribution
Payable in line with the pension contribution
available to the majority of the workforce, currently
6% of salary.
Non-
Executive
Director fees
Remunerates appropriately based
on an individual’s experience, time
commitment and responsibilities.
Non-Executive Directors’ fees are paid in cash and
are not performance related.
Additional fees may be payable in relation to extra
responsibilities or time commitments undertaken.
Variable Annual
bonus
Cash Deferral period Incentivises and rewards individuals
to execute the Group’s strategy and
achieve objectives linked to the
Strategic Priorities and Foundations.
Deferred element encourages longer-
term shareholding and links part of
annual bonus payment to the further
success of the Group and stakeholder
and shareholder interests.
The maximum bonus opportunity is capped at 150%
of salary for Executive Directors, with on-target
performance receiving 50% of maximum and up
to 25% of the maximum payable for threshold
performance. Two-thirds of the bonus is paid in
cash. One-third of the bonus is paid in shares
(post tax, national insurance and other statutory
deductions) and subject to a holding period of three
years (Deferred Shares).
Long-term
incentive
Performance period Holding period Incentivises shareholder value
creation and execution of the
strategy over the longer term.
Drives and rewards achievement
of key long-term Group objectives
aligned with the strategy and with
shareholder interests.
Contributes to building a meaningful
shareholding by aligning interests
with wider shareholders.
Awards take the form of nil-cost options or
conditional share awards. LTIP awards normally
vest on the third anniversary of grant subject to
achievement of performance measures and (other
than in good leaver situations) provided the Director
remains in oce with the Company.
Award levels will be at a maximum of 200% of salary.
Amounts equivalent to any dividends or shareholder
distributions made during the vesting period may
be awarded in respect of vested or exercisable LTIP
awards, normally in the form of shares.
A two-year post-vesting holding period will apply to
all vested LTIP awards.
Illustration of application of Policy in FY24
The remuneration package for the
Executive Directors is designed
to provide an appropriate balance
between fixed and variable
performance-related components,
with a significant proportion of the
package weighted towards long-
term variable pay.
The Committee remains satisfied
that the composition and structure
of the remuneration packages
is appropriate, clearly aligns
with financial and operational
performance as well as the Group’s
strategy, purpose, values and KPIs.
The Committee reviews this on an
annual basis.
The composition and structure
of the remuneration package
for Executive Directors in three
performance scenarios is set out in
the chart shown right.
Key and assumptions
Minimum
Fixed remuneration consisting of
current annualised salary, pension
(plan contribution or cash supplement)
and benefits.
Target
Fixed remuneration as detailed above,
plus 50% of maximum as target bonus
opportunity, and vesting of 50% of the
maximum LTIP award.
Maximum
Fixed remuneration together with the
maximum annual bonus opportunity of
125% and vesting of 100% of LTIP award
representing 150% of salary.
The graph also shows what would happen
should Crest Nicholson’s share price
increase by 50%, increasing the value of
LTIP awards.
Other than illustrating 50% share price
growth, share price movement and
dividend accrual are excluded.
Summary of the Directors’ Remuneration Policy
Below is a summary of the Policy that was approved by shareholders at the Company’s AGM on 23 March 2023. The Policy is set out in full in
the 2022 Annual Report and can be found at www.crestnicholson.com/investors/results-centre
Fixed pay Annual bonus LTIP LTIP with 50% share price growth
£2,704,000
£0k £500k £1,500k £2,500k £3,500k
Peter Truscott
Maximum
Minimum
Target
£3,231,000
£771,000
£1,737,000
100%
45% 25% 30%
29% 32% 39%
£0k £500k £1,500k £2,500k £3,500k
Bill Floydd
£1,495,000
Maximum
Minimum
Target
£1,785,000
£432,000
£963,000
100%
45% 25% 30%
29% 32% 39%
Crest Nicholson 85 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Implementation of the Policy in FY24
Executive Directors’ base salary
Executive Director salary increases are generally aligned to the average increase for the wider workforce. In FY24, the increase will be
2.6% of salary. There was no salary increase for Peter Truscott and Bill Floydd does not qualify for an increase as his salary was set for FY24
on appointment.
Executive Directors can elect whether to contribute some of the benefit directly into the Group’s defined contribution pension plan and receive
any balance (or all the benefit) as cash.
Non-Executive Directors’ fees
Non-Executive fees are reviewed on an annual basis. However, no fee increases were made for FY24.
Director Role FY24 fee (annual)
Iain Ferguson Chairman £212,180
David Arnold Non-Executive Director £63,654
Louise Hardy Non-Executive Director £59,941
Octavia Morley Senior Independent Director £72,672
Maggie Semple Non-Executive Director £54,636
1 Includes an additional fee of £9,018 for role as Chair of the Audit and Risk Committee.
2 Includes an additional fee of £5,305 for role as Non-Executive Director responsible for employee engagement.
3 Includes an additional fee of £9,018 for each role of Chair of the Remuneration Committee and Senior Independent Director.
Note: Lucinda Bell’s remuneration for the period 1 November to 31 December 2023 will be disclosed in the FY24 annual report.
Director Salary (annual) Change
Peter Truscott No increase awarded in January 2024 2024 £702,975 0%
Bill Floydd No increase awarded in January 2024 2024 £400,000 N/A
Note: Duncan Cooper’s remuneration for the period 1 November to 31 December 2023 will be disclosed in the FY24 annual report.
Pension and incentives
Director Pension or cash equivalent Annual bonus LTIP
Peter Truscott 6% of salary 125% of salary 150% of salary
Bill Floydd 6% of salary 125% of salary 150% of salary
1 6% is the rate applicable to the majority of the employee workforce.
Crest Nicholson 86 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
LTIP
Peter Truscott and Bill Floydd will be granted an LTIP award with a face value of 150% of base salary. Awards are subject to a three-year
performance period and a two-year post vesting holding period.
Following careful consideration of the structure and weightings of its LTIP for FY23, and taking account of the Group’s longer-term outlook the
Committee has retained TSR measured against the FTSE 250 and certain sector peers, ROCE and a measure of Absolute scope 1 and 2 carbon
emissions. All measures are considered to promote the long-term success of the Group:
Annual bonus
The annual bonus opportunity will remain at 125% of salary for FY24.
Targets are considered to be commercially sensitive and will be disclosed in the FY24 Directors’ Remuneration Report. The Committee will
review performance under the annual bonus in the context of wider stakeholder experience over the performance period when determining
bonus payments.
As per the Policy, one-third of any bonus earned will be paid in shares which are subject to a three-year holding period.
The Committee has reviewed and agreed the combination of measures and weighting in line with the Group’s strategy and these are set out
below. The Committee is satisfied that the annual bonus scheme framework is applied in a similar way to employees across the Group, tailored
to roles and functions.
Performance measure Measure detail Links to strategy
Weighting (% of total
bonus opportunity)
Financial
Adjusted profit before tax Performance is measured between threshold
and maximum
4
40
Net cash Performance is measured between threshold
and maximum
4
30
Non-financial
Customer service and quality Customer satisfaction survey score for FY24
measured between threshold and maximum
4
20
Environment, Social and
Governance
Reduction in waste intensity
1
2
10
SHE Leadership Assessment of SHE leadership during the year
3
A downward
adjustment of up to
10% may be applied
Performance measure % of award
Threshold
(25% of element)
Maximum
(100% of element) Links to strategy
TSR (FTSE 250 and sector peers) 50 Median Upper Quartile
2
4
ROCE FY26 35 10.5% 15%
4
ESG: Absolute scope 1 and 2
carbon emissions FY26
15 4,260 tCO
2
e 3,834 tCO
2
e
2
Key
Link to Foundations
1
People
2
Sustainability & Social Value
3
Safety, Health & Environment
4
Financial Targets
See pages 10 to 11
Link to Strategic Priorities
Placemaking & Quality
Land Portfolio
Operational Eciency
Five-Star Customer Service
Multi Channel Approach
Crest Nicholson 87 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
TSR is measured using the companies comprising the FTSE 250 index (excluding investment trusts) as at 1 November 2023 (50%) and a
selection of sector peers (50%). The FY24 peer group comprises Barratt Developments plc, Bellway plc, The Berkeley Group plc, MJ Gleeson
plc, Persimmon plc, Redrow plc, Taylor Wimpey plc and Vistry Group plc.
For both TSR elements, performance will be measured on a straight-line basis between a threshold of median TSR (earning 25% of the element)
and a maximum at upper quartile TSR (earning 100% of the element).
TSR provides a focus on the Companys relative TSR performance against the sector and the stock market generally.
ROCE will reward strong operational eciency and margin accretion and will be an adjusted measure as defined on pages 161 to 162. The ROCE
range represents a significant improvement in performance from the FY23 ROCE and has been calibrated carefully to take into account the
business plan and operating environment.
The ESG measure targets a reduction in absolute scope 1 and 2 emissions. Achievement of the maximum target would have the eect of
accelerating the path to the Group’s 2030 target by approximately three years. The reduction in absolute scope 1 and 2 emissions is also a
target under the Group’s Sustainability Linked Revolving Credit Facility (see page 20 for further information).
The Committee intends to grant awards at the normal policy level of 150% of base salary, but will consider the grant level at the time of the
award taking into account the share price level at grant. The final vesting value of any awards will be considered carefully by the Committee at
that time to ensure the value delivered to participants remains appropriate relative to the performance of the Group, shareholder experience,
and employee workforce impact over the performance period. In particular the Committee will ensure that no undue windfall gains are made as
a result of share price movements and there will be full disclosure of this determination in the Directors’ Remuneration Report.
Implementation of the Policy in FY24 continued
Crest Nicholson 88 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
The information in this Report is audited where this is indicated, and otherwise unaudited.
FY23 remuneration payable to Executive Directors (audited)
Pay for performance FY23 (audited)
Annual bonus targets and outcomes
The FY23 annual bonus scheme followed a similar format to previous years with adjusted profit before tax and cash generation (70%) as
well as non-financial measures (30%) focusing on customer service, voluntary employee turnover, reduction in waste and SHE leadership.
While appropriately stretching targets had been set based on forecasts relating to the financial and market outlook at the end of 2022, as set
out in the Financial Review on pages 32 to 34, persistently high inflation and rising interest rates along with build cost movements meant that
the adjusted profit before tax and net cash targets were not met this year.
During the period, the Group continued to make good progress reducing voluntary employee turnover but did not perform as strongly with
respect to customer service with performance below the 90% threshold. The metric for reduction in waste was achieved as total construction
waste decreased. However, waste intensity increased partly due to the reduced number of completions. The Committee decided to override
the formula and reduce the award to zero for this measure as this was a more appropriate outcome.
The Committee considered the SHE leadership shown by the Executive Directors during the year and taking into account a range of factors
including, divisional performance and leadership, and the levels and severity of accidents, the Committee considered that appropriate
leadership had been demonstrated. As such, no deduction was necessary under this annual bonus measure.
Despite the achievement of some annual bonus scheme metrics during the period, the Committee exercised discretion and agreed that the
bonus payable was nil in light of the experience of shareholders and to align outcomes with employees generally.
1 Further information about our customer service performance can be found on page 8.
FY23 Non-Executive Directors fees (audited)
Annual Report on remuneration
Salary
£000
Benefits
2
£000
Bonus
£000
LTIPs
3
£000
Retirement
benefits
£000
Total pay
£000
Total fixed
Pay £000
Total
variable
pay £000
Peter Truscott FY23 697 26 46 769 769
FY22 666 25 670 340 67 1,768 758 1,010
Duncan Cooper
5
FY23 392 23 23 438 438
FY22 374 22 376 143 22 937 418 519
1 Salary: Where salaries are adjusted for benefits which are provided via salary exchange, such salaries are quoted as the gross figure disregarding the eect of salary exchange.
2 Benefits: The figure shown includes the value of car benefit, private medical insurance, group income protection, personal accident, life assurance and an annual health check.
3 LTIPs: Last year’s LTIP figure has been restated to reflect the actual value of the award and share price at the time of vesting (being 231.694 pence per share on 8 March 2023).
4 Retirement benefits: Salary supplement of 6% (employee majority rate). No Director has a prospective interest in a defined benefit scheme.
5 Leaving arrangements: In accordance with our Policy and the scheme rules, no annual bonus is payable and LTIPs will lapse as a result of resignation.
FY23
£000
FY22
£000
Iain Ferguson 211 205
David Arnold 63 62
Lucinda Bell 54 53
Louise Hardy 60 58
Octavia Morley 72 70
Crest Nicholson 89 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Annual Report on remuneration continued
Measure
(Weighting)
Description and link
to strategy
Threshold
(20%
1
of
maximum)
On-target
(50% of
maximum)
Stretch and
maximum
(100% of
maximum)
% of maximum
bonus
achieved % of salary
Financial Adjusted profit
before tax (50%)
Adjusted profit before tax as
defined on page 1.
4
£76m £80m £100m 0 0
Net cash (20%) Cash and cash equivalents
plus noncurrent and
current interest bearing
loans and borrowings as at
31 October 2023.
4
£182.9m £192.5m £240.6m 0 0
Non-
financial
Customer service
and quality (15%)
The 12-month NHBC
‘recommend your
housebuilder’ score
for FY23.
4
90% 92% 94% 0 0
Environment, Social and Governance objectives:
Reduction
in voluntary
employee turnover
(7.5%)
Resignations or retirements
during the year as a
proportion of total
employees, compared
to the position at
31 October 2022.
1
27% 25% 23% 7.5 9.38
Reduction in waste
(7.5%)
Reduction in waste in FY23
compared to FY22. See page
23 for further information on
the Group’s action to manage
and minimise waste.
2
2
0% 3% 5% 7.5 9.38
SHE leadership
(-10%)
A downwards adjustment
of up to 10% of the bonus
achieved should SHE
leadership fall below the
standard expected by
the Group.
3
Less up to 10% adjustment
Total bonus 14.32 17.90
£41.4m
£64.9m
87.0%
6.47%
Actual
Actual
Actual
Actual
Actual
Actual
Pay for performance in FY23 continued (audited)
The maximum target for each element was set to stretch and further challenge the Executive Directors. Achievement was calculated on a
straight-line basis between threshold and target, and target and maximum/stretch with a maximum bonus potential of 125% of salary. The results
for each element of the annual bonus incentive are set out below:
Link to Strategic Priorities
Placemaking & Quality
Land Portfolio
Operational Eciency
Five-Star Customer Service
Multi Channel Approach
Link to Foundations
1
People
2
Sustainability & Social Value
3
Safety, Health & Environment
4
Financial Targets
19.39%
1 10% for financial measures. 20% for non-financial measures.
2 While total construction waste decreased in FY23, waste intensity increased partly due to the reduced number of completions. The Committee decided to override the formula and reduce
the award to zero for this measure as this was a more appropriate outcome.
Crest Nicholson 90 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
LTIP targets and outcomes (audited)
The FY21 LTIP award, granted on 8 February 2021, was based on performance over the three years ended 31 October 2023 and would have
become exercisable from 8 February 2024 (subject to the Directors still being in employment or otherwise having been a good leaver) had
the performance targets been reached. The table below sets out details of the measures, performance targets and actual performance which
resulted in 0% of the awards vesting.
Measure Weighting Threshold (25%) Maximum (100%) Actual performance % of award achieved
TSR in FY23
1
40% Median Upper Quartile
Below Median
compared to both peer
groups 0.0%
ROCE in FY23
2
30% 17% 20% 6.3% 0.0%
EBIT margin in FY23
3
30% 14.5% 16.5% 6.7% 0.0%
Total 100% 0.0%
1 Measured using the companies comprising the FTSE 250 index (excluding investment trusts) as at 1 November 2020 (one-third) and a selection of sector peers (two-thirds). The 2021 peer
group comprises Barratt Developments plc, Bellway plc, Countryside Properties plc, Vistry Group plc, Persimmon plc, Redrow plc, and Taylor Wimpey plc.
2 ROCE has been calculated using unrounded numbers. ROCE presented in the financial statements and elsewhere in the Annual Report has been calculated using numbers rounded to
£0.1m.
3 Adjusted EBIT Margin as defined on page 30.
The targets were considered stretching in light of the strategy, three-year business plan and market outlook at the time of award. High inflation,
rising interest rates, poor mortgage availability along with the withdrawal of Government support for first time buyers, resulted in a worsening
trading environment over the last year. Consequently these performance measures were not met.
Scheme interests awarded during the financial year (audited)
This table sets out the FY23 awards granted to Executive Directors under the LTIP for the performance period 1 November 2022 to
31 October 2025.
Award
1
Type Date of grant
Number of
shares
Face value
of award
2
£000 % of salary
% of award
receivable at
threshold
Peter Truscott Performance Nil-cost option 27.01.23 432,369 1,054 150 25
Duncan Cooper³ Performance Nil-cost option 27.01.23 242,792 592 150 25
1 Performance conditions in each case measured in FY25: 50% relative TSR (threshold median to maximum upper quartile), 35% average ROCE (threshold 17% to maximum 23%),
15% reduction in scope 1 and scope 2 carbon emissions (threshold 4,300 tCO
2
e to maximum 3,870 tCO
2
e)
2 Face value calculated based on 243.88 pence, the average of the closing middle market share price for the five dealing days preceding the date of grant.
3 Duncan Cooper’s outstanding awards lapsed on cessation of his employment on 13 December 2023.
This table sets out the FY23 awards granted to Executive Directors under the deferred bonus plan (DBP) in respect of the deferred element
of their FY22 annual bonus as set out on page 112 of the 2022 Annual Report. The deferred shares will vest after three years subject to
continued employment.
Award
1
Type Date of grant Number of shares
Face value
of award
2
£000
% of
bonus
payable
Peter Truscott Service Nil-cost option 27.01.23 90,664 221 33
Duncan Cooper³ Service Nil-cost option 27.01.23 50,911 124 33
1 There are no performance conditions attached to the award. The award will accrue dividend equivalents in accordance with the rules of the scheme. The amount of dividend equivalent to
be awarded as shares upon vesting will be adjusted according to the number of shares that vest, pro rata.
2 Face value calculated based on 243.88 pence, the closing middle market share price for the five preceding dealing days of the grant date.
3 Duncan Cooper’s outstanding awards lapsed on cessation of his employment on 13 December 2023.
Crest Nicholson 91 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Annual Report on remuneration continued
Directors’ shareholdings at the end of the financial year (audited)
There have been no changes to Directors’ interests between 31 October 2023 and 22 January 2024.
Shares held, including
connected persons at
31 October 2023
Outstanding share
awards
1
at
31 October 2023
with performance
conditions
Outstanding
share awards
1
at
31 October 2023
without performance
conditions
Total share
interests at
31 October 2023
Shareholding
2
as a percentage
of salary and share
price of 160 pence at
31 October 2023
Iain Ferguson 150,000 N/A N/A 150,000 N/A
Peter Truscott 491,659 1,050,497 164,261 1,706,417 132%
Duncan Cooper³ 69,522 589,894 92,239 751,655 48%
David Arnold 15,250 N/A N/A 15,250 N/A
Lucinda Bell 11,650 N/A N/A 11,650 N/A
Louise Hardy N/A N/A N/A
Octavia Morley 5,600 N/A N/A 5,600 N/A
1 Share awards take the form of nil-cost options other than Sharesave awards which are fixed price options. There are no conditional or restricted share awards. There were no vested but
unexercised share awards at 31 October 2023.
2 Shareholding includes shares held including connected persons, outstanding share awards without performance conditions (e.g. DBP) net of tax and excludes outstanding share awards
with performance conditions (e.g. LTIP).
3 Duncan Cooper’s outstanding awards lapsed on cessation of his employment on 13 December 2023.
Directors’ shareholdings and share interests
Share ownership plays a key role in aligning Executive Directors’ interests with the interests of shareholders over the long term. The Policy
requires Executive Directors to build up and maintain a significant shareholding in the Company of 200% of salary. On cessation of employment,
they are required to continue to hold the lower of their shareholding requirement or their shareholding at the date of leaving for a period of two
years. Under the Policy, shares owned outright and deferred shares (because they no longer have performance conditions attached) count
towards the shareholding requirement. Duncan Cooper will be required to retain his shareholding until 13 December 2025.
The chart below shows the Executive Directors’ current shareholdings together with unvested DBP awards and the illustrative eect if 50% of
outstanding LTIP awards vested in the future. Shares which are not owned outright are shown net of tax (i.e. excluding that proportion of those
shares expected to be sold on vesting to settle the associated tax liability).
Director
Peter Truscott
Duncan Cooper
0% 20%
111.9% 19.8% 31.7%
28.2% 19.8% 31.7% 120.3%
36.6%
40% 60% 80% 100% 120% 140% 160% 180% 200%
Shares owned outright Unvested DBP/SAYE shares Eect of 50% of LTIPs vesting Shareholding requirement
Executive Directors’ alignment to share price
The table below contains the value of shares currently held by the Executive Directors, those awarded under the DBP but not yet released (on a
post-tax basis) and Sharesave. It illustrates the Executive Directors’ alignment to share price movement through their ordinary shareholdings.
Shares
owned outright
Unvested DBP
shares (post-tax)
Total
shares
Indicative value on
31 October 2023
(£)
Consequence of a +/-
£1 share price change
(£)
Peter Truscott 491,659 87,058 578,717 925,948 578,717
Duncan Cooper 69,522 48,887 118,409 189,454 118,409
1 Value calculated using the share price of 160.0 pence as at 31 October 2023.
Crest Nicholson 92 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Executive Directors’ scheme interests at the end of the financial year (audited)
The LTIP awards have performance criteria attached to them in accordance with the Policy and as set out in the Directors’ Remuneration Report.
The DBP awards do not have any performance criteria attached to them.
Outstanding
share
options/
awards at
31 October
2022
Date
of grant Granted Exercised Lapsed
Outstanding
share
options/
awards at
31October
2023
Market
price on
award
£
Exercise
price
£
Market
price at
exercise/
vesting
£
Gain
receivable
£
Date
exercisable
or capable of
vesting Expiry date
Peter Truscott
LTIP
2020 253,016 20.02.2020 9,669
1
146,551 116,134 5.138 Nil 2.317 339,550 20.02.2023 19.02.2030
2021 297,364 08.02.2021 297,364 3.279 Nil 08.02.2024 07.02.2031
2022 320,764 28.01.2022 320,764 3.131 Nil 28.01.2025 27.01.2032
2023 27.01.2023 432,369 432,369 2.439 Nil 27.01.2026 26.01.2033
DBP
2020 240 28.02.2020 15
1
255 - 4.530 Nil 2.317 591 28.02.2023 27.02.2030
2022 73,597 28.01.2022 73,597 3.064 Nil 28.01.2025 27.01.2032
2023 27.01.2023 90,664 90,664 2.439 Nil 27.01.2026 26.01.2033
Duncan Cooper
LTIP
2020 106,558 28.02.2020 4,072
1
61,720 48,910 5.138 Nil 2.317 143,002 20.02.2023 19.02.2030
2021 166,981 08.02.2021 166,981 3.279 Nil 08.02.2024 07.02.2031
2022 180,121 28.01.2022 180,121 3.131 Nil 28.01.2025 27.01.2032
2023 27.01.2023 242,792 242,792 2.439 Nil 27.01.2026 26.01.2033
DBP
2020 320 28.02.2020 21
1
341 4.530 Nil 2.317 790 28.02.2023 27.02.2030
2022 41,328 28.01.2022 41,328 3.064 Nil 28.01.2025 27.01.2032
2023 27.01.2023 50,911 50,911 2.439 Nil 27.01.2026 26.01.2033
1 Dividend equivalents granted during the year.
2 Duncan Cooper’s outstanding awards lapsed on cessation of his employment on 13 December 2023.
Crest Nicholson 93 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Annual Report on remuneration continued
Loss of oce payments (audited)
Duncan Cooper left the Group on 13 December 2023. His remuneration arrangements were treated in line with the shareholder approved
Policy. He will not receive any compensation for loss of oce. In line with the rules of the annual bonus and executive share schemes, he is not
eligible for an annual bonus payment in respect of FY23 (including his time served in respect of FY24), and his outstanding awards under the
LTIP made in 2021, 2022 and 2023 will lapse. His DBP options in respect of the annual bonus for the financial years ended 30 October 2021
and 2022 will also lapse. His two-year post employment shareholding requirement, which requires him to hold shares equivalent to the lower of
200% of salary on cessation or his actual shareholding, commenced on 13 December 2023.
Payments to past Directors (audited)
There were no payments to past Directors made during the year.
External directorships
Subject to Board approval, Executive Directors may hold one non-executive position outside of the Group that complements and enhances
their current role. Any fees may be retained by the Director.
During the year, Peter Truscott served as a Non-Executive Director of Anchor Housing Group (appointed September 2020), for which he
receives and retains an annual fee of £35,000.
Directors’ service contracts and letters of appointment
Executive Directors have contracts of employment providing for a maximum of nine months’ notice from either party. Non-Executive Directors
have letters of appointment for an initial three-year term and generally serve two to three terms. The required notice is three months’ from
either party.
Date of appointment Notice period
Unexpired term remaining
31 October 2023
Peter Truscott 9 September 2019 Nine months Terminable on nine months’ notice
Bill Floydd 13 November 2023 Nine months Terminable on nine months’ notice
Iain Ferguson 16 September 2019 Three months Terminable on three months’ notice
David Arnold 1 September 2021 Three months Terminable on three months’ notice
Lucinda Bell 25 May 2018 Three months Terminable on three months’ notice
Louise Hardy 24 January 2018 Three months Terminable on three months’ notice
Octavia Morley 1 May 2017 Three months Terminable on three months’ notice
Maggie Semple 1 January 2024 Three months Terminable on three months’ notice
The Group has the right to terminate the contracts of Executive Directors by making a payment in lieu of notice. Any such payment will typically
reflect the individual’s salary, benefits in kind and pension entitlements. Further information is found on page 109 of the Remuneration Policy set
out in the 2022 Annual Report.
Crest Nicholson 94 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Performance graph and table
The graph below illustrates the Company’s total shareholder return performance relative to the constituents of the FTSE 250 Index (excluding
investment trusts) from 31 October 2013. As a member of the FTSE 250 (since joining the index on 24 June 2013), the Committee considers this
to be an appropriate comparator.
350
£
250
150
50
300
200
100
0
Oct ’14Oct ’13 Oct ’16Oct ’15 Oct ’18Oct ’17 Oct ’21 Oct ’22 Oct ’23Oct ’20Oct ’19
Crest Nicholson FTSE 250 (excl. investment trusts)
Historical Chief Executive remuneration
The table below sets out total Chief Executive remuneration for FY23 and prior years, together with the percentage of maximum annual bonus
outcome and the percentage of maximum LTIP vested in that year.
£000 2014 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022 2023
Chief Executive total remuneration 1,313 4,127 2,345 2,150 714
2
1,495
3
739 1,422 1,768 769
Annual bonus % of maximum 100 82 82 84 0 3.5 0 84 80 0
Long-term incentive plan award % of
maximum N/A
1
100 100 100 25 0 0 0 54 0
1 No long-term incentive plans vested or had a performance period ending in FY14.
2 Based pro rata, on salaries and total remuneration of Stephen Stone to 21 March 2018 and Patrick Bergin from 22 March 2018 to 31 October 2018.
3 Based pro rata, on salaries and total remuneration of Patrick Bergin to 26 March 2019, Chris Tinker from 26 March 2019 to 8 September 2019 and Peter Truscott from 9 September 2019.
It also includes the cost of buy-out arrangements for Peter Truscott.
Relative importance of spend on pay
The table below shows how employee remuneration costs compare to distributions made to shareholders in FY22 and FY23.
This includes data for all employees, including those who were promoted, had salary changes, were new starters or received incentive-based
remuneration, as well as pay in respect of individuals who left during the year but had some service. Distributions to shareholders for FY22 and
FY23 are made up of cash paid to shareholders in each respective year.
The increase in total spend on pay is reflective of a competitive labour market leading to increases to pay generally over the course of the year,
good financial performance in FY22 that led to annual bonuses being paid in February 2023 and the FY20 LTIP options partially meeting their
performance targets and vesting in February 2023. The level of distributions to shareholders reflects the decision to hold the dividend payment
at the same level as FY22.
The measures shown below are those specified by the applicable disclosure requirements and total spend on pay reflects actual expenditure in
the year.
Total spend on pay
2023
202 2
£56.3m
£49.0m
Change
£7.3m
15%
Distributions to shareholders by way of dividend
2023
202 2
£43.5m
£38.4m
Change
£5.1m
13%
1 Total spend on pay is calculated using cash amounts paid to employees in FY22. This is dierent to the disclosure in note 6 of the financial statements that uses accrued amounts which will
be paid in future periods.
Crest Nicholson 95 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Annual Report on remuneration continued
Our approach to Fair Pay
The Committee reviews the remuneration framework applicable to all employees annually, ensuring that the Policy framework applies in a very
similar way across the Group in terms of types of benefits and variable pay relative to role grades and disciplines. This ensures alignment across
the Group and encourages shared goals and objectives.
When making remuneration decisions for Executive Directors, the Committee considers the wider economic environment and conditions
within the Group. In particular, the Committee is sensitive to pay and employment conditions across the employee workforce and carefully
considers the broader employee salary increase budget when making reward decisions for Directors. The Committee also considers industry
benchmarking in the context of monitoring its overall position regarding Director and employee pay.
Cascade of remuneration across the Group
The table below summarises the information the Committee received as part of its annual review process and shows how remuneration
compares across the Group in a transparent and fair way.
Executive Directors
Executive Directors of the
Company.
Senior management
Executive Leadership Team
(other than Executive Directors)
and other senior roles.
Management
Management roles below
senior management.
Wider employee workforce
All other roles
Base salary Base salary is set with reference to the specific nature of the role and responsibility, individual experience and
performance, relative to other Group employees and market practice among other UK housebuilders. This
is normally reviewed and increased with reference to cost of living, inflation, role benchmarking and Group
performance. Other than where other wage rates apply such as apprentices, all employees are paid at or above
the voluntary real Living Wage.
Matters considered during the year
After consideration of Group performance and wider economic factors such as inflation and role benchmarking,
the average annual salary increase across the Group for FY24 was 2.6%. The Group’s HR team regularly reviews
base pay across the Group and compares this to market analysis and will continue to do so in FY24.
Benefits The Group’s benefit programme applies to all employees in a similar way including access to healthcare
coverage and life assurance. Certain benefits have a service requirement or have enhanced cover for
management roles and above. Employees have access to a real-time total reward statement via our MyReward
platform which also allows them to access and manage their benefits.
Matters considered during the year
The Committee considered the Group’s benefits programme, noting that it continued to be in alignment across
the Group.
Pension All employees are initially auto-enrolled into the Group pension plan with a 6% employer contribution or have the
ability to opt in. Employees can opt to increase or decrease their contribution amounts. The maximum employer
contribution is 10% depending on employee contribution level and service. The majority of employees receive an
employer contribution of 6%. More than 94% of our employees are members of the Group pension plan.
Matters considered during the year
The Committee reviewed the Group’s pension contribution framework and considered that budgetary headroom
would be more appropriately focused on base salaries
Annual bonus Yes Yes Yes Yes
Matters considered during the year
Where performance targets have been met, payments under employee schemes will be made. These are
consistent with the performance of the Executive Directors’ scheme.
Share schemes Sharesave + LTIP Sharesave + LTIP Sharesave only Sharesave only
Matters considered during the year
The performance measures for the 2020 LTIP were considered and were not met. The Committee approved
the launch of the 2023 Sharesave scheme to all employees which had 41% participation this year. The 2020
Sharesave matured in September and participants were able to exercise their options. We were pleased to see
a significant number of employees in the scheme opt to become Crest Nicholson shareholders and retain their
shares.
Employee engagement
At the Employee Voice forums Louise Hardy, Non-Executive Director responsible for employee engagement, engaged with forum members on
remuneration matters. As part of the 2023 Policy review, forum members were also shown how the reward package cascades across the Group
along with how the variable reward plans and their measures were developed. Forum members feedback was sought on how culture should be
taken into account when setting pay, whether employees understood their bonus schemes or had ideas on other measures that could be used
and whether there were any concerns about the 2023 Policy.
At the divisional updates regularly hosted by the Chief Executive, employees were also encouraged to participate by asking questions
(anonymously in advance or in person), and remuneration concerns were regularly addressed. The Committee was pleased that 41% of eligible
employees joined the 2023 Sharesave scheme and that employee participation across all share schemes remained at 51%. The Committee
considers Sharesave to be a valuable mechanism that provides employees with a path to share ownership. The Committee will continue to
review employee pay structures and levels during FY24.
Crest Nicholson 96 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Chief Executive to employees pay ratio for FY23
This year the Company has adopted Option B to calculate the ratio for FY23 and subsequent years following changes to internal systems, which
no longer collates the required data to use Option A. This is our fourth year publishing a Chief Executive pay ratio and previous years are below
for comparison. We will continue to build this up over time to show a rolling 10-year period.
Year Method 25th percentile pay ratio Median pay ratio 75th percentile pay ratio
31 October 2020 Option A Ratio 25:1 17:1 11:1
31 October 2021 Option A Ratio 46:1 32:1 21:1
31 October 2022 Option A Ratio 55:1 37:1 25:1
31 October 2023 Option B Ratio 16:1 12:1 10:1
Employees’ total pay £49,026 £66,376 £78,776
Employees’ salary £38,500 £51,667 £66,354
To calculate Option B, the latest available gender pay gap data (i.e. from April 2023) was used to identify three Group employees whose hourly
rates of pay were at the 25th, 50th and 75th percentiles of all Group employees. The total remuneration for the three employees at each
percentile was calculated as at 31 October 2023 on the same basis as the Chief Executive single total figure of remuneration (see page 89).
The remuneration of employees above and below the selected employees was also reviewed to ensure that they were the best equivalents for
each percentile.
Employee pay includes such items as overtime, commission, bonus
and any long-term incentives. Benefits include company car or car
allowance, private medical and employer pension contributions. Other than any bonus elements, all other payments are included on a cash
basis. The bonus elements are for the bonus earned during FY23.
The Executive Directors’ Policy is designed taking into account the remuneration arrangements, policies and practices throughout the Group
and when reviewing the implementation of the Policy, the Committee ensures outcomes throughout the Group are fair and appropriate.
The Committee considers the median pay ratio is consistent with the Group’s wider policies on employee pay, reward and progression.
The ratio has decreased this year because the Chief Executive did not receive any incentive payments for FY23, as explained earlier in this
report. In FY22 the bonus payout was 80% of maximum and LTIP vesting was 54% of maximum.
Percentage change in Directors’ remuneration
The table below sets out the percentage change between FY19 and FY20, FY20 and FY21, FY21 and FY22, and FY22 and FY23 for salary,
benefits and annual bonus of Directors compared with a selected cohort of employees. The parent company, Crest Nicholson Holdings plc,
does not have any direct employees. However, we disclose on a voluntary basis the comparison of the pay decisions taken by the Committee
for Directors against the experience of the wider workforce using a comparator group of employees.
To provide the best like-for-like comparison, this group of employees have similar employment terms to the Executive Directors and have not
joined or left employment during the latest comparison period. The average increase in salary of 7.11% for the cohort of employees during FY23
is due to role changes, promotions and market rate adjustments during the year. The average increases for benefits and bonus are aected by
these salary and role changes.
% change in basic salary/fees % change in benefits % change in bonus
7
2022 to
2023
2021 to
2022
2020 to
2021
2019 to
2020
2022 to
2023
2021 to
2022
2020 to
2021
2019 to
2020
2022 to
2023
2021 to
2022
2020 to
2021
2019 to
2020
Peter Truscott 4.7% 2.5% 0.0% 35.2% 3.6% 1.7% -0.3% -6.1% -100.0% -1.9% 100.0% -100.0%
Duncan Cooper 4.7% 2.5% 1.4% 7.6% 1.2% 0.4% 4.6% 18.4% -100.0% -1.9% 100.0% -100.0%
Iain Ferguson 3.0% 2.5% 0.0% -26.4%
David Arnold 3.0% 2.5% 0.0%
Octavia Morley 3.0% 2.5% 5.5% 8.3%
Lucinda Bell 3.0% 2.5% 0.0% 0.0%
Louise Hardy 3.0% 2.5% 9.7% 0.0%
Average cohort
Employees 7.1% 9.4% 7.1% 2.8% 5.2% 16.5% 11.2% 13.8% -79.3% 4.7% 244.0% -35.0%
1 The figures used for FY19 are the blended salaries for Patrick Bergin, Chris Tinker (who acted as Interim Chief Executive) and Peter Truscott, in respect of their time serving as Chief
Executive. They do not include buy out awards in respect of Peter Truscott.
2 For FY19 we have used annualised amounts in respect of Duncan Cooper.
3 The figure used for FY19 is the salary for Stephen Stone who was Chairman during this period.
4 The figure used for FY20 is the fee for Sharon Flood who served in the same role during this period.
5 The FY21 increase for Octavia Morley reflected her extra responsibilities as Senior Independent Director.
6 The FY21 increase for Louise Hardy reflected her extra responsibilities as Non-Executive Director responsible for employee engagement.
7 An element of employee bonus schemes is based on customer satisfaction scores on 31 January each year which falls after publication of this report. These figures for the cohort group are
calculated using the customer satisfaction score on 31 December in the respective year.
Crest Nicholson 97 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
Annual Report on remuneration continued
Gender pay gap reporting
During 2022 we saw a decrease in our mean hourly pay gap to 20% (2021: 27%) and our
median hourly pay gap to 13% (2021: 22%). We remain a majority male workforce with men
generally still holding the more senior roles, however, we have seen the number of women
in the upper quartile increase to 25% in 2022 (2021: 20%).
Women account for 39% of our workforce (compared to 37% in 2021) and we are working
hard to increase diversity and gender balance within all roles and at all levels. We have a long
way to go before we achieve a 50:50 male female ratio and believe our fair pay objectives
supported by our policies processes and initiatives will help us get there. More details can
be found on pages 28 to 29. The Committee continues to take into account its gender pay
gap when making pay decisions and works in conjunction with the Nomination Committee to
improve the diversity of employees.
Our Fair Pay Objectives
1
Become an employer of choice for all
in construction and housebuilding
2
Foster a culture of work-life balance
that respects responsibilities outside
of work
3
Remove any barriers to career
progression for all employees
4
Continue to ensure salaries and
bonuses are inclusive regardless
of role.
Advisors to the Committee
The Chief Executive and Group HR Director provide input to the Committee on matters concerning remuneration and the Group Company
Secretary acts as Secretary to the Committee.
The Committee received external remuneration advice in the year from Korn Ferry (total fees £58,668). Korn Ferry was appointed by the
Committee following a competitive selection process in 2018. Korn Ferry is a founder member of the Remuneration Consultants’ Group, which
operates a code of conduct. Fees paid to external remuneration advisors are typically charged on an hourly basis with costs for work agreed in
advance where possible. During the year, Korn Ferry provided professional search services to a separate part of the Company. These services
were carried out by a division separate to the remuneration advisory team.
The Committee manages conflicts of interest by ensuring the relevant member of management or the Committee are not present when
their own remuneration is determined or discussed. Taking into account their work in the year and their relationship with the Company, the
Committee is satisfied that the advice received by Korn Ferry in relation to executive remuneration matters was objective and independent.
Statement of voting at Annual General Meeting
The tables below set out the votes received for the FY22 Directors’ Remuneration Report and Remuneration Policy at the 2023 AGM.
Directors’ Remuneration Report Directors’ Remuneration Policy
Shares voted in favour 179,320,991 94.44% Shares voted in favour 185,680,904 97.28%
Shares voted against 10,567,076 5.56% Shares voted against 5,199,216 2.72%
The Committee welcomes feedback and encourages shareholders to contact the Remuneration Committee Chair via the Group Company
Secretary to provide their views and feedback.
Approval
This Directors’ Remuneration Report was approved by the Board of Directors on 23 January 2024 and signed on its behalf by
Octavia Morley
Remuneration Committee Chair
Crest Nicholson 98 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Directors’ Report
The Directors present their report for the year
ended 31 October 2023.
The Strategic Report set out on pages 1
to 52 of this Annual Report and financial
statements, together with the Corporate
Governance Report, the reports of the Board
Committees and the Directors’ Remuneration
Report set out on pages 53 to 100 of this
Annual Report and financial statements,
include information that would otherwise
need to be included in this Directors’ Report.
Readers are also referred to the cautionary
statement on the inside front cover of this
Annual Report and financial statements.
Disclosures by Reference
Additional information, which is incorporated
into this Directors’ Report by reference,
including information required by the
Companies Act 2006, Disclosure and
Transparency Rule 7.2, and Listing Rule
9.8.4R, can be located by page reference
elsewhere in this Annual Report and financial
statements as follows:
Content Page(s)
Audit and Risk Committee 74 – 80
Board of Directors 56 – 57
Business model 14 – 15
Directors’ interests 92 – 93
Directors’ responsibilities
statement
102
Dividend 34
Employee engagement 16 – 17, 29,
63
Employee share schemes 140 – 142
Employment of persons with
a disability
63
Financial assets and
liabilities
150
Key performance indicators 30 – 31
GHG emissions 50
Going Concern 115 – 116
Group profit 111
Outlook 5, 8
Principal risks 35 – 42
Stakeholder relation
including Section 172
Statement
16 – 19
Viability statement 52
Articles of Association
The Articles of Association regulate the
internal aairs of the Company and are
available on the Company’s website.
Amendments to the Articles of Association
may be made in accordance with the
provisions of Companies Act 2006 by special
resolution of shareholders.
Powers of Directors
Directors’ powers are conferred on them by
UK legislation and by the Articles.
Election and re-election of Directors
Any Director appointed to the Board during
the year shall hold oce until the next AGM
and shall then be eligible for election.
In accordance with the UK Corporate
Governance Code, the Board proposes the
election of Bill Floydd and Dr Maggie Semple
OBE to the Board at the upcoming AGM in
2024. All other serving Directors will retire
and oer themselves for re-election at the
2024 AGM.
Directors’ and ocers’ liability
insurance
The Company maintains Directors’ and
ocers’ liability insurance for the Directors.
The Company has granted indemnities to the
extent permitted by law to the Directors and
to the Directors of Crest Nicholson Pension
Trustee Limited, which acts as trustee to the
Group’s defined benefit pension scheme.
Share capital
As at 31 October 2023 there are 256,920,539
ordinary shares of 5 pence in issue. No ordinary
shares were issued during the financial year.
Rights and restrictions attached to
shares and restrictions on transfers
Subject to the provisions of relevant statutes,
and without prejudice to any rights attached
to any existing shares or class of shares:
Any share may be issued with such rights
or restrictions as the Company may by
ordinary resolution determine or, subject to
and in default of such determination, as the
Board shall determine
In any general meeting, on a show of
hands, every member who is present in
person shall have one vote, and on a poll
every member present in person or by
proxy shall have one vote for every share
of which they are the holder
There are no specific restrictions on
transfer of shares, other than where these
are imposed by law or regulations.
The Company is not aware of any
arrangements between shareholders that
may result in restrictions on the transfer of
securities or voting rights.
Power to issue or buy back own
shares
At the AGM in March 2023 the Company’s
shareholders delegated to the Directors
the following powers in relation to the issue
or market purchase by the Company of
its shares:
Authority to allot shares in the Company
up to an aggregate nominal amount of
£4,282,008 (equivalent to one-third of the
Company’s issued share capital)
Authority to allot a further one-third of
the Group’s issued share capital up to an
aggregate nominal amount of £4,282,008
(equivalent to one-third of the Company’s
issued share capital) in connection with a
pre-emptive oer by way of a rights issue
Authority to disapply pre-emption rights
up to an aggregate nominal amount of
£1,284,602 (equivalent to 10% of the
Company’s issued share capital) with the
authority for a further disapplication of
pre-emption rights up to an aggregate
nominal amount of £256,920 (equivalent to
2% of the Company’s issued share capital)
to be used only for the purposes of a follow
on oer as described in the Pre-Emption
Group’s Statement of Principles 2022 on
Disapplying Pre-Emption Rights (Statement
of Principles 2022)
Authority to disapply pre-emption rights
up to an aggregate nominal amount of
£1,284,602 (equivalent to 10% of the
Company’s issued share capital) for
transactions which the Board determines
to be an acquisition or other capital
investment as defined in the Statement
of Principles 2022, with the authority for
a further disapplication of pre-emption
rights up to an aggregate nominal amount
of £256,920 (equivalent to 2% of the
Company’s issued share capital) to be
used only for the purposes of a follow
on oer as described in the Statement of
Principles 2022
Authority to make market purchases of its
own shares up to a maximum aggregate
number of 25,692,053 (equivalent to 10%
of the Company’s issued shares).
These standard authorities will expire on
30 April 2024 or at the conclusion of the next
AGM, whichever is earlier.
AGM
The AGM will be held on 19 March 2024.
Details and arrangements for the meeting
together with the resolutions to be proposed
will be set out in the Notice of Annual General
Meeting which accompanies the Annual
Report and financial statements and is
available on our website.
Crest Nicholson 99 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Governance
and Directors’ Report
For details on the resolutions and explanatory
notes, please refer to the Notice of AGM
which will be posted to shareholders and
made available at www.crestnicholson.com/
investors/shareholder-centre
Employee Share Ownership Trust
As at 31 October 2023 the Group’s Employee
Share Ownership Trust (ESOT) held 600,256
ordinary shares for the purposes of satisfying
awards under the Company’s share and
incentive plans. The ESOT has waived rights
to a dividend now and in the future.
Policies and procedures
Policies and procedures, including operating
and financial controls, are detailed in
the Group’s policies and procedures
manuals. There are approval processes in
relation to the acquisition of land and the
commencement of development projects.
All land acquisitions go through a rigorous
approval and assessment process at
Group level.
Substantial shareholdings
Set out below are the percentage interests in ordinary share capital of the Company, disclosable under the Disclosure Guidance and
Transparency Rules, that were notified to the Company as at 31 October 2023 and 22 January 2024.
Shareholder
31 October 2023
% of voting rights held
22 January 2024
% of voting rights held
Shanlis Investment Unlimited 0.00 6.03
Lorsden (Jersey) Limited 6.03 0.00
BlackRock, Inc 5.32 5.32
Boldhaven Management LLP 5.03 5.03
Janus Henderson Group plc 5.01 5.01
Liontrust Asset Management plc 4.94 4.94
Norges Bank 3.92 3.92
Disclosure of information to the auditor
The Directors who held oce at the date of approval of the Directors’ Report confirm that, so far as they are each aware, there is no relevant
audit information of which the Group’s auditor is unaware. Each Director has taken all the steps they ought to have taken as a Director to make
themselves aware of any relevant audit information and to establish that the Group’s auditor is aware of that information.
Appointment of auditor
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (PwC) was re-appointed at the 2023 AGM and is willing to seek re-appointment this year.
Resolutions to re-appoint PwC will be proposed at the 2024 AGM.
Approval
The Directors’ Report was approved by the Board of Directors on 23 January 2024 and signed on its behalf.
Penny Thomas
Company Secretary
Significant contracts
The Group does not have any contracts that
are considered alone to be essential to the
business of the Group. The Group does,
on occasion, make significant purchases
of goods and services from a sole supplier
where this is deemed necessary for
eciency, practicality or value. However, it
does so only after a tender or appropriate
selection process and in the context of the
level of risk such sole supply might bring.
Financial risk management
Note 24 to the consolidated financial
statements set out the Group’s approach to
financial risk management including financial
credit and liquidity risk.
Political donations
The Group made no political donations
during the year (FY22: nil).
Events after the balance sheet date
There were no significant events after
the balance sheet date.
Branches
The Group has no branches outside the
United Kingdom.
Change of control
The Group has in place several agreements
with its lending banks, private placement note
holders, joint venture partners, Government
authorities (such as Homes England), private
investors and customers, which contain
certain termination rights that would have
an eect in the event of a change of control.
The Directors believe these agreements to
be commercially sensitive and consider that
their disclosure would be seriously prejudicial
to the Group.
The Group’s share schemes contain
provisions that, in the event of a change of
control, would result in outstanding options
and awards becoming exercisable.
There are no agreements between the
Group and its Directors or employees
providing for compensation for loss of oce
or employment that occurs because of a
takeover bid.
Directors’ Report continued
Crest Nicholson 100 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
In this section
102 Statement of Directors’ responsibilities
103 Independent auditors’ report
111 Consolidated income statement
111 Consolidated statement of comprehensive income
112 Consolidated statement of changes in equity
113 Consolidated statement of financial position
114 Consolidated cash flow statement
115 Notes to the consolidated financial statements
156 Company statement of financial position
157 Company statement of changes in equity
158 Notes to the company financial statements
161 Alternative performance measures (unaudited)
163 Historical summary (unaudited)
164 Shareholder services and Glossary
FY23 financial
statements
Financial statements
Crest Nicholson 101 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Statement of Directors’ responsibilities
in respect of the financial statements
The Directors are responsible for preparing
the Annual Report and the financial
statements in accordance with applicable law
and regulation.
Company law requires the Directors to
prepare financial statements for each
financial year. Under that law the Directors
have prepared the Group financial
statements in accordance with UK-adopted
international accounting standards and the
Company financial statements in accordance
with United Kingdom Generally Accepted
Accounting Practice (United Kingdom
Accounting Standards, comprising FRS
101 ‘Reduced Disclosure Framework’, and
applicable law).
Under company law, Directors must not
approve the financial statements unless
they are satisfied that they give a true and
fair view of the state of aairs of the Group
and Company and of the profit or loss of
the Group for that period. In preparing
the financial statements, the Directors are
required to:
Select suitable accounting policies and
then apply them consistently
State whether applicable UK-adopted
international accounting standards have
been followed for the Group financial
statements and United Kingdom
Accounting Standards, comprising
FRS 101, have been followed for the
Company financial statements, subject
to any material departures disclosed and
explained in the financial statements
Make judgements and accounting
estimates that are reasonable and prudent,
and
Prepare the financial statements on
the going concern basis unless it is
inappropriate to presume that the Group
and Company will continue in business.
The Directors are responsible for
safeguarding the assets of the Group and
Company and hence for taking reasonable
steps for the prevention and detection of
fraud and other irregularities.
The Directors are also responsible for
keeping adequate accounting records that
are sucient to show and explain the Group’s
and Company’s transactions and disclose
with reasonable accuracy at any time the
financial position of the Group and Company
and enable them to ensure that the financial
statements and the Directors’ Remuneration
Report comply with the Companies Act 2006.
The Directors are responsible for the
maintenance and integrity of the Company’s
website. Legislation in the United Kingdom
governing the preparation and dissemination
of financial statements may dier from
legislation in other jurisdictions.
Directors’ confirmations
The Directors consider that the Annual
Report and financial statements, taken as a
whole, is fair, balanced and understandable
and provides the information necessary
for shareholders to assess the Group’s
and Company’s position and performance,
business model and strategy.
Each of the Directors, whose names and
functions are listed on pages 56 to 57 confirm
that, to the best of their knowledge:
The Group financial statements, which
have been prepared in accordance with
UK-adopted international accounting
standards, give a true and fair view of the
assets, liabilities, financial position and
profit of the Group
The Company financial statements, which
have been prepared in accordance with
United Kingdom Accounting Standards,
comprising FRS 101, give a true and fair
view of the assets, liabilities and financial
position of the Company, and
The Strategic Report includes a fair review
of the development and performance of
the business and the position of the Group
and Company, together with a description
of the principal risks and uncertainties that
it faces.
In the case of each Director in oce at the
date the Directors’ Report is approved:
So far as the Director is aware, there is
no relevant audit information of which
the Group’s and Company’s auditors are
unaware, and
They have taken all the steps that they
ought to have taken as a Director in order
to make themselves aware of any relevant
audit information and to establish that the
Group’s and Company’s auditors are aware
of that information.
On behalf of the Board
Peter Truscott
Chief Executive
23 January 2024
Crest Nicholson 102 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Report on the audit of the
financial statements
Opinion
In our opinion:
Crest Nicholson Holdings plc’s Group
financial statements and Company financial
statements (the “financial statements”)
give a true and fair view of the state of the
Group’s and of the Company’s aairs as at
31 October 2023 and of the Group’s profit
and the Group’s cash flows for the year
then ended;
the Group financial statements have been
properly prepared in accordance with
UK-adopted international accounting
standards as applied in accordance with
the provisions of the Companies Act 2006;
the Company financial statements have
been properly prepared in accordance
with United Kingdom Generally Accepted
Accounting Practice (United Kingdom
Accounting Standards, including FRS 101
“Reduced Disclosure Framework”, and
applicable law); and
the financial statements have been
prepared in accordance with the
requirements of the Companies Act 2006.
We have audited the financial statements,
included within the Annual report and
financial statements 2023 (the “Annual
Report”), which comprise: the Consolidated
and Company statements of financial position
as at 31 October 2023; the Consolidated
income statement, the Consolidated
statement of comprehensive income, the
Consolidated cash flow statement and the
Consolidated and Company statements of
changes in equity for the year then ended;
and the notes to the financial statements,
which include a description of the significant
accounting policies.
Our opinion is consistent with our reporting
to the Audit and Risk Committee.
Basis for opinion
We conducted our audit in accordance
with International Standards on Auditing
(UK) (“ISAs (UK)”) and applicable law.
Our responsibilities under ISAs (UK)
are further described in the Auditors’
responsibilities for the audit of the financial
statements section of our report. We believe
that the audit evidence we have obtained is
sucient and appropriate to provide a basis
for our opinion.
Independence
We remained independent of the Group in
accordance with the ethical requirements
that are relevant to our audit of the financial
statements in the UK, which includes the
FRC’s Ethical Standard, as applicable to
listed public interest entities, and we have
fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities in
accordance with these requirements.
To the best of our knowledge and belief, we
declare that non-audit services prohibited
by the FRC’s Ethical Standard were
not provided.
Other than those disclosed in note 5 of
the consolidated financial statements, we
have provided no non-audit services to the
Company or its controlled undertakings in the
period under audit.
Independent auditors’ report
to the members of Crest Nicholson Holdings plc
Our audit approach
Context
Crest Nicholson Holdings plc is a residential housebuilder listed on the London Stock Exchange. The Group is wholly UK based. The Group is
susceptible to external macro-economic factors such as government regulation, mortgage availability and changes in the wider housing sector
such as customer demand, supply chain availability and build cost inflation. This is particularly relevant for our work in the areas of margin
forecasting and recognition and valuation of inventory. During the year ended 31 October 2023, the Group’s revenues and profits have decreased
from the prior year, reflecting a lower level of home completions and reduction in profit margins. The Group has recorded an additional net
exceptional charge in relation to the combustible materials provision and a legal provision. Our audit procedures, as set out below in the related
key audit matters, focused on the appropriateness of the significant accounting estimates made by management.
The scope of our audit
As part of designing our audit, we determined materiality and assessed the risks of material misstatement in the financial statements.
Overview
Audit scope
We conducted an audit of the complete financial information of each of the five revenue-generating housebuilding divisions, which form
the majority of the Group. Specific balances and financial statement line items were audited within additional reporting units based on
their size. Revenue, the carrying value of inventory, pensions and the combustible materials provision, amongst other items, were tested
at the Group level.
Key audit matters
Valuation of inventory at the lower of cost and net realisable value (“NRV”) (Group)
Margin forecasting and recognition (Group)
Accounting for the combustible materials provision (Group)
Valuation of intercompany receivables (Company)
Materiality
Overall Group materiality: £4,800,000 (2022: £6,400,000) based on approximately 5% of a 3-year average of the Group’s profit before
tax and exceptional items (2022: based on 5% of the current year profit before tax and exceptional items).
Overall Company materiality: £1,800,000 (2022: £2,200,000) based on approximately 1% of total assets.
Performance materiality: £3,600,000 (2022: £4,800,000) (Group) and £1,350,000 (2022: £1,650,000) (Company).
Crest Nicholson 103 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Independent auditors’ report continued
Key audit matters
Key audit matters are those matters that, in the auditors’ professional judgement, were of most significance in the audit of the financial
statements of the current period and include the most significant assessed risks of material misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) identified
by the auditors, including those which had the greatest eect on: the overall audit strategy; the allocation of resources in the audit; and directing
the eorts of the engagement team. These matters, and any comments we make on the results of our procedures thereon, were addressed in
the context of our audit of the financial statements as a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon, and we do not provide a separate opinion on
these matters.
This is not a complete list of all risks identified by our audit.
The key audit matters below are consistent with last year.
Key audit matter How our audit addressed the key audit matter
Valuation of inventory at the lower of cost and net realisable value
(“NRV”) (Group)
Refer to Note 1 (Accounting policies) and Note 18 (Inventories) of the
Consolidated financial statements, and the Key financial and internal
control matters section of the Governance Report.
Inventory is the most significant balance in the consolidated
statement of financial position and is held at the lower of cost
and net realisable value (“NRV). While the cost of inventory is
relatively straightforward to determine, the NRV of a development
isjudgemental, based on forecasts of costs and sales prices.
Due to the size of the balances and the judgemental nature of the
forecasts we determined that the valuation of this financial statement
line item was assessed as a significant risk for the audit and therefore
an area of focus for our work.
Our audit procedures included:
Confirming and updating our understanding of management’s
process for preparing a margin forecast for each development,
consistent with the risk associated with the margin forecasting and
recognition process (see key audit matter below);
Evaluating and testing management’s controls over the approval
of the initial forecasts and the monitoring of updates required
to the forecasts over the course of the development’s life,
including attendance at build cost control meetings at all divisions.
Where controls could not be relied upon, which was the case in two
of the divisions (see further detail in the Key financial and internal
control matters section of the Governance Report), a high level
of substantive evidence was sought from the procedures set out
immediately below;
Testing the appropriateness and accuracy of the inputs into the
development forecasts, for example by comparing sales prices and
costs to market research, quotes or purchase orders. As part of our
audit procedures, we also had discussions with site surveyors and
other individuals outside the finance function;
Understanding the composition of the inventory balance,
specifically the level of completed but unreserved units, to confirm
if completed units are held at the appropriate value. Assessing the
level of post year end reservations and comparing forecast sales
prices to actual sales prices achieved or to external market data to
determine that this audit evidence supports the valuations at the
period end;
Evaluating future margins to be recognised on sites with low
margins or high levels of completed and unreserved units at the
year end date;
Evaluating the carrying value of part exchange stock by verifying
sales values to post-year end reservations;
Assessing the accuracy of the NRV charge recognised in the
period by testing managements latest estimates of costs and sales
prices, including movements post year end, and confirming the
appropriateness of the NRV utilised during the year; and
Testing management’s NRV models to confirm the mathematical
accuracy of the workings.
Crest Nicholson 104 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Key audit matter How our audit addressed the key audit matter
Margin forecasting and recognition (Group)
Refer to Note 1 (Accounting policies) of the Consolidated financial
statements and the Key financial and internal control matters section
of the Governance Report.
The Group’s margins are recognised on a plot by plot basis by
reference to the margin forecast across the related development
site. The margin per site reflects the best estimates of sales prices
and costs at that time. There is a risk that the margin forecast for the
site, and consequently the margin recognised on each unit sale, is
incorrect and not reflective of management’s current best estimate
of the future final margin that will be recognised on a development.
As a result, profit margins could be manipulated or subject to
error through the high level of management estimation involved
in ensuring the accuracy and completeness of an individual site
forecast, and the monitoring of these estimates over time.
Sales prices and build costs are inherently more uncertain as
they are influenced by changes in external market factors, such
as government regulations, the availability and aordability
of mortgages, changes in customer demand due to market
uncertainty or build cost inflation. There is higher uncertainty when a
development is scheduled to be completed over a long timeframe.
Management has implemented internal forecasting controls to
assess land acquisition prior to build commencement and assist with
the initial financial appraisal process. Further controls to monitor the
ongoing costs and sales prices within these forecasts occur on a
regular basis throughout the year.
In view of the high inherent estimation uncertainty and the potential
for manipulation of margin forecasts, we consider the accuracy and
completeness of forecasting and margin recognition across the life
of the site to be a significant financial reporting risk for the Group.
Our audit procedures included:
Testing management’s controls over the approval of the
initial forecasts;
Testing management’s forecasting and monitoring controls
for the developments (including attendance at a selection of
management’s internal control meetings) and evaluating samples
ofthe data used in these meetings, including for monitoring
changes to forecasts, to confirm the accuracy of this information.
Where this control could not be relied upon, which was the case
in two of the Divisions (see further detail in the Key financial and
internal control matters section of the Governance Report), a
high level of substantive testing was performed from the relevant
procedures set out below;
For a sample of sites where we noted variances in forecast
margins compared to the prior year and the current year budget,
substantively testing a sample of the inputs (eg. latest quotes/
tenders) to confirm these were supportable and complete;
Confirming, through sampling of additions to inventory, that costs
were being allocated to appropriate developments and therefore
impacting the correct site margin;
Assessing management’s overall historical accuracy of the
forecasts by analysing the changes to margins in the year and
adjustments made to margins through cost of sales. We also
assessed how margins had moved across divisions to consider
whether there were any systemic trends that could indicate
manipulation of forecasts;
Evaluating, by recalculating a sample of margins and by a test of
controls, that the system correctly calculates the margin following
cost or sales price amendments made by management; and
Testing any material manual adjustments to margins to ensure
these were appropriate by agreeing these costs/income to third
party support.
Crest Nicholson 105 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Independent auditors’ report continued
Key audit matter How our audit addressed the key audit matter
Accounting for the combustible materials provision (Group)
Refer to Note 1 (Accounting policies), Note 4 (Exceptional items),
Note 22 (Provisions) of the Consolidated financial statements
and the Key financial and internal control matters section of the
Governance Report.
Since FY19 the Group has held a provision in relation to combustible
materials to comply with the Fire Safety Order where it was
established that one of the Group’s buildings had been non-
compliant at the time of build.
As a consequence of signing the Building Safety Pledge in April
2022, the Group’s obligation to remediate buildings widened to
cover for ‘Life Critical’ safety issues in buildings 11 metres and over
that have been built over the last 30 years.
In March 2023, the Group signed the Developer Remediation
Contract (the “Contract”) which formalised the commitments made
in the signing of the Building Safety Pledge in the prior year. During
the year management has increased the provision, which primarily
reflects changes to cost estimates and scope of works, oset by the
increased impact of discounting. The provision is material, inherently
judgemental and an area of significant estimation uncertainty.
The provision is identified as a critical accounting estimate as
it requires a number of judgements over key assumptions in its
calculation, including the number of properties impacted, the scope
of work required, the estimated cost and the timing of expenditure.
Given the related estimation uncertainty, we identified the valuation
and completeness of the combustible materials provision as a
significant risk for the audit.
Our audit procedures included:
Inquiring with senior management to understand the impact
of signing the Government’s Developer Remediation Contract
and to understand the movement in the provision in the year.
Evaluating that the approach taken aligns with accounting
standards as well as the impact of signing the Contract;
Reading and understanding the requirements of the Developer
Remediation Contract, and management’s assessment of the
impact of the contract, to confirm management’s assumptions and
interpretations are reasonable and determine scope of remediation;
Recalculating and checking the integrity of management’s manual
model to confirm its accuracy;
Testing the valuation of the provision recognised at the year end.
For sites where the Building Safety Fund (BSF) made full or partial
awards to the BSF applicants and the Group is not performing,
but is paying for, the remediation work we agreed the amounts
provided to correspondence from the BSF to the Group. For the
remaining sites, where the scope of work was already assessed
by the Group, our testing focussed on agreeing the scope of
works to external fire assessment reports and costs to, third party
tenders. On sites where the scope of work is yet to be determined,
we tested management’s assumptions in relation to scope and
estimate of the work through agreeing the scope to draft fire
assessment reports and comparing the costs to other similar sites.
In the absence of this information, we have agreed the amounts
provided to the initial BSF awards as that is the best available
evidence for the estimated cost of remediation on those sites;
Assessing the completeness of the provision through procedures,
including internet searches on unnotified buildings, trend
analytics on sites by location and comparison of similar buildings
and performing external searches for identified management
companies who have notified the Group which has resulted in the
recognition of a provision to identify other buildings in the public
domain and to assess exposure;
Assessing the technical capabilities and expertise of the Group’s
employees and consultants involved in assessing the provision;
Making enquiries of the Group’s General Counsel in relation to
any claims that have come through in relation to fire safety and
reviewing the latest report on claims and assessing the impact of
any fire safety related claims on the provision;
Reviewing board minutes to check for any fire safety related claims
that are not already factored into the provision;
Assessing the disclosures made in the financial statements and
considering these both in the context of IAS 37 and expected
disclosures around contingent liabilities; and
Validating the long-term and short-term split of the provision
based on management’s plans for remediation as well as expected
payments to the BSF. This is based on managements best estimate
of when the cash is likely to outflow.
Crest Nicholson 106 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
How we tailored the audit scope
We tailored the scope of our audit to ensure that we performed enough work to be able to give an opinion on the financial statements as a
whole, taking into account the structure of the Group and the Company, the accounting processes and controls, and the industry in which
they operate.
The Group’s financial statements are ultimately a consolidation of 20 reporting units (each of which are deemed to be financial reporting
components) representing the Group’s five geographically-based housebuilding divisions, other smaller trading subsidiaries and the centralised
functions. The reporting units vary in size, but the bulk of the Group’s operations is represented by the five revenue-generating housebuilding
divisions. Consequently, we determined each of these five divisions required an audit of its complete financial information due to its size.
These five reporting units were all audited by the Group engagement team. The reporting units where we performed an audit of the complete
financial information, in addition to the audit of consolidation journals and the audit of specific financial statement line items for other reporting
units, accounted for 100% of the Group’s revenues and 95% of the Group’s profit before tax and exceptional items. We audited exceptional
items, including the combustible materials and legal provisions, at the Group level. The audit of specific financial statement line items included
a further three reporting units, to provide additional coverage over items such as inventory, administrative costs and accruals. Our audit work
across these reporting units, together with the additional procedures performed at the Group level on revenue, the carrying value of inventory,
the consolidation, goodwill, taxation, retirement benefit obligations, payroll expense, finance expense and loans and borrowings gave us the
evidence we needed for our opinion on the Consolidated financial statements as a whole. The audit of the Company financial statements
consisted of the full scope audit of one reporting unit which operates as the holding Company function.
The impact of climate risk on our audit
As part of our audit we made enquiries of management to understand the extent of the potential impact of climate risk on the Group’s and
Company’s financial statements. The risks are primarily transitional and relate to additional regulatory and/or reporting requirements, which may
result in further cost to the Group. These costs, for example by applying the Future Homes Standard to new homes built from 2025, will impact
the whole housebuilding sector and therefore become a feature of house price valuation at that time. The Group will also procure land factoring
in these costs to its future margin appraisals, but there is a risk that for some existing parts of the Group’s land portfolio that these costs have to
be absorbed by the Group. We have evaluated management’s assessment of this risk. Our procedures did not identify any material impact as a
result of climate risk on the Group’s and Company’s financial statements.
Materiality
The scope of our audit was influenced by our application of materiality. We set certain quantitative thresholds for materiality. These, together
with qualitative considerations, helped us to determine the scope of our audit and the nature, timing and extent of our audit procedures on the
individual financial statement line items and disclosures and in evaluating the eect of misstatements, both individually and in aggregate on the
financial statements as a whole.
Based on our professional judgement, we determined materiality for the financial statements as a whole as follows:
Financial statements – Group Financial statements – Company
Overall materiality £4,800,000 (2022: £6,400,000). £1,800,000 (2022: £2,200,000).
How we determined it Approximately 5% of a 3-year average of the
Group’s profit before tax and exceptional items
(2022: based on 5% of the current year profit before
tax and exceptional items).
Approximately 1% of total assets.
Rationale for benchmark
applied
Profit before tax and exceptional items is one of
the key measures used by the shareholders in
assessing the performance of the Group and is
a generally accepted auditing benchmark. Using
an average over 3 years is appropriate given the
fluctuation in the Group’s financial performance in
each of these periods, whilst the Group’s statement
of financial position remains relatively consistent.
We believe that total assets is the primary measure
used by the shareholders in assessing the
performance of the entity, which acts solely as
a holding Company, and is a generally accepted
auditing benchmark.
Key audit matter How our audit addressed the key audit matter
Valuation of intercompany receivables (Company)
Refer to Note 5 (Trade and other receivables) of the Company
financial statements.
Intercompany receivables are the largest financial statement line item
in the Company financial statements and are repayable on demand.
The recoverability, and any expected credit losses, of these balances
from other Group companies depends on the ability of the Group as
awhole to generate cash flows to enable future repayment.
Whilst this is not a significant risk for the audit, in the context of the
audit of the Company it is the area of highest audit eort.
Our audit procedures included:
Testing the outcomes of the Group’s going concern model, in
particular the cash flow forecasts, and confirming that there were
no liquidity issues in the Group that would impact the ability of
subsidiaries to repay amounts due; and
Verifying the level of cash held by the subsidiaries of the Group and
their ability to repay this on the basis that sucient cash reserves,
and access to further credit facilities, are held to repay the debt
if required.
Crest Nicholson 107 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Independent auditors’ report continued
For each component in the scope of our Group audit, we allocated a materiality that is less than our overall Group materiality. The range of
materiality allocated across components was between £0.3 million and £4.5 million.
We use performance materiality to reduce to an appropriately low level the probability that the aggregate of uncorrected and undetected
misstatements exceeds overall materiality. Specifically, we use performance materiality in determining the scope of our audit and the nature and
extent of our testing of account balances, classes of transactions and disclosures, for example in determining sample sizes. Our performance
materiality was 75% (2022: 75%) of overall materiality, amounting to £3,600,000 (2022: £4,800,000) for the Group financial statements and
£1,350,000 (2022: £1,650,000) for the Company financial statements.
In determining the performance materiality, we considered a number of factors – the history of misstatements, risk assessment and aggregation
risk and the eectiveness of controls – and concluded that an amount at the upper end of our normal range was appropriate.
We agreed with the Audit and Risk Committee that we would report to them misstatements identified during our audit above £240,000 (Group
audit) (2022: £300,000) and £90,000 (Company audit) (2022: £110,000) as well as misstatements below those amounts that, in our view,
warranted reporting for qualitative reasons.
Conclusions relating to going concern
Our evaluation of the directors’ assessment of the Group’s and the Company’s ability to continue to adopt the going concern basis of
accounting included:
Evaluating the appropriateness of the going concern assessment performed by the directors, including the accuracy of the underlying model
and the principles applied to determine the cash flows;
Testing of the key assumptions used in the model, including comparison to third party market information where appropriate and confirmation
that the assumptions used in the “severe but plausible” downside scenario were suciently severe to model potential future economic
downturn, above and beyond current market forecasts, and that mitigating actions modelled in this scenario were realistic and appropriate;
Evaluating the output of the models and considered this in the context of the Group’s covenants on its lending facilities, and in particular
understanding any risk of potential breach of covenants; and
Ensuring that both the base case and the downside scenario appropriately considered other known risks to the Group, outside the general
assumptions overlayed on underlying trading.
Based on the work we have performed, we have not identified any material uncertainties relating to events or conditions that, individually or
collectively, may cast significant doubt on the Group’s and the Company’s ability to continue as a going concern for a period of at least twelve
months from when the financial statements are authorised for issue.
In auditing the financial statements, we have concluded that the directors’ use of the going concern basis of accounting in the preparation of the
financial statements is appropriate.
However, because not all future events or conditions can be predicted, this conclusion is not a guarantee as to the Group’s and the Company’s
ability to continue as a going concern.
In relation to the directors’ reporting on how they have applied the UK Corporate Governance Code, we have nothing material to add or draw
attention to in relation to the directors’ statement in the financial statements about whether the directors considered it appropriate to adopt the
going concern basis of accounting.
Our responsibilities and the responsibilities of the directors with respect to going concern are described in the relevant sections of this report.
Reporting on other information
The other information comprises all of the information in the Annual Report other than the financial statements and our auditors’ report thereon.
The directors are responsible for the other information. Our opinion on the financial statements does not cover the other information and,
accordingly, we do not express an audit opinion or, except to the extent otherwise explicitly stated in this report, any form of assurance thereon.
In connection with our audit of the financial statements, our responsibility is to read the other information and, in doing so, consider whether
the other information is materially inconsistent with the financial statements or our knowledge obtained in the audit, or otherwise appears to
be materially misstated. If we identify an apparent material inconsistency or material misstatement, we are required to perform procedures to
conclude whether there is a material misstatement of the financial statements or a material misstatement of the other information. If, based on
the work we have performed, we conclude that there is a material misstatement of this other information, we are required to report that fact.
We have nothing to report based on these responsibilities.
With respect to the Strategic Report and the Directors’ Report, we also considered whether the disclosures required by the UK Companies Act
2006 have been included.
Crest Nicholson 108 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Based on our work undertaken in the course of the audit, the Companies Act 2006 requires us also to report certain opinions and matters as
described below.
Strategic report and the Directors’ report
In our opinion, based on the work undertaken in the course of the audit, the information given in the Strategic Report and the Directors’
Report for the year ended 31 October 2023 is consistent with the financial statements and has been prepared in accordance with applicable
legal requirements.
In light of the knowledge and understanding of the Group and Company and their environment obtained in the course of the audit, we did not
identify any material misstatements in the Strategic Report and the Directors’ Report.
Directors’ Remuneration
In our opinion, the part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report to be audited has been properly prepared in accordance with the Companies
Act 2006.
Corporate governance statement
The Listing Rules require us to review the directors’ statements in relation to going concern, longer-term viability and that part of the
corporate governance statement relating to the Company’s compliance with the provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code specified
for our review. Our additional responsibilities with respect to the corporate governance statement as other information are described in the
Reporting on other information section of this report.
Based on the work undertaken as part of our audit, we have concluded that each of the following elements of the corporate governance
statement is materially consistent with the financial statements and our knowledge obtained during the audit, and we have nothing material
to add or draw attention to in relation to:
The directors’ confirmation that they have carried out a robust assessment of the emerging and principal risks;
The disclosures in the Annual Report that describe those principal risks, what procedures are in place to identify emerging risks and an
explanation of how these are being managed or mitigated;
The directors’ statement in the financial statements about whether they considered it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of
accounting in preparing them, and their identification of any material uncertainties to the Group’s and Company’s ability to continue to do
so over a period of at least twelve months from the date of approval of the financial statements;
The directors’ explanation as to their assessment of the Group’s and Company’s prospects, the period this assessment covers and why the
period is appropriate; and
The directors’ statement as to whether they have a reasonable expectation that the Company will be able to continue in operation and
meet its liabilities as they fall due over the period of its assessment, including any related disclosures drawing attention to any necessary
qualifications or assumptions.
Our review of the directors’ statement regarding the longer-term viability of the Group and Company was substantially less in scope than an
audit and only consisted of making inquiries and considering the directors’ process supporting their statement; checking that the statement
is in alignment with the relevant provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code; and considering whether the statement is consistent with
the financial statements and our knowledge and understanding of the Group and Company and their environment obtained in the course of
the audit.
In addition, based on the work undertaken as part of our audit, we have concluded that each of the following elements of the corporate
governance statement is materially consistent with the financial statements and our knowledge obtained during the audit:
The directors’ statement that they consider the Annual Report, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable, and provides the
information necessary for the members to assess the Group’s and Company’s position, performance, business model and strategy;
The section of the Annual Report that describes the review of eectiveness of risk management and internal control systems; and
The section of the Annual Report describing the work of the Audit and Risk Committee.
We have nothing to report in respect of our responsibility to report when the directors’ statement relating to the Company’s compliance
with the Code does not properly disclose a departure from a relevant provision of the Code specified under the Listing Rules for review by
the auditors.
Crest Nicholson 109 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Independent auditors’ report continued
Responsibilities for the financial
statements and the audit
Responsibilities of the directors for the
financial statements
As explained more fully in the Statement
of Directors’ responsibilities in respect of
the financial statements, the directors are
responsible for the preparation of the financial
statements in accordance with the applicable
framework and for being satisfied that they
give a true and fair view. The directors are
also responsible for such internal control as
they determine is necessary to enable the
preparation of financial statements that are
free from material misstatement, whether due
to fraud or error.
In preparing the financial statements, the
directors are responsible for assessing the
Group’s and the Company’s ability to continue
as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable,
matters related to going concern and using
the going concern basis of accounting unless
the directors either intend to liquidate the
Group or the Company or to cease operations,
or have no realistic alternative but to do so.
Auditors’ responsibilities for the audit of the
financial statements
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable
assurance about whether the financial
statements as a whole are free from material
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error,
and to issue an auditors’ report that includes
our opinion. Reasonable assurance is a high
level of assurance, but is not a guarantee that
an audit conducted in accordance with ISAs
(UK) will always detect a material misstatement
when it exists. Misstatements can arise from
fraud or error and are considered material if,
individually or in the aggregate, they could
reasonably be expected to influence the
economic decisions of users taken on the
basis of these financial statements.
Irregularities, including fraud, are instances
of non-compliance with laws and regulations.
We design procedures in line with our
responsibilities, outlined above, to detect
material misstatements in respect of
irregularities, including fraud. The extent
to which our procedures are capable of
detecting irregularities, including fraud, is
detailed below.
Based on our understanding of the Group and
industry, we identified that the principal risks
of non-compliance with laws and regulations
related to government guidelines on fire safety
and other health and safety requirements,
employment law, including legislation relating
to pensions, and we considered the extent to
which non-compliance might have a material
eect on the financial statements. We also
considered those laws and regulations that
have a direct impact on the financial statements
such as the Listing Rules and the Companies
Act 2006. We evaluated management’s
incentives and opportunities for fraudulent
manipulation of the financial statements
(including the risk of override of controls), and
determined that the principal risks were related
to management bias, in particular in areas of
significant estimation uncertainty as set out in
note 1 to the consolidated financial statements,
or where management has the ability to post
inappropriate journals. The Group engagement
team shared this risk assessment with the
component auditors so that they could include
appropriate audit procedures in response
to such risks in their work. Audit procedures
performed by the Group engagement team
and/or component auditors included:
Discussions with the Executive Leadership
Team, Divisional management teams and
the Audit and Risk Committee, review of
internal audit reports and consideration
of known or suspected instances of
non-compliance with laws and regulation
and fraud;
Evaluation and testing of the operating
eectiveness of management’s controls
designed to prevent and detect
irregularities, in particular their controls
around cost and margin forecasting,
including performing alternative audit
procedures where controls were not
deemed to be eective in the period;
Challenging the assumptions and
judgements made by management in
determining their significant accounting
estimates, in particular in relation to cost
and margin forecasting and provisions (see
related key audit matters above); and
Identifying and testing journal entries, in
particular any journal entries posted with
unusual account combinations.
There are inherent limitations in the audit
procedures described above. We are less
likely to become aware of instances of non-
compliance with laws and regulations that are
not closely related to events and transactions
reflected in the financial statements. Also, the
risk of not detecting a material misstatement
due to fraud is higher than the risk of not
detecting one resulting from error, as
fraud may involve deliberate concealment
by, for example, forgery or intentional
misrepresentations, or through collusion.
Our audit testing might include testing
complete populations of certain transactions
and balances, possibly using data auditing
techniques. However, it typically involves
selecting a limited number of items for testing,
rather than testing complete populations.
We will often seek to target particular
items for testing based on their size or
risk characteristics. In other cases, we will
use audit sampling to enable us to draw a
conclusion about the population from which
the sample is selected.
A further description of our responsibilities for
the audit of the financial statements is located
on the FRC’s website at: www.frc.org.uk/
auditorsresponsibilities. This description forms
part of our auditors’ report.
Use of this report
This report, including the opinions, has been
prepared for and only for the Company’s
members as a body in accordance with Chapter
3 of Part 16 of the Companies Act 2006 and for
no other purpose. We do not, in giving these
opinions, accept or assume responsibility for
any other purpose or to any other person to
whom this report is shown or into whose hands
it may come save where expressly agreed by
our prior consent in writing.
Other required reporting
Companies Act 2006 exception reporting
Under the Companies Act 2006 we are
required to report to you if, in our opinion:
we have not obtained all the information
and explanations we require for our audit; or
adequate accounting records have not been
kept by the Company, or returns adequate
for our audit have not been received from
branches not visited by us; or
certain disclosures of directors’
remuneration specified by law are not
made; or
the Company financial statements and the
part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report
to be audited are not in agreement with the
accounting records and returns.
We have no exceptions to report arising from
this responsibility.
Appointment
Following the recommendation of the Audit
and Risk Committee, we were appointed
by the members on 23 March 2015 to audit
the financial statements for the year ended
31 October 2015 and subsequent financial
periods. The period of total uninterrupted
engagement is nine years, covering the years
ended 31 October 2015 to 31 October 2023.
Other matter
In due course, as required by the Financial
Conduct Authority Disclosure Guidance and
Transparency Rule 4.1.14R, these financial
statements will form part of the ESEF-
prepared annual financial report filed on the
National Storage Mechanism of the Financial
Conduct Authority in accordance with the
ESEF Regulatory Technical Standard (‘ESEF
RTS’). This auditors’ report provides no
assurance over whether the annual financial
report will be prepared using the single
electronic format specified in the ESEF RTS.
Darryl Phillips
(Senior Statutory Auditor)
for and on behalf of
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
Chartered Accountants and
Statutory Auditors
London
23 January 2024
Crest Nicholson 110 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Note
2023 2022
Pre- 2023 Pre- 2022
exceptional Exceptional 2023 exceptional Exceptional 2022
items items (note 4) Total items items (note 4) Total
£m£m£m£m£m£m
Revenue
3
657 .5
657 .5
913.6
913.6
Cost of sales
(556.9)
(14.3)
(571.2)
(719.3)
(102.5)
(821.8)
Gross profit/(loss)
10 0.6
(14.3)
86.3
194.3
(102.5)
91.8
Net administrative expenses
5
(55.8)
(55.8)
(51. 1)
(51. 1)
Net impairment losses onnancial
assets
17
(0.6)
(0.6)
(2.3)
(2.3)
Operating profit/(loss)
5
44.2
(14.3)
29.9
140.9
(102.5)
38.4
Finance income
7
4 .1
4 .1
3 .1
3 .1
Finance expense
7
(9.6)
(4. 6)
(14.2)
(10.2)
(1. 0)
(11.2)
Net finance expense
(5.5)
(4.6)
(10. 1)
(7 . 1)
(1.0)
(8. 1)
Share of post-tax profits/(losses)
of joint ventures using the equity
method
14
2 .7
0.6
3.3
4 .0
(1.5)
2.5
Profit/(loss) before tax
41.4
(18.3)
23. 1
137 .8
(105.0)
32.8
Income tax (expense)/credit
8
(10 . 0)
4.8
(5.2)
(28.8)
22.4
(6.4)
Profit/(loss) for the year
attributable to equity
shareholders
31.4
(13.5)
17 .9
1 09.0
(82.6)
26.4
Earnings per ordinary share
Basic
10
12.3p
7. 0p
42.5p
10 .3p
Diluted
10
12.2p
7. 0p
42.3p
10.2p
The notes on pages 115-155 form part of these consolidated financial statements.
Consolidated income statement
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Consolidated statement of comprehensive income
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Note
2023 2022
£m£m
Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders
17 .9
26.4
Other comprehensive (expense)/income:
Items that will not be reclassified to the consolidated income statement:
Actuarial losses of defined benefit schemes
16
(2.5)
(8.4)
Change in deferred tax on actuarial losses of defined benefit schemes
15
1 .1
1 .6
Other comprehensive expense for the year net of income tax
(1.4)
(6.8)
Total comprehensive income attributable to equity shareholders
16.5
19.6
The notes on pages 115-155 form part of these consolidated financial statements.
Crest Nicholson 111 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Note
Share premium Retained
Share capital account earnings Total equit y
£m£m£m£m
Balance at 1 November 2021
12.8
74.2
814.6
901.6
Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders
26.4
26.4
Actuarial losses of defined benefit schemes
16
(8.4)
(8.4)
Change in deferred tax on actuarial losses of defined benefit
schemes
15
1 .6
1 .6
Total comprehensive income for the year
1 9.6
1 9.6
Transactions with shareholders:
Equity-settled share-based payments
16
1.9
1.9
Deferred tax on equity-settled share-based payments
15
(0.4)
(0.4)
Purchase of own shares
23
(1. 1)
(1. 1)
Dividends paid
9
(38.5)
(38.5)
Balance at 31 October 2022
12.8
74.2
796. 1
883. 1
Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders
17 .9
17 .9
Actuarial losses of defined benefit schemes
16
(2.5)
(2.5)
Change in deferred tax on actuarial losses of defined benefit
schemes
15
1 .1
1 .1
Total comprehensive income for the year
16.5
16.5
Transactions with shareholders:
Equity-settled share-based payments
16
1.5
1.5
Deferred tax on equity-settled share-based payments
15
(0.2)
(0 .2)
Purchase of own shares
23
(1.9)
(1.9)
Transfers in respect of share options
0. 9
0.9
Dividends paid
9
(43.6)
(43. 6)
Balance at 31 October 2023
12.8
74.2
769.3
856.3
The notes on pages 115-155 form part of these consolidated financial statements.
Consolidated statement of changes in equity
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 112 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Consolidated statement of financial position
As at 31 October 2023
Assets Note
2023 2022
£m£m
Non-current assets
Intangible assets
11
2 9.0
2 9.0
Property, plant and equipment
12
2.2
0. 9
Right-of-use assets
13
6 .1
3 .7
Investments in joint ventures
14
1 0.7
9.0
Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss
2 .6
3.3
Deferred tax assets
15
3.3
4.8
Retirement benefit surplus
16
1 0.0
11. 1
Trade and other receivables
17
6 .0
35. 0
69.9
96.8
Current assets
Inventories
18
1, 164.8
990 . 1
Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss
1 .1
1.3
Trade and other receivables
17
1 20.0
116.3
Current income tax receivable
11.9
1 .1
Cash and cash equivalents
19
162.6
373. 6
1,460.4
1,482.4
Total assets
1,530.3
1,579.2
Liabilities
Non-current liabilities
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
20
(83.5)
(97 . 1)
Trade and other payables
21
(71. 1)
(41.8)
Lease liabilities
13
(4.4)
(2.3)
Deferred tax liabilities
15
(2.5)
(3.2)
Provisions
22
(73.8)
(70.8)
(235.3)
(215.2)
Current liabilities
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
20
(14.2)
Trade and other payables
21
(337 .0)
(407 .1)
Lease liabilities
13
(2. 0)
(1.6)
Provisions
22
(85.5)
(72.2)
(438. 7)
(480.9)
Total liabilities
(674.0)
(696. 1)
Net assets
(856.3)
(883. 1)
Equity
Share capital
23
12.8
12.8
Share premium account
23
74.2
74.2
Retained earnings
769 .3
796. 1
Total equity
856.3
883. 1
The notes on pages 115-155 form part of these consolidated financial statements.
These consolidated financial statements on pages 111-155 were approved by the Board of Directors on 23 January 2024.
On behalf of the Board
Peter Truscott Bill Floydd
Director Director
Crest Nicholson 113 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Consolidated cash flow statement
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Note
2023 2022
£m£m
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders
17 .9
26.4
Adjustments for:
Depreciation on property, plant and equipment
12
0. 5
0. 4
Depreciation on right-of-use assets
13
2.3
1.9
Retirement benefit obligation administrative expenses
16
0.6
0.9
Net finance expense
7
1 0 .1
8 .1
Share-based payment expense
16
1.5
1.9
Share of post-tax profits of joint ventures using the equity method
14
(3.3)
(2.5)
Impairment of inventories movement
18
7. 6
(8. 1)
Net impairment of financial assets
17
0.6
2.3
Income tax expense
8
5.2
6.4
Operating profit before changes in working capital, provisions and contributions to
retirement benefit obligations
43.0
3 7. 7
Decrease/(increase) in trade and other receivables
2 7. 0
(17 . 0)
(Increase)/decrease in inventories
(182.3)
55.5
Decrease in trade and other payables and provisions
(31.9)
(13.4)
Contribution to retirement benefit obligations
16
(1.5)
(3.4)
Cash (used by)/generated from operations
(145. 7)
59.4
Finance expense paid
(5. 6)
(6.3)
Income tax paid
(14.3)
(1.4)
Net cash (outflow)/inflow from operating activities
(165.6)
51. 7
Cash flows from investing activities
Purchases of property, plant and equipment
12
(1.8)
(0 . 1)
Disposal of financial assets at fair value through profit and loss
0. 9
0 .7
Funding to joint ventures
(13. 0)
(7 .5)
Repayment of funding from joint ventures
11. 7
18.8
Dividends received from joint ventures
1.5
2.4
Finance income received
2.3
0 .1
Net cash inflow from investing activities
1.6
14.4
Cash flows from financing activities
Principal elements of lease payments
13
(2.4)
(2. 1)
Dividends paid
9
(43. 6)
(38.5)
Net purchase of own shares
(1. 0)
(1. 1)
Debt arrangement and facility fees
(1.5)
Net cash outflow from financing activities
(47 .0)
(43.2)
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents
(211.0)
22.9
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year
373. 6
350. 7
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year
19
162.6
373.6
The notes on pages 115-155 form part of these consolidated financial statements.
Crest Nicholson 114 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
1 Accounting policies
Basis of preparation
Crest Nicholson Holdings plc (Company)
is a public limited company incorporated,
listed and domiciled in the UK. The address
of the registered ored office is 500 Dashwood
Lang Road, Bourne Business Park,
Addlestone, Surrey KT15 2HJ. The Group
financial statements consolidate those of
the Company and its subsidiaries (together
referred to as the Group) and include the
Group’s interest in jointly controlled entities.
The parent company financial statements
present information about the Company as a
separate entity and not about its Group.
The financial statements are presented
in pounds sterling and amounts stated
are denominated in millions (£m), unless
otherwise stated.
The Group financial statements have been
prepared and approved by the Directors in
accordance with UK-adopted international
accounting standards, and with the
requirements of the Companies Act 2006
as applicable to companies reporting under
those standards and have been prepared on
the historical cost basis except for financial
assets at fair value through profit and loss,
which are as otherwise stated. The parent
company financial statements are presented
on pages 156-160.
The preparation of financial statements in
conformity with UK-adopted international
accounting standards requires the Directors
to make assumptions and judgements that
aeaffect the application of policies and reported
amounts within the financial statements.
Assumptions and judgements are based
on experience and other factors that the
Directors consider reasonable under the
circumstances. Actual results may dier fiffer from
these estimates.
Judgements made by the Directors, in the
application of these accounting policies
that have a significant eect on the a significant effect on the financial
statements and estimates with a significant
risk of material adjustment in the next year
are discussed below.
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Going concern
The Directors have adopted the going concern basis in preparing the financial statements and have concluded that there are no material
uncertainties leading to significant doubt about the Group’s going concern status. The assessment has been performed over the 15 month
period to April 2025, aligning with the measurement date of the Group’s covenants on its lending facilities.
Assessment of principal risks
The Directors assessed the Group’s principal risks as detailed on pages 37–42 and considered three overarching risks when developing the
stress testing for this assessment. These risks were selected due to the potential impact over the period assessed for going concern, which
isshorter than theis shorter than the period used for the principal risk assessment.
Risk Mitigation and other considerations Link to principal risks
Will the volume of home completions
fall further?
Will the current economic activity disrupt
future operations and our ability to build and
sell properties?
Will material and labour availability worsen
due to energy prices or other economic
factors and impact project timelines?
The Group has successfully demonstrated
its ability to trade eece effectively in previous
downturns in the housing cycle and benefits
from a strong balance sheet and good
forward order book
The UK Government has consistently
demonstrated its support for the housing
lending market, encouraging lenders to
maintain good levels of mortgage availability
The Group benefits from strong supplier
and subcontractor relationships that help
mitigate availability issues.
Market conditions
Supply chain
Will UK house prices fall?
Will the current or further decline in
macro-economic conditions result in lower
prices for UK property due to reduced
demand through unemployment or
mortgage availability?
Will the higher cost of mortgages persist and
create an aordability gap an affordability gap?
The Group has a good forward order
book of reservations and exchanges at
prevailing prices
There is appetite for institutional capital
investment into the UK property market
that helps mitigate any cyclical drop in
confidence in the private market
The Group participates in aordability affordability
schemes such as Deposit Unlock.
Market conditions
Will build cost inflation remain high
and sustained?
Will the availability of materials and labour
remain scarce because of the war in Ukraine
and high energy prices?
Will the move to more sustainable building
practices and materials lead to an increase in
construction costs?
The Group benefits from well-negotiated
central contracts with suppliers which help
mitigate cost increases
The Group’s implementation of COINS as its
new ERP platform will enhance the reporting
of build costs for the divisions once initial
issues are resolved, the implementation was
completed in FY23 with all divisions now
using a consistent system.
Supply chain
Build cost management
Crest Nicholson 115 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Applying these risks against future forecasts
The Directors have considered prior years
trading performance and the completed
weeks of trading since 31 October 2023.
The Group retains a good level of working
capital and liquidity to execute its strategy.
During the prior year the Group completed
a £250.0m Sustainability Linked RCF which
expires in October 2026. The Group also
benefits from £100.0m of senior loan notes.
Both of these sources of financing are subject
to three financial covenant tests. Details of
these covenants can be found in note 24.
The RCF is also subject to sustainability
targets which are aligned to the Group’s
sustainability strategy with a lower interest
rate payable if these are achieved. See note
24 for more information. Given the Group’s
good liquidity position the Directors consider
the possibility of breaching one of the
financial covenants as being the first sign that
the Group could be in distress and should be
the basis of its going concern assessment in
this year’s financial statements.
The Directors have then considered
three scenarios that stress test how the
Group would perform against the risks
outlined above.
1. ‘Base case’. The Directors have considered
the forecast for FY24 and FY25 covering
the period to April 2025. The forecasts
include the Directors current assessment
of the potential impact of the economic
uncertainty currently being experienced in
the UK. These impacts include sales price
and sales volume expectation, but are not
disclosed as the Group considers them to
be commercially sensitive.
The Group has already secured a
significant proportion of sales for
FY24 by way of its forward order book.
Under this scenario the Group maintains
a good level of liquidity and financial
headroom throughout FY24 and across
the going concern period and remains
compliant with all three covenants with
comfortable headroom.
2. ‘Severe but plausible downside case’.
The Directors have applied the three risks
outlined above to the base case scenario
without double counting the sales price
and volume assumptions implicit in that
base case. These risks are considered
eeeffective from 1 November 2023 and
include a 0.37 SPOW (FY23 SPOW was
0.52), a reduction in forecast average
selling prices that increase over time and
reaches a peak of 7% before recovering
and a 10.0% increase in forecast build
costs. Build costs include the Group’s
stated commitment under the Developer
Remediation Contract to remediate legacy
buildings and therefore any assumed
increase in build costs also increases the
size of this commitment. Each of these
risks has been applied individually and
the Group remains compliant with all
three covenants with sucifficient headroom.
The Directors have then applied the
7.0% sales price reduction together with
the 0.37 SPOW rate, to reflect what they
consider to be a ‘severe but plausible
downside case’ outcome and trading
environment. The build cost inflation
risk was not included in this severe but
plausible downside case, as during a
downturn as severe as that considered,
the Group has historically seen build cost
deflation as suppliers and subcontractors
swiftly recalibrate their pricing to compete
for work in shrinking forward order
books. As such, applying all three risks in
aggregate was not considered plausible.
This combined scenario inevitably places
a higher stress than the base case
scenario, but again the Group remains
compliant with all three covenants, with
sucient headsufficient headroom.
In all three ‘downside’ individual scenarios,
and in the combined scenario, the Group
has used appropriate mitigations available
to enable it to ot to offset the deterioration in
financial performance. These mitigations
are within the control of the Group and
can be enacted in good time, and are
outlined below.
3. ‘Test to failure’. The assumptions have then
individually, and again in combination,
been applied to each of the risks above
to a level beyond that which is considered
to be a plausible ‘downside’ scenario.
This informs the Directors as to what level
of stress would be needed to realise a
breach in any of the covenants. The results
of these tests are not disclosed as they are
considered commercially sensitive.
Mitigation options and considerations
Based on the assessment methodology
outlined above the Directors have considered
some of the mitigations that could be applied
in a deteriorating trading environment to
either increase profit or conserve cash.
Some of these measures are implicit
outcomes of a downturn (such as reduction
in build spend) rather than mitigating actions
which the Group would have to apply.
The Group has experience of applying such
mitigations in the past, which include but are
not limited to:
The impact of any immediate reduction in
home reservations or achieved average
selling prices would be mitigated by the
Group’s forward order book of reservations
and exchanges
A reduction in Group overheads to reflect
the lower build and selling activity in a
weaker trading environment
Renegotiation of supplier arrangements as
the amount of build activity contracts, and
materials suppliers and subcontractors are
required to be more competitive, reducing
build spend
Mothballing unproductive and/or capital-
intensive schemes
Repaying interest-bearing products to
reduce the net interest charge, recognising
the Group’s current liquidity position
A reduction in sales and marketing costs to
reflect a fall in sales volumes
A reduction in discretionary land
acquisitions and therefore land
expenditure as we require less land to
replenish the land portfolio
Reduction in dividend to conserve cash.
Conclusion on going concern
In reviewing the assessment outlined
above the Directors are confident that the
Group has the necessary resources and
mitigations available to continue trading for
at least 12 months from the date of signing
of the financial statements. Accordingly, the
consolidated financial statements continue to
be prepared on a going concern basis.
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 116 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Critical accounting estimates
andjudgementsand judgements
The preparation of the consolidated financial
statements under UK-adopted international
accounting standards requires the Directors
to make estimates and assumptions that
aeaffect the application of policies and reported
amounts of assets and liabilities, income and
expenses and related disclosures. In applying
the Group’s accounting policies, the key
judgements that have a significant impact
on the financial statements, include those
involving estimates, which are described
below, the judgement to present certain items
as exceptional (see note 4), certain revenue
policies relating to part exchange sales, the
identification of performance obligations
where a revenue transaction involves the
sale of both land and residential units and
revenue on the units is then subsequently
recognised over time where the land sale
element takes place at the start of the contract
(see note3 foe note 3 for the split of revenue recognised
at a point in time and recognised over time),
the recognition of the defined benefit pension
scheme net surplus (see note 16) and the
current and non-current presentation of the
combustible materials provision.
The Group has made a judgement to not
recognise revenue on the proceeds received
on the disposal of properties taken in part
exchange against a new property as they are
incidental to the main revenue-generating
activities of the Group. As part exchange
sales are deemed incidental, the income and
expenses associated with part exchange
properties are recognised in other operating
income and other operating expenses which
are presented within net administrative
expenses in the consolidated income
statement. Income is recognised when legal
title is passed to the customer. Previously the
income and associated costs arising on these
sales was presented net within cost of sales.
The prior year balance has not been restated
since the net result is immaterial to the Group
and there is no change to the operating profit
realised in each year.
Estimates and associated assumptions
aectaffecting the financial statements are based
on historical experience and various other
factors that are believed to be reasonable
under the circumstances. The estimates and
underlying assumptions are reviewed on
an ongoing basis. Changes in accounting
estimates may be necessary if there are
changes in the circumstances on which
the estimate was based or as a result of
new information.
Revisions to accounting estimates are
recognised in the year in which the estimate
is revised if the revision aecn affects only that
year, or in the year of revision and future
years if the revision aen affects both current and
future years.
The Directors have made consistent
estimates and assumptions in reviewing the
going concern assumption as those detailed
above. The Directors consider the key
sources of estimation uncertainty that have
a risk of causing a material adjustment to
the carrying value of assets and liabilities as
described below.
Carrying value of inventories
Inventories of work-in-progress, completed
buildings including show homes and part
exchange inventories are stated in the
consolidated statement of financial position
at the lower of cost or NRV. On a regular
basis management update estimates
of future revenue and expenditure for
each development. Future revenue and
expenditure may diery differ from estimates which
could lead to an impairment of inventory if
there are adverse changes. Where forecast
revenues are lower than forecast total costs
an inventory provision is made. This provision
may be reversed in subsequent periods if
there is evidence of sustained improved
revenue or reduced expenditure forecast on
a development. If forecast revenue was 10.0%
lower on sites within the short-term portfolio
(total land portfolio excluding strategic land)
as at 31 October 2023, the impact on profit
before tax would have been £15.9m lower
(2022: £7.0m lower).
Estimation of development profitability
Due to the nature of development
activity and, in particular, the length of
the development cycle, the Group has to
make estimates of the costs to complete
developments, in particular those which
are multi-phase and/or may have significant
infrastructure costs. These estimates
are reflected in the margin recognised
on developments in relation to sales
recognised in the current and future years.
There is a degree of inherent uncertainty
in making such estimates. The Group
has established internal controls that are
designed to ensure an eective assessment ensure an effective assessment
of estimates is made of the costs to complete
developments. The Group considers
estimates of the costs to complete on
longer-term sites, which typically have higher
upfront shared infrastructure costs to have
greater estimation uncertainty than sites
of shorter duration with less infrastructure
requirements. A change in estimated margins
on sites, for example due to changes in
estimates of build cost inflation or a reduction
in house prices, could alter future profitability.
If forecast costs were 10.0% higher on
sites which contributed to the year ended
31 October 2023 and which are forecast to
still be in production beyond the year ending
31 October 2025 (2022: beyond the year
ending 31 October 2024), profit before tax
in the current year would have been £32.3m
lower (2022: £25.3m lower).
The Group has considered the potential
financial impacts associated with transitional
and physical climate-related risks and
opportunities. The primary known impact is
the FHS, due to be implemented from 2025,
which is expected to increase build cost for
individual units. The anticipated additional
build cost has been included in new project
acquisition appraisals since the FHS was
announced. Projects already underway will
be substantially built out before the new
regulations commence. It is not expected that
the additional build cost will have a material
impact on the carrying value of inventories
or their associated project margins or the
value of goodwill. The longer-term costs
associated with climate-related risks are
considered to be beyond the timescale of the
projects the Group is currently contracted
to and as such do not impact the carrying
value of inventories or their associated
project margins. Further information on
climate-related risks and opportunities is
provided on pages 47–48 and this represents
an area of estimation rather than a critical
accounting estimate.
Valuation of the pension scheme assets and
liabilities
In determining the valuation of the pension
scheme assets and liabilities, the Directors
utilise the services of an actuary. The actuary
uses key assumptions being inflation rate, life
expectancy, discount rate and Guaranteed
Minimum Pensions, which are dependent
on factors outside the control of the Group.
To the extent that such assumptions dier differ
to that expected, the pension liability would
change. See note 16 for additional details.
Combustible materials
The combustible materials provision requires
a number of key estimates and assumptions
in its calculation. If it is deemed that the costs
are probable and can be reliably measured
then, as per IAS 37, a provision is recorded.
If costs are considered possible or cannot be
reliably estimated, then they are recorded
as contingent liabilities (see note 25).
During the year, the combustible materials
provision has been increased to reflect the
most contemporaneous assessment of these
costs. The Group signed the Developer
Remediation Contract on 13 March 2023,
which did not materially alter the provision
required from that recorded as at 31 October
2022. In the previous financial year, the
Group signed the UK Government’s Building
Safety Pledge (the Pledge), a consequence
of which the Group has committed to funding
the remediation of life-critical fire safety
issues on buildings over 11 metres in which
the Group was involved from 1992.
Crest Nicholson 117 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
The key assumptions used to determine
the provision include but are not limited to
identification of the properties impacted
through the period of construction
considered. The key estimates then applied
to these properties include the potential
costs of investigation, replacement materials
and works to complete, along with the timing
of forecast expenditure. The Directors have
used BSF cost information, other external
information, and internal assessments as
a basis for the estimated remedial costs.
These estimates are inherently uncertain
due to the highly complex and bespoke
nature of the buildings. The actual costs
may dier tiffer to the amounts notified by the
BSF costed projects, and fire safety reports
in progress may require dire different levels of
remediation and associated costs than those
currently estimated. If forecast remediation
costs on buildings currently provided for
are 20.0% higher than provided, the pre-tax
exceptional items charge in the consolidated
income statement would be £29.0m higher.
If further buildings are identified this could
also increase the required provision, but the
potential quantity of this change cannot be
readily determined without further claims or
investigative work. See notes 4 and 22 for
additional details.
Adoption of new and
revisedstandardsrevised standards
There are no new standards, amendments
to standards and interpretations that are
applicable to the Group and are mandatory
for the first time for the financial year
beginning 1 November 2022 which have had
a material impact on the Group.
Impact of standards and
interpretations in issue but
not yet eectivenot yet effective
There are a number of standards,
amendments and interpretations that have
been published that are not mandatory for
the 31 October 2023 reporting period and
have not been adopted early by the Group.
The Group does not expect that the adoption
of these standards, amendments and
interpretations will have a material impact
on the financial statements of the Group in
future years.
Other accounting policies
The accounting policies set out below have,
unless otherwise stated, been applied
consistently to all periods presented in
these Group financial statements except in
respect of the presentation of the proceeds
generated from the disposal of part exchange
properties as detailed within critical
accounting estimates and judgements.
Alternative performance measures
The Group has adopted various APMs, as
presented on pages 161-162. These measures
are not defined by IFRS and therefore
may not be directly comparable with
other companies’ APMs, and should be
considered in addition to, and are not
intended to be a substitute for, or superior to,
IFRS measurements.
Consolidation
The consolidatednancial statements include
the financial statements of Crest Nicholson
Holdings plc, its subsidiary undertakings
and the Group’s share of the results of joint
ventures and joint operations. Inter-company
transactions, balances and unrealised gains
on transactions between group companies
are eliminated on consolidation.
(a) Subsidiaries
Subsidiaries are entities in which the Group
has control. The Group controls an entity
when the Group is exposed to, or has rights
to, variable returns through its power over
the entity. In assessing control, potential
voting rights that are currently exercisable or
convertible are taken into account. The profits
and losses of subsidiaries are included in the
consolidated financial statements from the
date that control commences until the date
that control ceases.
The acquisition method of accounting is used
by the Group to account for the acquisition
of subsidiaries that are a business under
IFRS 3. On acquisition of a subsidiary, all
of the subsidiary’s separable, identifiable
assets and liabilities existing at the date
of acquisition are recorded at their fair
values reflecting their condition at that date.
All changes to those assets and liabilities
and the resulting gains and losses that
arise after the Group has gained control of
the subsidiary are charged to the post-
acquisition consolidated income statement
or consolidated statement of comprehensive
income. Accounting policies of acquired
subsidiaries are changed where necessary, to
ensure consistency with policies adopted by
the Group.
Acquisitions of subsidiaries which do not
qualify as a business under IFRS 3 are
accounted for as an asset acquisition
rather than a business combination.
Under such circumstances the fair value of
the consideration paid for the subsidiary
is allocated to the assets and liabilities
purchased based on their relative fair value
at the date of purchase. No goodwill is
recognised on such transactions.
(b) Joint ventures
A joint venture is a contractual arrangement
in which the Group and other parties
undertake an economic activity that is
subject to joint control and these parties
have rights to the net assets of the
arrangement. The Group reports its interests
in joint ventures using the equity method
of accounting. Under this method, interests
in joint ventures are initially recognised at
cost and adjusted thereafter to recognise
the Group’s share of the post-acquisition
profits or losses and movements in other
comprehensive income. The Group’s share
of results of the joint venture after tax is
included in a single line in the consolidated
income statement. Where the share of losses
exceeds the Group’s interest in the entity
and there is no obligation to fund these
losses, the carrying amount is reduced
to nil and recognition of further losses is
discontinued, unless there is a long-term
receivable due from the joint venture in which
case, if appropriate, the loss is recognised
against the receivable. If an obligation to
fund losses exists the further losses and a
provision are recognised. Unrealised gains
on transactions between the Group
and its joint ventures are eliminated on
consolidation. Accounting policies of joint
ventures are changed where necessary, to
ensure consistency with policies adopted by
the Group.
(c) Joint operations
A joint operation is a joint arrangement that
the Group undertakes with other parties,
in which those parties have rights to the
assets and obligations of the arrangement.
The Group accounts for joint operations by
recognising its share of the jointly controlled
assets and liabilities and income and
expenditure on a line-by-line basis in the
consolidated statement of financial position
and consolidated income statement.
Goodwill
Goodwill arising on consolidation represents
the excess of the cost of acquisition over
the Group’s interest in the fair value of the
identifiable assets and liabilities of the
acquired entity at the date of the acquisition
and is not amortised. Goodwill arising on
acquisition of subsidiaries and businesses
is capitalised as an asset. The goodwill
balance has been allocated to the strategic
land holdings within the Group. The Group
expects to benefit from the strategic land
holdings for a further period of 14 years to
2038. The period used in the assessment
represents the estimated time it will take
to obtain planning and build out on the
remaining acquired strategic land holdings.
Goodwill is assessed for impairment at
each reporting date. The sites acquired are
considered as a singular cash generating
unit and the value in use is calculated on
a discounted cash flow basis with more
speculative strategic sites given a lower
probability of reaching development.
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 118 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
The calculated discounted cash flow value
is compared to the goodwill balance to
assess if it is impaired. Any impairment loss is
recognised immediately in the consolidated
income statement.
Revenue and profit recognition
Revenue comprises the fair value of the
consideration received or receivable, net of
value added tax and discounts.
The Group has made a judgement to not
recognise revenue on the proceeds received
on the disposal of properties taken in part
exchange against a new property as they are
incidental to the main revenue-generating
activities of the Group. As part exchange
sales are deemed incidental, the income and
expenses associated with part exchange
properties are recognised in other operating
income and other operating expenses which
are presented within net administrative
expenses in the consolidated income
statement. Income is recognised when legal
title is passed to the customer. Previously the
income and associated costs arising on these
sales was presented net within cost of sales.
The prior year balance has not been restated
since the net result is immaterial to the Group
and there is no change to the operating profit
realised in each year.
Revenue is recognised on house and
apartment sales at legal completion.
For aordable andFor affordable and other sales in bulk,
revenue recognition is dependent on
freehold legal title being passed to
the customer as it is considered that
upon transfer of freehold title that the
customer controls the work-in-progress.
Where freehold legal title and control
is passed to the customer, revenue is
recognised on any upfront sale of land (where
applicable) and then on the housing units
as the build of the related units progresses,
via surveys of work performed on contract
activity. Where freehold legal title is not
passed to the customer, revenue is not
recognised on any upfront sale of land and
the revenue on the housing units and sale of
land is recognised at handover of completed
units to the customer. The transaction
price for all housing units is derived from
contractual negotiations and does not
include any material variable consideration.
Revenue is predominantly recognised on land
sales when legal title passes to the customer.
If the Group has remaining performance
obligations, such as the provision of services
to the land, an element of revenue is
allocated to these performance obligations
and recognised as the obligations are
performed, which can be when the works are
finished if the work-in-progress is controlled
by the Group or over the performance of the
works if they are controlled by the customer.
Revenue recognition on commercial property
sales is dependent on freehold legal title
being passed to the customer, as it is
considered that upon transfer of freehold
title that the customer controls the work-in-
progress. Where freehold legal title is passed
to the customer, revenue is recognised on
any upfront sale of land (where applicable)
and then on the development revenue over
time as the build of the related commercial
units progress. Where freehold legal title is
not passed to the customer revenue is not
recognised on any upfront sale of land and
the revenue on the commercial property is
recognised at handover of the completed
commercial unit to the customer.
The transaction price for commercial
property revenue may include an element
of variable consideration based on the
commercial occupancy of the units when they
are completed, though this is not expected to
be material. If this is the case, the Directors
take the view that unless the lettings not yet
contracted are highly probable they should
not be included in the calculation of the
transaction price. The transaction price is
regularly updated to reflect any changes in
the accounting period.
Revenue is recognised on freehold reversion
sales when the customer is contractually
entitled to the ground rent revenue stream
associated with the units purchased.
Revenue on specification upgrades
paid for by the customer or on the cost
of specification upgrades oeres offered to the
customer as part of the purchase price is
recognised as revenue when legal title
passes to the customer.
Profit is recognised on a plot-by-plot basis,
by reference to the margin forecast across
the related development site. Due to the
development cycle often exceeding one
financial year, plot margins are forecast,
taking into account the allocation of site-wide
development costs such as infrastructure,
and estimates required for the cost to
complete such developments.
Exceptional items
Exceptional items are those which, in the
opinion of the Directors, are material by
size and/or non-recurring in nature such as
significant costs and settlements associated
with combustible materials, significant costs
associated with acquiring another business,
significant legal matters and significant
inventory impairments. Where appropriate,
the Directors consider that items should be
considered as categories or classes of items,
such as any credits/costs impacting the
consolidated income statement which relate
to combustible materials, notwithstanding
where an item may be individually immaterial.
The Directors believe that these items require
separate disclosure within the consolidated
income statement in order to assist the
users of the financial statements to better
understand the performance of the Group,
which is also how the Directors internally
manage the business. Where appropriate,
the material reversal of any of these amounts
will also be reflected through exceptional
items. Additional charges/credits to items
classified as exceptional items in prior years
will be classified as exceptional in the current
year, unless immaterial to the financial
statements. As these exceptional items can
vary significantly year on year, they may
introduce volatility into the reported earnings.
The income tax impacts of exceptional items
are reflected at the actual tax rate related to
these items.
Net finance expense
Interest income is recognised on a time
apportioned basis by reference to the
principal outstanding and the eective and the effective
interest rate. Interest costs are recognised
in the consolidated income statement on an
accruals basis in the period in which they
are incurred. Imputed interest expense on
deferred land creditors and combustible
materials discounting is recognised over the
life of associated cash flows.
Income and deferred tax
Income tax comprises current tax and
deferred tax. Income tax is recognised in the
consolidated income statement except to
the extent that it relates to items recognised
in other comprehensive income, in which
case it is recognised in other comprehensive
income. Current tax is the expected tax
payable on taxable profit for the year and
any adjustment to tax payable in respect of
previous years. Taxable profit is profit before
tax per the consolidated income statement
after adjusting for income and expenditure
that is not subject to tax, and for items
that are subject to tax in other accounting
periods. The Group’s liability for current tax
is calculated using tax rates that have been
enacted or substantively enacted by the
consolidated statement of financial position
date. Current tax assets are recognised
to the extent that it is probable the asset
is recoverable.
Deferred tax is provided in full on temporary
dierences between the carrying amountdifferences between the carrying amounts
of assets and liabilities in the financial
statements and the corresponding tax bases
used in the computation of taxable profits.
Deferred tax assets are recognised to the
extent that it is probable that taxable profits
will be available against which deductible
temporary dierences differences can be utilised.
Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for
all temporary diereifferences. Deferred tax is
calculated using tax rates that have been
substantively enacted by the consolidated
statement of financial position date.
Crest Nicholson 119 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Dividends
Final and interim dividend distributions to the
Company’s shareholders are recorded in the
Group’s financial statements in the earlier of
the period in which they are approved by the
Company’s shareholders, or paid.
Employee benefits
(a) Pensions
The Group operates a defined benefit
(DB) scheme (closed to new employees
since October 2001 and to future service
accrual since April 2010) and also makes
payments into a defined contribution scheme
for employees.
In respect of the DB scheme, the retirement
benefit deficit or surplus is calculated by
estimating the amount of future benefit that
employees have earned in return for their
service in the current and prior periods, such
benefits measured at discounted present
value, less the fair value of the scheme
assets. The rate used to discount the benefits
accrued is the yield at the consolidated
statement of financial position date on AA
credit rated bonds that have maturity dates
approximating to the terms of the Group’s
obligations. The calculation is performed by
a qualified actuary using the projected unit
method. The operating and financing costs of
such plans are recognised separately in the
consolidated income statement; past service
costs and financing costs are recognised in
the periods in which they arise. The Group
recognises expected scheme gains and
losses via the consolidated income statement
and actuarial gains and losses are recognised
in the period they occur directly in other
comprehensive income, with associated
deferred tax.
The retirement benefit deficit or surplus
recognised in the consolidated statement
of financial position represents the deficit
or surplus of the fair value of the scheme’s
assets over the present value of scheme
liabilities, with any net surplus recognised
to the extent that the employer can
gain economic benefit as set out in the
requirements of IFRIC 14.
Payments to the defined contribution scheme
are accounted for on an accruals basis.
(b) Share-based payments
The fair value of equity-settled, share-based
compensation plans is recognised as an
employee expense with a corresponding
increase in equity. The fair value is measured
as at the date the options are granted and
the charge amended if vesting does not
take place due to non-market conditions
(such as service or performance) not being
met. The fair value is spread over the period
during which the employees become
unconditionally entitled to the shares and
is adjusted to reflect the actual number
of options that vest. At the consolidated
statement of financial position date, if it is
expected that non-market conditions will
not be satisfied, the cumulative expense
recognised in relation to the relevant options
is reversed. The proceeds received are
credited to share capital (nominal value)
and share premium when the options are
exercised if new shares are issued. If treasury
shares are used the proceeds are credited to
retained reserves. There are no cash-settled
share-based compensation plans.
Own shares held by Employee
ShareOShare Ownership Trust (ESOT)
Transactions of the Company-sponsored
ESOT are included in both the Group financial
statements and the Company’s own financial
statements. The purchase of shares in the
Company by the ESOT are charged directly
to equity.
Software as a Service (SaaS)
arrangements
Implementation costs including costs to
configure or customise a cloud provider’s
application software are recognised as
administrative expenses when the services
are received, and the Group determines
that there is no control over the asset
in development.
Property, plant and equipment
Property, plant and equipment is stated
at cost less accumulated depreciation.
Cost includes the original purchase price
of the asset and the costs attributable to
bringing the asset to its working condition.
Depreciation is calculated to write o thte off the cost
of the assets on a straight-line basis to their
estimated residual value over its expected
useful life at the following rates:
Fixtures and fittings 10%
Computer equipment and
non-SaaS software 20% to 33%
The asset residual values, carrying values
and useful lives are reviewed on an
annual basis and adjusted if appropriate at
each consolidated statement of financial
position date.
Right-of-use assets and
leaseliabilitieslease liabilities
The Group assesses at lease inception
whether a contract is, or contains, a lease.
The Group recognises a right-of-use asset
and a lease liability at lease commencement.
The right-of-use asset is initially recorded
at the present value of future lease
payments and subsequently measured
net of depreciation, which is charged to
the consolidated income statement as an
administrative expense over the shorter of
its useful economic life or its lease term on a
straight-line basis.
The Group recognises lease liabilities at
the present value of future lease payments,
lease payments being discounted at the
rate implicit in the lease or the Group’s
incremental borrowing rate as determined
with reference to the most recently issued
financial liabilities carrying interest.
The discount is subsequently unwound
and recorded in the consolidated income
statement over the lease term as a finance
expense. The lease term comprises the non-
cancellable period of the contract, together
with periods covered by an option to extend
the lease where the Group is reasonably
certain to exercise that option.
The Group has elected not to recognise
right-of-use assets and lease liabilities for
short-term leases that have a lease term of
12 months or less and leases of low value
assets. The Group recognises the lease
payments associated with these leases as
an expense on a straight-line basis over the
lease term.
Inventories
Inventories are stated at the lower of cost
and NRV.
Work-in-progress and completed buildings
including show homes comprise land under
development, undeveloped land, land
option payments, direct materials, sub-
contract work, labour costs, site overheads,
associated professional fees and other
attributable overheads, but excludes
interest costs.
Part exchange inventories are held at the
lower of cost and NRV, which includes
an assessment of costs of management
and resale.
Land inventories and the associated land
payables are recognised in the consolidated
statement of financial position from the date
of unconditional exchange of contracts.
Land payables are recognised as part of
trade and other payables.
Options purchased in respect of land
are recognised initially as a prepayment
within inventories and written down on a
straight-line basis over the life of the option.
If planning permission is granted and the
option exercised, the option is not written
down during that year and its carrying value
is included within the cost of land purchased.
Provisions are established to write down
inventories where the estimated net sales
proceeds less costs to complete exceed
the current carrying value. Adjustments to
the provisions will be required where selling
prices or costs to complete change. NRV for
inventories is assessed by estimating selling
prices and costs, taking into account current
market conditions.
Financial assets
Financial assets are initially recognised at fair
value and subsequently classified into one of
the following measurement categories:
At amortised cost
Subsequently at FVTPL
Subsequently at FVOCI.
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 120 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
The classification of financial assets depends
on the Group’s business model for managing
the asset and the contractual terms of the
cash flows. Assets that are held for the
collection of contractual cash flows that
represent solely payments of principal and
interest are measured at amortised cost,
with any interest income recognised in the
consolidated income statement using the
eeeffective interest rate method.
Financial assets that do not meet the
criteria to be measured at amortised cost
are classified by the Group as measured
at FVTPL. Fair value gains and losses
on financial assets measured at FVTPL
are recognised in the consolidated
income statement and presented within
administrative expenses. The Group currently
has no financial assets measured at FVOCI.
Financial assets at fair value through
profit and loss
Financial assets at fair value through profit
and loss (which comprise shared equity
receivables) are classified as being held to
collect and initially recognised at fair value.
Changes in fair value relating to the expected
recoverable amount are recognised in the
consolidated income statement as a finance
income or expense. These assets are held
as current or non-current based on their
contractual repayment dates.
Trade and other receivables
Trade and other receivables are recognised
initially at fair value and subsequently
measured at amortised cost, using the
eeeffective interest method, less provision for
impairment. A provision for impairment of
trade and other receivables is established
based on an expected credit loss model
applying the simplified approach, which
uses a lifetime expected loss allowance for
all trade and other receivables. The amount
of the loss is recognised separately in
the consolidated income statement.
Current trade and other receivables do not
carry any interest and are stated at their
amortised cost, as reduced by appropriate
allowances for estimated irrecoverable
amounts. Non-current trade and other
receivables are discounted to present value
when the impact of discounting is deemed
to be material, with any discount to nominal
value being recognised in the consolidated
income statement as interest income over the
duration of the deferred payment.
Contract assets
Contract assets represent unbilled work-
in-progress on aordable and on affordable and other sales
in bulk on contracts in which revenue is
recognised over time. Contract assets
are recognised initially at fair value and
subsequently measured at amortised cost,
using the eece effective interest method, less
provision for impairment. Contract assets
do not carry any interest and are stated
at their amortised cost, as reduced by
appropriate allowances for estimated
irrecoverable amounts.
Cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents are cash balances
in hand and in the bank and are carried in the
consolidated statement of financial position
at nominal value.
Interest-bearing loans and
borrowings
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
are recognised initially at fair value, net of
direct transaction costs, and subsequently
measured at amortised cost. Finance charges
are accounted for on an accruals basis in
the consolidated income statement using
the eece effective interest method and are added
to the carrying amount of the instrument to
the extent that they are not settled in the
period in which they arise or included within
interest accruals.
Financial liabilities
Financial liabilities are initially recognised at
fair value and subsequently classified into
one of the following measurement categories:
At amortised cost
Subsequently at FVTPL.
Non-derivative financial liabilities are
measured at FVTPL when they are
considered held for trading or designated as
such on initial recognition. The Group has no
non-derivative financial liabilities measured
at FVTPL.
Land payables
Land payables are recognised in the
consolidated statement of financial position
from the date of unconditional exchange
of contracts. Where land is purchased on
deferred settlement terms then the land and
the land payable are discounted to their fair
value using the eec effective interest method
in accordance with IFRS 9. The dieifference
between the fair value and the nominal value
is amortised over the deferment period, with
the financing element being charged as an
interest expense through the consolidated
income statement.
Trade and other payables
Trade and other payables are recognised
initially at their fair value and subsequently
measured at amortised cost using the
eeeffective interest method. Trade and other
payables on deferred terms are initially
recorded at their fair value, with the discount
to nominal value being charged to the
consolidated income statement as an
interest expense over the duration of the
deferred period.
Contract liabilities
Contract liabilities represent payments on
account, received from customers, in excess
of billable work-in-progress on aordable in-progress on affordable
and other sales in bulk on contracts.
Contract liabilities are recognised initially at
their fair value and subsequently measured
at amortised cost using the eece effective
interest method.
Provisions
A provision is recognised in the consolidated
statement of financial position when the
Group has a present legal or constructive
obligation as a result of a past event and
it is probable that an outflow of economic
benefits will be required to settle the
obligation, and the amount can be reliably
estimated. Provisions are discounted to
present value on a discounted cash flow
basis using an interest rate appropriate to
the class of the provision, where the eece effect
is material.
Seasonality
In common with the rest of the UK
housebuilding industry, activity occurs
throughout the year, with peaks in sales
completions in spring and autumn.
This creates seasonality in the Group’s
trading results and working capital.
2 Segmental reporting
The ELT (comprising Peter Truscott (Chief
Executive), Duncan Cooper (Group Finance
Director until 13 December 2023), Bill Floydd
(Group Finance Director from 13 November
2023) David Marchant (Group Operations
Director), Kieran Daya (Managing Director,
Crest Nicholson Partnerships and Strategic
Land until 31 December 2023 and Chief
Operating Oceg Officer from 1 January 2024), Jane
Cookson (Group HR Director), Kevin Maguire
(General Counsel and Company Secretary
until 18 August 2023), Heather O’Sullivan
(General Council from 25 September 2023),
Penny Thomas (Group Company Secretary
from 1 January 2024), Alex Stark (Executive
Managing Director until 8 August 2023)
and David Brown (Executive Managing
Director until 15 December 2023)), which
is accountable to the Board, has been
identified as the chief operating decision
maker for the purposes of determining
the Group’s operating segments. The ELT
approves investment decisions, allocates
group resources and performs divisional
performance reviews. The Group operating
segments are considered to be its divisions,
each of which has its own management
board. All divisions are engaged in
residential-led, mixed-use developments
in the United Kingdom and therefore with
consideration of relevant economic indicators
such as the nature of the products sold
and customer base, and, having regard
to the aggregation criteria in IFRS 8, the
Group identifies that it has one reportable
operating segment.
Crest Nicholson 121 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
3 Revenue
Revenue type
2023 2022
£m £m
Open market housing including specification upgrades
550.0
803.7
Aordable housingAffordable housing
88.0
76.9
Total housing
638.0
880.6
Land and commercial sales
19.5
32.0
Freehold reversions
1.0
Total revenue
657.5
913.6
2023 2022
£m £m
Timing of revenue recognition
Revenue recognised at a point in time
552.4
842.6
Revenue recognised over time
105.1
71.0
Total revenue
657.5
913.6
2023 2022
£m £m
Assets and liabilities related to contracts with customers
Contract assets (note 17)
6.9
25.1
Contract liabilities (note 21)
(6.0)
(19.3)
Contract assets have decreased to £6.9m from £25.1m in 2022, reflecting less unbilled work-in-progress on aordffordable and other sales in bulk
at the year end. This is in line with the trading of the Group and the contractual arrangements in the Group’s contracts. Contract liabilities
have reduced to £6.0m from £19.3m in 2022, reflecting a lower amount of payments on account received from customers in excess of billable
work-in-progress on aorn affordable and other sales in bulk on contracts on which revenue is recognised over time. This fall was driven primarily
by a reduction in a number of sites where revenue was recognised at a point in time in the current year but the Group had received progress
payments from the customer in the prior year.
Based on historical trends, the Directors expect a significant proportion of the contract liabilities total to be recognised as revenue in the next
reporting period.
Included in revenue during the year was £16.1m (2022: £19.6m) that was included in contract liabilities at the beginning of the year.
During the year £nil (2022: £nil) of revenue was recognised from performance obligations satisfied or partially satisfied in previous years.
As at 31 October 2023 there was £229.1m (2022: £322.4m) of transaction price allocated to performance obligations that are unsatisfied or
partially unsatisfied on contracts exchanged with customers. Forecasts recognise £114.3m (2022: £257.4m) of transaction prices allocated to
performance obligations that are unsatisfied on contracts exchanged with customers within one year, £112.0m (2022: £65.0m) within two to five
years, and £2.8m (2022: £nil) over five years.
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 122 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
4 Exceptional items
Exceptional items are those which, in the opinion of the Directors, are material by size and/or non-recurring in nature and therefore require
separate disclosure within the consolidated income statement in order to assist the users of the financial statements to better understand the
performance of the Group, which is also how the Directors internally manage the business. Where appropriate, the Directors consider that items
should be considered as categories or classes of items, such as any credits/costs impacting the consolidated income statement which relate to
combustible materials, notwithstanding where an item may be individually immaterial. Where appropriate, a material reversal of these amounts
will be reflected through exceptional items.
2023 2022
£m £m
Cost of sales
Combustible materials charge
(11.3)
(102.5)
Combustible materials credit
10.0
Net combustible materials charge
(1.3)
(102.5)
Legal provision
(13.0)
Total cost of sales charge
(14.3)
(102.5)
Net finance expense
Combustible materials imputed interest
(4.6)
(1.0)
Share of post-tax profit/(loss) of joint ventures
Combustible materials credit/(charge) of joint ventures
0.6
(1.5)
Total exceptional charge
(18.3)
(105.0)
Tax credit on exceptional charge
4.8
22.4
Total exceptional charge after tax credit
(13.5)
(82.6)
Net combustible materials charge
As a consequence of signing the Developer Remediation Contract on 13 March 2023, the Group has entered into contractual commitments
with the UK Government to identify and remediate those buildings it has developed with possible life-critical fire safety defects. The Group
is currently working on circa 90 buildings in various stages of design, procurement and works. The combustible materials charge represents
forecast changes in build costs and in the provision discount. The Group has recovered £10.0m cash from third parties in the year in respect of
defective design and workmanship. See note 22 for additional information.
Legal provision
The Group is subject to a legal claim relating to a low-rise bespoke apartment block built by the Group which was damaged by fire in 2021.
Due to the size and nature of the claim, and in line with the Group’s accounting policy, this has been presented as an exceptional item. See note
22 for additional information.
Net finance expense
The combustible materials imputed interest reflects the unwind of the imputed interest on the provision to reflect the time value of the liability.
Share of post-tax loss of joint ventures
The combustible materials credit/(charge) of joint ventures represents the Group’s share of exceptional combustibles materials credit/(charge) in
its joint venture Crest Nicholson Bioregional Quintain LLP. The joint venture recognised a provision in the prior year and the current year credit
represents a recovery from third parties, net of changes in build costs.
Taxation
An exceptional income tax credit of £4.8m (2022: £22.4m) has been recognised in relation to the above exceptional items using the actual tax
rate applicable to these items.
Crest Nicholson 123 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
5 Net administrative expenses and operating profit
Operating profit of £29.9m (2022: £38.4m) from continuing activities is stated after (charging)/crediting:
Note
2023 2022
£m £m
Inventories expensed in the year
(520.2)
(705.3)
Inventories impairment movement in the year
18
(7.6)
8.1
Employee costs
6
(60.7)
(58.4)
Depreciation on property, plant and equipment
12
(0.5)
(0.4)
Depreciation on right-of-use assets
13
(2.3)
(1.9)
Joint venture project management fees recognised in administrative expenses
27
1.9
2.0
Net administrative expenses
£m
£m
Administrative expenses
(55.0)
(51.1)
Other operating income
40.1
48.9
Other operating expenses
(40.9)
(47.4)
Net administrative expenses
(55.8)
Other operating income and other operating expenses shown above relate to the income and associated costs arising on the sale of part
exchange properties. For the year ended 31 October 2023, both the income and associated costs of these sales has been presented within net
administrative expenses in the consolidated income statement. Previously the income and associated costs arising on these sales was included
within cost of sales. The prior year has not been restated since the net result is immaterial to the Group and there is no change to the operating
profit realised in the year.
2023 2022
£000 £000
Auditors’ remuneration
Audit of these consolidated financial statements
166
137
Audit of financial statements of subsidiaries pursuant to legislation
819
783
Other non-audit services
154
95
The audit fees payable in 2022 included £30,000 in relation to additional costs for the 2021 audit.
Fees payable to the Group’s auditors for non-audit services included £100,000 (2022: £95,000) in respect of an independent review of the half-
year results and £54,000 for other non-audit assurance services for sustainability reporting.
In addition to the above, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP provide audit services to the Crest Nicholson Group Pension and Life Assurance
Scheme and Group joint ventures. The fees associated with the services to the Crest Nicholson Group Pension and Life Assurance Scheme are
£35,565 (2022: £25,400) and are met by the assets of the scheme, and the fees associated with services to Group joint ventures are £20,000
(2022: £22,000).
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 124 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
6 Employee numbers and costs
(a) Average monthly number of persons employed by the Group
2023 2022
Number Number
Development
778
727
The Directors consider all employees of the Group to be employed within the same category of Development.
(b) Employee costs (including Directors and key management)
2023 2022
£m £m
Wages and salaries
50.4
48.0
Social security costs
5.8
6.0
Other pension costs
3.0
2.5
Share-based payments (note 16)
1.5
1.9
60.7
58.4
(c) Key management remuneration
2023 2022
£m £m
Salaries and short-term employee benefits
3.5
4.0
Directors’ remuneration for loss of oce office
0.5
Share-based payments
0.6
1.0
4.1
5.5
Key management comprises the ELT (which includes the Executive Directors of the Board) and Non-Executive Directors as they are considered
to have the authority and responsibility for planning, directing and controlling the activities of the Group.
(d) Directors’ remuneration
2023 2022
£m £m
Salaries and short-term employee benefits
1.7
2.6
Directors’ remuneration for loss of oce office
0.5
Share-based payments
0.5
0.7
2.2
3.8
Further information relating to Directors’ remuneration, incentive plans, share options, pension entitlement and the highest paid Director,
appears in the Directors’ Remuneration Report, which is presented on pages 81–98.
7 Finance income and expense
2023 2022
£m £m
Finance income
Interest income
2.4
0.7
Interest on amounts due from joint ventures (note 27)
1.2
2.1
Net interest on defined benefit pension scheme (note 16)
0.5
0.3
4.1
3 .1
Finance expense
Interest on bank loans
(5.7)
(6.6)
Revolving credit facility issue costs
(0.6)
(0.7)
Imputed interest on deferred land payables
(3.1)
(2.8)
Interest on lease liabilities (note 13)
(0.2)
(0.1)
Imputed interest on combustible materials provision – exceptional (note 22)
(4.6)
(1.0)
(14.2)
(11.2)
Net finance expense
(10.1)
(8.1)
Crest Nicholson 125 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
8 Income tax expense
2023 2022
£m £m
Current tax
UK corporation tax expense on profit for the year
(4.2)
(6.1)
Adjustment in respect of prior periods
0.7
Total current tax expense
(3.5)
(6.1)
Deferred tax
Origination and reversal of temporary dierences inersal of temporary differences in the year
(1.7)
(0.3)
Total deferred tax charge (note 15)
(1.7)
(0.3)
Total income tax expense in consolidated income statement
(5.2)
(6.4)
Corporation tax is calculated at 22.5%, based on a tax rate of 19.0% up until 1 April 2023, and a tax rate of 25.0% from 1 April 2023 (2022: 19.0%),
of the profit chargeable to tax for the year. From 1 April 2022 the Group is subject to the RPDT at an additional rate of 4.0%. This results in a
weighted statutory rate of corporation tax of 26.5% (2022: 21.3%) for the year. The eecffective tax rate for the year is 22.5% (2022: 19.5%), which
is lower than (2022: lower than) the weighted standard rate of UK corporation tax due to the impact of a prior year adjustment, enhanced tax
deductions and the RPDT annual allowance. The Group expects the eecffective tax rate to be more aligned to the standard rate of corporation tax
in future years as deferred tax on temporary dierifferences unwinds.
2023 2022
£m £m
Reconciliation of tax expense in the year
Profit before tax
23.1
32.8
Tax charge on profit at 26.5% (2022: 21.3%)
(6.1)
(7.0)
EecEffects of:
Expenses not deductible for tax purposes
(0.8)
(0.7)
Enhanced tax deductions
0.3
0.2
Adjustment in respect of prior periods
0.7
EeEffect of change in rate of tax
0.6
Impact of RPDT annual allowance and adjustments
0.7
0.5
Total income tax expense in consolidated income statement
(5.2)
(6.4)
RPDT came into force in April 2022 and is therefore applicable to relevant profits for the full financial year. RPDT is an additional tax on profits
generated from residential property development activity, in excess of an annual threshold and adjusting for amounts disallowable under
RPDT, such as interest expense. The impact of RPDT annual allowance and adjustments reflects the net tax benefit of the annual threshold and
interest adjustment.
Expenses not deductible for tax purposes include business entertaining and other permanent disallowable expenses. Enhanced tax deductions
include items for which, under tax law, a corporation tax deduction is available in excess of the amount shown in the consolidated income
statement. For example, land remediation enhanced allowances.
Adjustment in respect of prior periods reflect the diee difference between the estimated consolidated income statement tax charge in the prior year
and that of the actual tax outcome.
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 126 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
9 Dividends
2023 2022
£m £m
Dividends recognised as distributions to equity shareholders in the year:
Current year interim dividend of 5. 5 pence per share (2022: 5 .5 pence per share)
14.1
14.1
Prior year final dividend per share of 11.5 pence per share (2022: 9.5 pence per share)
29.5
24.4
43.6
38.5
2023 2022
£m £m
Dividends proposed as distributions to equity shareholders in the year:
Final dividend for the year ended 31 October 2023 of 11 .5 pence per share (2022: 11 .5 pence per share)
29.5
29.5
The proposed final dividend was approved by the Board on 23 January 2024 and, in accordance with IAS 10: Events after the Reporting Period,
has not been included as a liability in this financial year. The final dividend will be paid on 23 April 2024 to all ordinary shareholders on the
Register of Members on 22 March 2024.
10 Earnings per ordinary share
Basic earnings per share is calculated by dividing profit attributable to equity shareholders by the weighted average number of ordinary shares
in issue during the year. For diluted earnings per share, the weighted average number of shares is increased by the average number of potential
ordinary shares held under option during the year. This reflects the number of ordinary shares which would be purchased using the dier purchased using the difference
in value between the market value of shares and the share option exercise price. The market value of shares has been calculated using the
average ordinary share price during the year. Only share options which have met their cumulative performance criteria have been included in
the dilution calculation. The earnings and weighted average number of shares used in the calculations are set out below.
Weighted
average
number of Per share
Earnings ordinary shares amount
£m Number Pence
Year ended 31 October 2023
Basic earnings per share
17.9
256,131,621
7.0
Dilutive eive effect of share options
594,762
Diluted earnings per share
17.9
256,726,383
7.0
Year ended 31 October 2023 – Pre-exceptional items
Adjusted basic earnings per share
31.4
256,131,621
12.3
Dilutive eive effect of share options
594,762
Adjusted diluted earnings per share
31.4
256,726,383
12.2
Year ended 31 October 2022
Basic earnings per share
26.4
256,405,006
10.3
Dilutive eive effect of share options
1,320,375
Diluted earnings per share
26.4
257,725,381
10.2
Year ended 31 October 2022 – Pre-exceptional items
Adjusted basic earnings per share
109.0
256,405,006
42.5
Dilutive eive effect of share options
1,320,375
Adjusted diluted earnings per share
109.0
257,725,381
42.3
Crest Nicholson 127 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
11 Intangible assets
Goodwill
2023 2022
£m £m
Cost at beginning and end of the year
47.7
47.7
Accumulated impairment
(18.7)
(18.7)
At beginning and end of the year
29.0
29.0
Goodwill arose on the acquisition of CN Finance plc (formerly Castle Bidco plc) on 24 March 2009. The goodwill relating to items other than the
holding of strategic land was fully impaired in prior periods. The remaining goodwill was allocated to acquired strategic land holdings (the cash-
generating unit) within the Group and has not previously been impaired. The goodwill is assessed for impairment annually. The recoverable
amount is equal to the higher of value in use and fair value less costs of disposal. The Directors have therefore assessed value in use, being the
present value of the forecast cash flows from the expected development and sale of properties on the strategic land. These cash flows are the
key estimates in the value in use assessment. The forecast looks at the likelihood and scale of permitted development, forecast build costs and
forecast selling prices, using a pre-tax discount rate of 9.5% (2022: 8.5%), covering a further period of 14 years to 2038, and based on current
market conditions. The discount rate is based on an externally produced weighted average cost of capital range estimate. For 2023 9.5%
(2022: 8.5%) falls within the range. The FHS will not impact the estimated development cash flows as sites in production already incorporate the
forecast extra costs, and for those under option the extra costs will be adjusted in the land values payable. The period used in this assessment
represents the estimated time it will take to obtain planning and build out on the remaining acquired strategic land holdings. The recoverable
value of the cash generating unit is substantially in excess of the carrying value of goodwill. Sensitivity analysis has been undertaken by
changing the discount rates by plus or minus 1.0% and the forecast profit margins applicable to the site within the cash generating unit. None of
the sensitivities, either individually or in aggregate, resulted in the fair value of the goodwill being reduced to below its current book value
amount. As the forecast covers the entire life of the cash generating unit no growth rate has been used to extrapolate the cash flow projection,
and as such the rate is not disclosed.
12 Property, plant and equipment
Computer
Fixtures and equipment and
fittings software Total
£m £m £m
Cost
At 1 November 2021
1.8
3.2
5.0
Additions
0.1
0.1
Disposals
(0.1)
(0.4)
(0.5)
At 31 October 2022
1.7
2.9
4.6
Additions
1.8
1.8
Disposals
(0.7)
(0.7)
At 31 October 2023
3.5
2.2
5.7
Accumulated depreciation
At 1 November 2021
1.0
2.8
3.8
Charge for the year
0.2
0.2
0.4
Disposals
(0.1)
(0.4)
(0.5)
At 31 October 2022
1.1
2.6
3.7
Charge for the year
0.3
0.2
0.5
Disposals
(0.7)
(0.7)
At 31 October 2023
1.4
2.1
3.5
Net book value
At 31 October 2023
2.1
0.1
2.2
At 31 October 2022
0.6
0.3
0.9
At 1 November 2021
0.8
0.4
1.2
The Group has contractual commitments for the acquisition of property, plant and equipment of £nil (2022: £nil).
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 128 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
13 Right-of-use assets and liabilities
Oce buildingsOffice buildings Motor vehicles Total
£m £m £m
Cost
At 1 November 2021
13.1
4.2
17.3
Additions
1.3
1.3
Disposals
(1.0)
(1.0)
At 31 October 2022
13.1
4.5
17.6
Additions
2.8
1.9
4.7
Disposals
(7.3)
(1.6)
(8.9)
At 31 October 2023
8.6
4.8
13.4
Accumulated depreciation
At 1 November 2021
10.7
2.9
13.6
Charge for the year
1.0
0.9
1.9
Disposals
(1.0)
(1.0)
Reclassification
(0.6)
(0.6)
At 31 October 2022
11.1
2.8
13.9
Charge for the year
1.3
1.0
2.3
Disposals
(7.3)
(1.6)
(8.9)
At 31 October 2023
5.1
2.2
7. 3
Net book value
At 31 October 2023
3.5
2.6
6.1
At 31 October 2022
2.0
1.7
3.7
At 1 November 2021
2.4
1.3
3.7
2023 2022
£m £m
Lease liabilities included in the consolidated statement of financial position
Non-current
4.4
2.3
Current
2.0
1.6
Total lease liabilities
6.4
3.9
2023 2022
£m £m
Amounts recognised in the consolidated income statement
Depreciation on right-of-use assets
2.3
1.9
Interest on lease liabilities
0.2
0.1
2023 2022
£m £m
Amounts recognised in the consolidated cash flow statement
Principal element of lease payments
2.4
2.1
2023 2022
£m £m
Maturity of undiscounted contracted lease cash flows
Less than one year
2.2
1.7
One to five years
3.2
2.4
More than five years
1.6
Total
7.0
4 .1
Crest Nicholson 129 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
14 Investments
Investments in joint ventures
Below are the joint ventures that the Directors consider to be material to the Group:
Crest A2D (Walton Court) LLP: In January 2016 the Group entered into a partnership agreement with A2 Dominion Developments Limited to
procure and develop a site in Surrey. The LLP commenced construction in 2019, with sales completion forecast for 2025. The development
will be equally funded by both parties by way of interest free loans. The Group performs the role of project manager, for which it receives a
project management fee
Elmsbrook (Crest A2D) LLP: In July 2017 the Group entered into a partnership agreement with A2 Dominion Developments Limited to procure
and develop a site in Oxfordshire. The LLP commenced construction in 2018, with sales completion forecast for 2024. The development
will be equally funded by both parties by way of interest free loans. The Group performs the role of project manager, for which it receives a
project management fee
Crest Sovereign (Brooklands) LLP: In April 2019 the Group entered into a partnership agreement with Sovereign Housing Association Limited
to develop a site in Bristol. The LLP commenced construction in 2019, with sales completion forecast for 2027. The LLP will be equally funded
by both parties, who will receive interest on loaned sums. The Group performs the role of project manager, for which it receives a project
management fee
Crest Peabody (Turweston) LLP: In September 2023 the Group entered into a partnership agreement with the Peabody Trust to develop a
site in Buckinghamshire. The LLP is expecting to commence construction in 2024, with sales completion forecast for 2029. The development
will be equally funded by both parties by way of interest free loans. The Group performs the role of project manager, for which it will receive a
project management fee and a sales and marketing fee.
2023 2022
£m £m
Total investments in joint ventures
Crest A2D (Walton Court) LLP
2.3
3.4
Elmsbrook (Crest A2D) LLP
3.5
3.3
Crest Sovereign (Brooklands) LLP
4.9
2.3
Crest Peabody (Turweston) LLP
Other non-material joint ventures
Total investments in joint ventures
10.7
9.0
All material joint ventures have their place of business in Great Britain, are 50% owned and are accounted for using the equity method, in line
with the prior year. See note 28 for further details.
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 130 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Summarised financial information for joint ventures
The tables below provide financial information for joint ventures that are material to the Group. The information disclosed reflects the
amounts presented in the financial statements of the relevant joint ventures, where the Group retains an interest, and not the Group’s share of
those amounts.
Crest Crest
Crest A2D Elmsbrook Sovereign Peabody Other non-
(Walton Court) (Crest A2D) (Brooklands) (Turweston) material joint
LLP LLP LLP LLP ventures Total
2023 £m £m £m £m £m £m
Summarised statement of financial
position
Current assets
Cash and cash equivalents
0.2
6.0
0.4
0.2
6.8
Inventories
64.8
4.6
16.7
86.1
Other current assets
0.2
1.0
1.9
5.3
2.0
10.4
Current liabilities
Financial liabilities
(52.0)
(1.4)
(1.1)
(0.3)
(54.8)
Other current liabilities
(5.7)
(3.3)
(8.1)
(5.0)
(3.9)
(26.0)
Non-current liabilities
Financial liabilities
(3.0)
(3.0)
Net assets/(liabilities)
4.5
6.9
9.8
(1.7)
19.5
Reconciliation to carrying amounts
Opening net assets/(liabilities) at 1 November 2022
6.7
6.5
4.6
(2.9)
14.9
(Loss)/profit for the year
(3.2)
3.4
5.2
1.2
6.6
Capital contribution reserve
1.0
1.0
Dividends paid
(3.0)
(3.0)
Closing net assets/(liabilities) at 31 October 2023
4.5
6.9
9.8
(1.7)
19.5
Group’s share of closing net assets/(liabilities) at
31 October 2023
2.3
3.5
4.9
(0.9)
9.8
Fully provided in the Group financial statements
(note 22)
0.9
0.9
Group’s share in joint venture
2.3
3.5
4.9
10.7
Amount due to the Group (note 17)
27.4
1.4
0.4
0.3
29.5
Amount due from the Group (note 21)
0.7
0.7
Summarised income statement
for the1for the 12 months ending
31Oc31 October20r 2023
Revenue
0.9
21.1
47.2
69.2
Expenditure
(2.6)
(17.7)
(41.1)
(61.4)
Expenditure – exceptional item (note 4)
1.2
1.2
Operating (loss)/profit before finance expense
(1.7)
3.4
6.1
1.2
9.0
Finance expense
(1.5)
(0.9)
(2.4)
Pre-tax and post-tax (loss)/profit for the year
(3.2)
3.4
5.2
1.2
6.6
Group’s share in joint venture (loss)/profit for
the year
(1.6)
1.7
2.6
0.6
3.3
1
1 £27.4m stated after expected credit loss of £0.1m.
Crest Nicholson 131 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
The Group is committed to provide such funding to joint ventures as may be required by the joint venture in order to carry out the project if
called. Funding of this nature is currently expected to be £5.9m (2022: £1.2m). The Group has recognised its share of the accumulated losses of
its joint ventures against the carrying value of investments or loans in the joint venture where appropriate, in line with IAS 28.
Crest
Crest A2D Elmsbrook Sovereign Other non-
Bonner Road (Walton Court) (Crest A2D) (Brooklands) material joint
LLP
1
LLP LLP LLP ventures Total
2022 £m £m £m £m £m £m
Summarised statement of financial position
Current assets
Cash and cash equivalents
0.1
1.6
0.3
0.2
2.2
Inventories
40.4
7.8
28.8
77.0
Other current assets
0.1
0.1
2.3
0.2
2.7
Current liabilities
Financial liabilities
(0.6)
(1.0)
(1.6)
Other current liabilities
(1.4)
(3.0)
(6.9)
(3.3)
(14.6)
Non-current liabilities
Financial liabilities
(31.9)
(18.9)
(50.8)
Net assets/(liabilities)
6.7
6.5
4.6
(2.9)
14.9
Reconciliation to carrying amounts
Opening net (liabilities)/assets at 1 November 2021
(13.7)
4.3
8.9
(1.0)
0.2
(1.3)
(Loss)/profit for the year
(1.2)
1.2
2.4
5.6
(3.1)
4.9
Capital contribution reserve
1.2
1.2
Dividends paid
(4.8)
(4.8)
Disposal in the year
14.9*
14.9
Closing net assets/(liabilities) at 31 October 2022
6.7
6.5
4.6
(2.9)
14.9
Group’s share of closing net assets/(liabilities)
at3at 31Oc1 October 2022
3.4
3.3
2.3
(1.4)
7.6
Losses recognised against receivable from joint
venture (note 17)
0.2
0.2
Fully provided in the Group financial statements
(note 22)
1.2
1.2
Group’s share in joint venture
3.4
3.3
2.3
9.0
Amount due to the Group (note 17)
15.9
0.8
10.4
27.1
Amount due from the Group (note 21)
0.1
0.1
Summarised income statement for the
12months ending 31 October 2022
Revenue
26.0
11.0
47.4
84.4
Expenditure
(23.6)
(8.6)
(39.9)
(0.1)
(72.2)
Expenditure – exceptional item (note 4)
(3.0)
(3.0)
Operating profit/(loss) before finance expense
2.4
2.4
7.5
(3.1)
9.2
Finance expense
(1.2)
(1.2)
(1.9)
(4.3)
Pre-tax and post-tax (loss)/profit for the year
(1.2)
1.2
2.4
5.6
(3.1)
4.9
Group’s share in joint venture (loss)/profit
fortfor theyearhe year
(0.6)
0.6
1.2
2.8
(1.5)
2.5
2
1 Group’s share of the net liabilities comprises £7.5m made up of brought forward net liabilities of £6.9m and current year loss of £0.6m. Bonner Road LLP was disposed of on 6 May 2022.
2 £15.9m stated after expected credit loss of £0.1m.
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 132 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Subsidiary undertakings
The subsidiary undertakings that are significant to the Group and traded during the year are set out below. The Group’s interest is in respect of
ordinary issued share capital that is wholly owned and all the subsidiary undertakings are incorporated in Great Britain and are included in the
consolidated financial statements.
Subsidiary Nature of business
CN Finance plc Holding company (including group financing)
Crest Nicholson plc Holding company
Crest Nicholson Operations Limited Residential and commercial property development
A full list of the Group’s undertakings including subsidiaries and joint ventures is set out in note 28.
15 Deferred tax assets and liabilities
Other
Inventories Share-based temporary
fair value payments dierencesdifferences Total
Deferred tax assets £m £m £m £m
At 1 November 2021
1.5
0.4
2.9
4.8
Consolidated income statement movements
0.5
(0.1)
0.4
Equity movements
(0.4)
(0.4)
At 31 October 2022
1.5
0.5
2.8
4.8
Consolidated income statement movements
(0.4)
(0.1)
(0.8)
(1.3)
Equity movements
(0.2)
(0.2)
At 31 October 2023
1.1
0.2
2.0
3.3
Pension
surplus Total
Deferred tax liabilities £m £m
At 1 November 2021
(4.1)
(4.1)
Consolidated income statement movements
(0.7)
(0.7)
Equity movements
1.6
1.6
At 31 October 2022
(3.2)
(3.2)
Consolidated income statement movements
(0.4)
(0.4)
Equity movements
1.1
1.1
At 31 October 2023
(2.5)
(2.5)
Total deferred tax credited to equity in the year is £0.9m (2022: £1.2m). Deferred tax assets expected to be recovered in less than 12 months
is £1.0m (2022: £1.5m), and in more than 12 months is £2.3m (2022: £3.3m). Deferred tax liabilities are expected to be settled in more than
12 months.
At the consolidated statement of financial position date the substantively enacted future corporation tax rate is 25.0% (as from 1 April 2023).
RPDT became eeme effective from 1 April 2022 and is an additional tax at 4.0% of profits generated from residential property development activity, in
excess of an annual threshold. Deferred tax assets and liabilities have been evaluated using the applicable tax rates when the asset is forecast
to be realised and the liability is forecast to be settled. The Group has no material unrecognised deferred tax assets.
Inventories fair value represents temporary diey differences on the carrying value of inventory fair valued on the acquisition of CN Finance plc in
2009. These temporary dierifferences are expected to be recoverable in full as it is considered probable that taxable profits will be available
against which the deductible temporary diey differences can be utilised, and are therefore recognised as deferred tax assets in the above amounts.
Crest Nicholson 133 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
16 Employee benefits
(a) Retirement benefit obligations
Defined contribution scheme
The Group operates a defined contribution scheme for new employees. The assets of the scheme are held separately from those of the Group
in an independently administered fund. The contributions to this scheme for the year were £2.8m (2022: £2.3m). At the consolidated statement
of financial position date there were no outstanding or prepaid contributions (2022: £nil).
Defined benefit scheme
The Company sponsors the Crest Nicholson Group Pension and Life Assurance Scheme (Scheme), a funded defined benefit pension scheme
in the UK. The Scheme is administered within a trust that is legally separate from the Company. A Trustee company (Trustee) is appointed by
the Company and the Company and the Scheme’s members appoint Trustee Directors. The Trustee is appointed to act in the interest of the
Scheme and all relevant stakeholders, including the members and the Company. The Trustee is also responsible for the investment of the
Scheme’s assets.
The Scheme closed to future accrual from 30 April 2010. Accrued pensions in relation to deferred members are revalued at statutory revaluation
in the period before retirement. Benefits also increase either at a fixed rate or in line with inflation while in payment. The Scheme provides
pensions to members on retirement and to their dependants on death.
The Company pays contributions to improve the Scheme’s funding position as determined by regular actuarial valuations. The Trustee
is required to use prudent assumptions to value the liabilities and costs of the Scheme whereas the accounting assumptions must be
best estimates.
Responsibility for meeting any deficit within the Scheme lies with the Company and this introduces a number of risks for the Company.
The major risks are: interest rate risk, inflation risk, investment risk and longevity risk. The Company and Trustee are aware of these risks and
manage them through appropriate investment and funding strategies.
The Scheme is subject to regular actuarial valuations, which are usually carried out every three years. The last actuarial valuation was carried
out with an eeh an effective date of 31 January 2021. These actuarial valuations are carried out in accordance with the requirements of the Pensions
Act 2004 and so include deliberate margins for prudence. This contrasts with these accounting disclosures, which are determined using best
estimate assumptions.
The results of the actuarial valuation as at 31 January 2021 have been projected to 31 October 2023 by a qualified independent actuary.
The figures in the following disclosure were measured using the Projected Unit Method.
The investment strategy in place for the Scheme is to invest in a mix of return seeking, index linked and fixed interest investments. As at
31 October 2023 the allocation of the Scheme’s invested assets was 18% in return seeking investments, 40% in liability-driven investing, 40% in
cash and 2% in insured annuities. Details of the investment strategy can be found in the Scheme’s Statement of Investment Principles, which the
Trustee updates as their policy evolves.
It should also be noted that liabilities relating to insured members of the Scheme have been included as both an asset and a liability.
Following the High Court judgement in the Lloyds Banking Group Pensions Trustees Limited v Lloyds Bank plc and others (2018) case,
overall pension benefits now need to be equalised to eliminate inequalities between males and females in Guaranteed Minimum Pensions
(GMP). The Company has allowed for this in its accounts by adding a 1.3% (2022: 1.3%) reserve reflecting an approximate estimate of the
additional liability.
2023 2022 2021
£m £m £m
The amounts recognised in the consolidated statement of financial position
are as follows:
Fair value of scheme assets
141.3
160.0
241.9
Present value of scheme liabilities
(131.3)
(148.9)
(225.2)
Net surplus amount recognised at year end
10.0
11.1
16.7
Deferred tax liability recognised at year end within non-current liabilities
(2.5)
(3.2)
(4.1)
The retirement benefit surplus recognised in the consolidated statement of financial position represents the surplus of the fair value of the
Scheme’s assets over the present value of the Scheme’s liabilities.
The rules of the Scheme provide the Group with an unconditional right to a refund of surplus assets on the gradual settlement of the Scheme’s
liabilities. In the ordinary course of business the Scheme Trustee has no unilateral right to wind the Scheme up. Based on these rights and in
accordance with IFRIC 14, the Group has made the judgement that the net surplus in the Scheme is recognised in full.
At the consolidated statement of financial position date the corporation tax rate is 25.0%. The deferred tax liability on the retirement benefit
surplus has been evaluated applying this rate. RPDT of 4.0% is applicable to residential property development trading income only.
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 134 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Amounts recognised in comprehensive income:
The current and past service costs, settlements and curtailments, together with the interest income for the year are included in the consolidated
statement of comprehensive income. Remeasurements of the net defined benefit asset are included in the consolidated statement of
comprehensive income.
2023 2022
£m £m
Service cost
Administrative expenses
(0.6)
(0.9)
Interest income
0.5
0.3
Recognised in the consolidated income statement
(0.1)
(0.6)
2023 2022
£m £m
Remeasurements of the net liability
Return on Scheme assets
(18.5)
(82.6)
Gains arising from changes in financial assumptions
12.5
79.8
Gains/(losses) arising from changes in demographic assumptions
6.1
(0.1)
Experience losses
(2.6)
(5.5)
Actuarial losses recorded in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income
(2.5)
(8.4)
Total defined benefit scheme losses
(2.6)
(9.0)
2023 2022
% %
The principal actuarial assumptions used were:
Liability discount rate
5.6
4.8
Inflation assumption – RPI
3.3
3.2
Inflation assumption – CPI
2.7
2.6
Revaluation of deferred pensions
2.7
2.6
Increases for pensions in payment
Benefits accrued in excess of GMP pre-1997
3.0
3.0
Benefits accrued post-1997
3.1
3.0
Proportion of employees opting for early retirement
0.0
0.0
Proportion of employees commuting pension for cash
100.0
100.0
Mortality assumption – pre-retirement
AC00
AC00
Mortality assumption – male and female post-retirement
S3PA light base tables
(males and females) projected S3PA light base tables
in line with CMI_2022 projected in line with
core model with core CMI_2021
parameters (Sk = core model with core
7.0, an initial addition of parameters (Sk =
0.25%, w2020 7.0, an initial addition of
and w2021 set to zero 0.25%, w2020
and 2022 set to 25%) and and w2021 set to zero) and
with a long-term rate of with a long-term rate of
improvement of 1.25% p.a improvement of 1.25% p.a
Crest Nicholson 135 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
2023 2022
Years Years
Future expected lifetime of current pensioner at age 65
Male aged 65 at year end
22.9
23.4
Female aged 65 at year end
24.6
25.0
Future expected lifetime of future pensioner at age 65
Male aged 45 at year end
24.1
24.6
Female aged 45 at year end
25.9
26.3
2023 2022
£m £m
Changes in the present value of assets over the year
Fair value of assets at beginning of the year
160.0
241.9
Interest income
7.5
4.1
Return on assets (excluding amount included in net interest income)
(18.5)
(82.6)
Contributions from the employer
1.5
3.4
Benefits paid
(8.6)
(5.9)
Administrative expenses
(0.6)
(0.9)
Fair value of assets at end of the year
141.3
160.0
Actual return on assets over the year
(10.9)
(78.5)
2023 2022
£m £m
Changes in the present value of liabilities over the year
Liabilities at beginning of the year
(148.9)
(225.2)
Interest cost
(7.0)
(3.8)
Remeasurement gains/(losses)
Gains arising from changes in financial assumptions
12.5
79.8
Gains/(losses) arising from changes in demographic assumptions
6.1
(0.1)
Experience losses
(2.6)
(5.5)
Benefits paid
8.6
5.9
Liabilities at end of the year
(131.3)
(148.9)
2023 2022
£m £m
Split of the Schemes liabilities by category of membership
Deferred pensioners
(57.8)
(71.5)
Pensions in payment
(73.5)
(77.4)
(131.3)
(148.9)
2023 2022
Years Years
Average duration of the Scheme’s liabilities at end of the year
12.0
14.0
This can be subdivided as follows:
Deferred pensioners
16.0
18.0
Pensions in payment
9.0
10.0
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 136 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
2023 2022
£m £m
Major categories of scheme assets
Return seeking
Overseas equities
2.4
2.3
Other (hedge funds, multi asset strategy and absolute return funds)
23.6
55.9
26.0
58.2
Debt instruments
Corporates
11.8
Liability-driven investing
44.1
71.6
55.9
71.6
Other
Cash
55.9
25.9
Insured annuities
3.5
4.3
59.4
30.2
Total market value of assets
141.3
160.0
The Scheme has implemented a Liability driven investment (LDI) strategy designed to closely align investment returns with movements in the
Scheme’s liabilities on a low-risk basis, thereby reducing the volatility of the Scheme’s funding level. The use of LDI brings liquidity risk as the
demand for additional collateral to maintain the Scheme’s hedging can change over short periods when interest rates change. In consultation
with the Company, during the 2022 gilts crisis the Scheme continued to follow their LDI strategy, maintaining their interest rate and inflation
hedging during the period of significant market volatility. Following the 2022 gilts crisis, the Trustee worked with its investment advisor (and in
consultation with the Company) to review the investment strategy in April 2023. As a result, LCP (the Trustee’s investment advisor) estimate that
as at 30 September 2023 the Scheme has sus sufficient liquidity in the LDI portfolio (and Liquidity Plus Fund alongside) to withstand a greater than
4% p.a. increase in yields (from already historic highs) across the curve (assuming no accompanying fall in the value of collateral) before other
assets would need to be sold to maintain the Scheme’s hedge.
£nil (2022: £nil) of Scheme assets have a quoted market price in active markets, £90.9m (2022: £106.2m) of Scheme assets have valuation
inputs other than quoted market prices, including quoted market prices for similar assets in active markets, £21.4m (2022: £42.4m) of Scheme
assets are instruments that are valued based on quoted prices for similar instruments but for which significant unobservable adjustments or
assumptions are required to reflect the dieifferences between the instruments, and £29.0m (2022: £11.4m) of Scheme assets are cash and insured
pension annuities.
The Scheme has no investments in the Group or in property occupied by the Group.
The Scheme had a deficit as at the latest valuation date of 31 January 2021, with a recovery plan agreed between the Group and the Trustee.
The Scheme was in surplus on the Technical Provisions basis, and so no further contributions were payable in respect of the shortfall in
funding in accordance with the Recovery Plan dated 8 February 2022. In order to continue to move the Scheme towards the Trustee’s
secondary funding objective, the Trustee and the Group have agreed that the Company will fund the Scheme with contributions of £1.5m per
annum, payable monthly until 30 April 2025. When the Scheme is at least 95% funded on the Secondary Funding Basis for a period of three
consecutive months then the Group has the option to pay any remaining contributions to an escrow account. The Group expects to contribute
£1.5m to scheme funding in the year ending 31 October 2024.
Sensitivity of the liability value to changes in the principal assumptions
The sensitivities included are consistent with those shown in prior years and show the change in the consolidated statement of financial
position as at 31 October 2023 as a result of a change to the key assumptions.
If the discount rate was 0.25% higher/(lower), the Scheme liabilities would decrease by £3.8m/(increase by £3.9m) if all the other assumptions
remained unchanged.
If the inflation assumption was 0.25% higher/(lower), the Scheme liabilities would increase by £2.3m/(decrease by £2.4m) if all the other
assumptions remained unchanged.
If life expectancies were to increase by one year, the scheme liabilities would increase by £4.7m if all the other assumptions
remained unchanged.
Crest Nicholson 137 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
(b) Share-based payments
The Group operates a Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP), save as you earn (SAYE) and a deferred bonus plan.
Long-Term Incentive Plan
The Group’s LTIP is open to the Executive Directors and senior management with awards being made at the discretion of the Remuneration
Committee. Options granted under the plan are exercisable between three and 10 years after the date of grant. Awards may be satisfied by
shares held in the ESOT, the issue of new shares (directly or to the ESOT) or the acquisition of shares in the market. Awards made prior to
31 October 2020 vest over three years and are subject to three years’ service, and return on capital and profit performance conditions.
Awards issued between 2021 and 2023 are subject to three years’ service and assessed against return on capital, profit performance conditions
and relative total shareholder returns (TSR). The non-market based return on capital and profit performance conditions applies to 60% of the
award and value the options using a binomial option valuation model. The market-based TSR performance conditions apply to 40% of the award
and values the options using the Monte Carlo valuation model. The TSR-based performance conditions are split one-third FTSE 250 excluding
investment funds and two-thirds sector peer group. 1,320,566 of the options awarded in 2023 (961,765 of the 2022 award) are subject to an
additional post-vesting holding period, where shares cannot be sold for two years after vesting date.
The 2021 fair value at measurement date of the dierenfferent valuation elements are £2.25 TSR (FTSE 250), £1.85 TSR (peer group), and £2.84
for the non-market-based return on capital and profit performance conditions. The correlation of FTSE 250 and peer group calculated for
each individual comparator company relative to the Group is 30% and 67% respectively. The average fair value at measurement date is £2.50
per option.
The 28 January 2022 grant fair value at measurement date of the dierenfferent valuation elements of the unrestricted options are £1.68 TSR (FTSE
250), £1.55 TSR (peer group), and £2.62 for the non-market-based return on capital and profit performance conditions. The 2023 fair value at
measurement date of the dierefferent valuation elements of the restricted options are £1.51 TSR (FTSE 250), £1.40 TSR (peer group), and £2.36 for
the non-market-based return on capital and profit performance conditions. The correlation of FTSE 250 and peer group calculated for each
individual comparator company relative to the Group is 31% and 68% respectively. The average fair value at measurement date is £2.10 per
option. The average fair value at measurement date of the 25 August 2023 grant is £1.59 per option.
The 27 January 2023 grant fair value at measurement date of the dierentf the different valuation elements of the unrestricted options are £1.84 TSR (FTSE
250), £1.68 TSR (peer group), and £2.45 for the non-market-based return on capital and tCO
2
elements. The 2023 fair value at measurement
date of the dieifferent valuation elements of the restricted options are £1.58 TSR (FTSE 250), £1.44 TSR (peer group), and £2.10 for the non-
market-based return on capital and profit performance conditions. The correlation of FTSE 250 and peer group calculated for each individual
comparator company relative to the Group is 33% and 65% respectively. The average fair value at measurement date is £1.88 per option.
26 Feb 16 Apr 21 Jun 20 Feb 04 Aug 08 Feb 28 Jan 25 Aug 06 Mar 07 Aug 27 Jan
Date of grant 2016 2019 2019 2020 2020 2021 2022 2022 2023 2023 2023
Options
granted
1,075,943
1,140,962
278,558
1,125,531
7,298
1,328,192
1,341,918
23,955
29,462
508
1,771,417
Fair value at
measurement
date
£5.07
£3.15
£3.15
£4.28
£1.53
£2.50
£2.10
£1.59
£2.75
£2.46
£1.88
Share price
on date of
grant
£5.62
£4.00
£3.55
£5.16
£1.85
£3.23
£3.07
£2.33
£2.32
£2.14
£2.45
Exercise
price
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
Vesting
period
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
Expected
dividend
yield
3.50%
8.20%
8.20%
6.40%
6.40%
4.30%
5.30%
5.30%
N/A
N/A
0.0%
Expected
volatility
30.0%
35.0%
35.0%
30.0%
30.0%
40.0%
40.0%
40.0%
N/A
N/A
45.0%
Risk-free
interest rate
0.43%
0.81%
0.81%
0.45%
0.45%
0.03%
0.97%
0.97%
N/A
N/A
3.23%
Binomial/ Binomial/ Binomial/ Binomial/
Valuation Monte Monte Monte Monte
model
Binomial
Binomial
Binomial
Binomial
Binomial
Carlo Carlo
Carlo
N/A
N/A
Carlo
Contractual
life from
Contractual
26.02.16
16.04.19
21.06.19
20.02.20
04.08.20
08.02.21
28.01.22
25.08.22
06.03.23
07.08.23
27.01.23
life to
25.02.26
15.04.29
20.06.29
19.02.30
03.08.30
07.02.31
27.02.32
27.02.32
19.02.30
03.08.30
26.01.33
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 138 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Total
Movements Number Number Number Number Number Number Number Number Number Number Number Number
in the year of options of options of options of options of options of options of options of options of options of options of options of options
Outstanding
at 1 November
2021
1,518
692,934
278,558
954,131
7,298
1,276,437
3,210,876
Granted
during the
year
1,341,918
23,955
1,365,873
Exercised
during the
year
(1,518)
(1,518)
Lapsed
during the
year
(692,934)
(278,558)
(62,161)
(78,761)
(29,443)
(1,141,857)
Outstanding
at 31
October
2022
891,970
7,298
1,197,676
1,312,475
23,955
3,433,374
Granted
during the
year
29,462
508
1,771,407
1,801,377
Exercised
during the
year
(417,308)
(3,948)
(29,462)
(508)
(451,226)
Lapsed
during the
year
(474,662)
(3,350)
(167,438)
(181,150)
(201,028)
(1,027,628)
Outstanding
at 31
October
2023
1,030,238
1,131,325
23,955
1,570,379
3,755,897
Exercisable
at 31
October
2023
Exercisable
at 31 October
2022
Total
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
Charge to
income for
the current
year
0.1
0.1
0.1
0.3
0.6
Charge to
income for
the prior year
1.1
(0.1)
0.2
1.2
The weighted average exercise price of LTIP options was £nil (2022: £nil).
Crest Nicholson 139 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Save As You Earn
Executive Directors and eligible employees are invited to make regular monthly contributions to a Sharesave scheme administered by EQ.
On completion of the three-year contract period employees are able to purchase ordinary shares in the Company based on the market price at
the date of invitation less a 20% discount. There are no performance conditions.
26 Jul 30 Jul 07 Aug 03 Aug 02 Aug 28 Jul
Date of grant 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022 2023
Options granted
712,944
935,208
1,624,259
256,132
975,549
1,938,156
Fair value at
measurement
date
£0.52
£0.54
£0.36
£1.15
£0.66
£1.51
Share price on
date of grant
£3.77
£3.68
£1.94
£4.14
£2.67
£2.19
Exercise price
£3.15
£2.86
£1.70
£3.42
£1.94
£1.51
Vesting period
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
Expected
dividend yield
8.76%
8.96%
5.20%
1.98%
5.63%
7.78%
Expected
volatility
35.00%
35.00%
40.00%
45.30%
42.20%
41.6%
Risk-free interest
rate
0.85%
0.38%
-0.08%
0.14%
1.62%
4.63%
Valuation model
Binomial
Binomial
Binomial
Binomial
Binomial
Binomial
Contractual life
from
01.09.18
01.09.19
01.09.20
01.09.21
01.09.22
01.09.23
Contractual life to
01.03.22
01.03.23
01.03.24
01.03.25
01.03.26
01.03.27
Total Weighted
Movements in the Number of Number of Number of Number of Number of Number of number of average
year options options options options options options options exercise price
Outstanding at
1 November 2021
40,842
147,357
1,124,088
244,294
1,556,581
£2.12
Granted during
the year
975,549
975,549
£1.94
Exercised during
the year
(8,854)
(5,764)
(14,618)
£2.58
Lapsed during
the year
(31,988)
(50,525)
(210,555)
(160,163)
(62,992)
(516,223)
£2.47
Outstanding at
31 October 2022
96,832
907,769
84,131
912,557
2,001,289
£1.94
Granted during
the year
1,938,156
1,938,156
£1.51
Exercised during
the year
(522,976)
(522,976)
£1.70
Lapsed during
the year
(96,832)
(61,983)
(41,201)
(486,485)
(158,774)
(845,275)
£2.02
Outstanding at
31 October 2023
322,810
42,930
426,072
1,779,382
2,571,194
£1.64
Exercisable at
31 October 2023
322,810
322,810
Exercisable at
31 October 2022
96,832
96,832
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
Total £m
Charge to
income for the
current year
0.1
0.3
0.1
0.5
Charge to income
for the prior year
0.1
0.1
0.1
0.3
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 140 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Deferred bonus plan
Under the terms of certain bonus schemes, some parts of bonus payments must be deferred into share options. The options carry no
performance criteria and vest over one or three years. Options granted under the plan are exercisable between one and 10 years after the date
of grant. Deferred bonus plan option numbers are based on the share price on the date of grant.
28 Feb 26 Feb 01 Mar 28 Jan 09 Feb 06 Mar 06 Mar 27 Jan
Date of grant 2020 2021 2022 2022 2022 2023 2023 2023
Options granted
20,956
34,800
251
230,605
58,848
151
2,897
340,125
Fair value at
measurement date
£4.52
£3.28
£4.06
£2.76
£2.76
£2.75
£2.53
£2.44
Share price on date of
grant
£4.52
£3.28
£2.70
£3.06
£3.27
£2.32
£2.32
£2.45
Exercise price
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
£0.00
Vesting period
3 years
1 year
N/A
3 years
1 year
N/A
N/A
3/1 year
Expected dividend yield
and volatility
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Risk-free interest rate
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Valuation model
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Contractual life from
28.02.20
26.02.21
02.03.22
28.01.22
09.02.22
06.03.23
06.03.23
27.01.23
Contractual life to
27.02.30
25.02.31
25.02.31
27.01.25
08.02.23
27.02.30
08.02.32
28.02.33
Total
Number of Number of Number of Number of Number of Number of Number of Number of number of
Movements in the year options options options options options options options options options
Outstanding at
1No1 November 2021
2,260
34,800
37,060
Granted during the year
251
230,605
58,848
289,704
Exercised during the
year
(24,985)
(251)
(25,236)
Lapsed during the year
(9,815)
(9,815)
Outstanding at
31O31 October 2022
2,260
230,605
58,848
291,713
Granted during the year
151
2,897
340,125
343,173
Exercised during the
year
(2,260)
(48,374)
(151)
(2,897)
(53,682)
Lapsed during the year
(10,474)
(21,108)
(31,582)
Outstanding at
31O31 October 2023
230,605
319,017
549,622
Exercisable at
31O31 October 2023
Exercisable at
31O31 October 2022
Total
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
Charge to income for
the current year
0.2
0.2
0.4
Charge to income for
the prior year
0.4
0.4
The weighted average exercise price of deferred bonus plan share options was £nil (2022: £nil).
Crest Nicholson 141 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Total share incentive schemes
2023
2022
Number of Number of
Movements in the year options options
Outstanding at beginning of the year
5,726,376
4,804,517
Granted during the year
4,082,706
2,631,126
Exercised during the year
(1,027,884)
(41,372)
Lapsed during the year
(1,904,485)
(1,667,895)
Outstanding at end of the year
6,876,713
5,726,376
Exercisable at end of the year
322,810
96,832
£m
£m
Charge to income for share incentive schemes
1.5
1.9
The weighted average share price at the date of exercise of share options exercised during the year was £2.77 (2022: £3.59). The options
outstanding had a range of exercise prices of £nil to £3.42 (2022: £nil to £3.42) and a weighted average remaining contractual life of 6.2 years
(2022: 6.4 years). The gain on shares exercised during the year was £0.1m (2022: £0.6m).
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 142 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
17 Trade and other receivables
Trade and other Trade and other
receivables Trade and other receivables Trade and other
before receivables before receivables
expected Expected after expected expected Expected after expected
credit loss credit loss credit loss credit loss credit loss credit loss
2023 2023 2023 2022 2022 2022
£m £m £m £m £m £m
Non-current
Trade receivables
4.6
(0.1)
4.5
9.7
9.7
Due from joint ventures
1.5
1.5
25.4
(0.1)
25.3
6.1
(0.1)
6.0
35.1
(0.1)
35.0
Current
Trade receivables
57.1
(0.7)
56.4
49.7
(0.3)
49.4
Contract assets
6.9
6.9
25.2
(0.1)
25.1
Due from joint ventures
28.1
(0.1)
28.0
1.8
1.8
Other receivables
27.0
(0.2)
26.8
38.1
38.1
Prepayments and accrued income
1.9
1.9
1.9
1.9
121.0
(1.0)
120.0
116.7
(0.4)
116.3
Non-current and current
127.1
(1.1)
126.0
151.8
(0.5)
151.3
Trade receivables and contract assets mainly comprise contractual amounts due from housing associations, bulk sale purchasers and land
sales to other housebuilders. Other receivables mainly comprise two development agreements where the Group is entitled to recovery of
costs incurred under the agreement. Current trade receivables of £20.2m have been collected as of 1 January 2024 (2022: £21.2m have been
collected as of 1 January 2023). The remaining balance is due according to contractual terms, and no individually material amounts are past due.
At the consolidated statement of financial position date the diereifference between the fair value of amounts due from joint ventures and nominal
value is £0.2m (2022: £0.4m).
Amounts due from joint ventures comprises funding provided on four (2022: three) joint venture developments which are being project
managed by the Group and are repayable according to contractual arrangements. Amounts due from joint ventures are stated net of losses of
£nil (2022: £0.2m). See note 14 for additional details on the Group’s interests in joint ventures.
Amounts due from joint ventures are stated after a loss allowance of £0.1m (2022: £0.1m) in respect of expected credit losses. £nil (2022: £2.3m)
provision was made during the year, £nil (2022: £14.1m) was utilised and £nil (2022: £nil) provision was released during the year.
Trade receivables, contract assets and other receivables are stated after a loss allowance of £1.0m (2022: £0.4m) in respect of expected credit
losses, assessed on an estimate of default rates. £0.7m (2022: £nil) provision was made during the year, £nil (2022: £nil) was utilised and £0.1m
(2022: £nil) provision was released during the year.
Crest Nicholson 143 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
2023 2022
£m £m
Movements in total loss allowance for expected credit losses
At beginning of the year
0.5
12.3
Charged in the year on joint venture balances (note 14)
2.3
Charged in the year on trade and other trade receivables
0.7
Released in the year on contract assets
(0.1)
Utilised in the year on joint venture balances (note 14)
(14.1)
At end of the year
1.1
0.5
2023 2022
£m £m
Maturity of non-current receivables:
Due between one and two years
5.8
34.2
Due between two and five years
0.2
0.8
Due after five years
6.0
35.0
18 Inventories
2023 2022
£m £m
Work-in-progress
1,040.7
942.8
Completed buildings including show homes
89.6
30.1
Part exchange inventories
34.5
17.2
1,164.8
990.1
Included within inventories is a fair value adjustment of £1.3m (2022: £2.0m) which arose on the acquisition of CN Finance plc in 2009 and
will continue to unwind to cost of sales in future years as the units against which the original fair value provision was recognised are sold or
otherwise divested. The amount of fair value provision unwound in cost of sales in the year was £0.7m (2022: £0.5m). Total inventories of
£520.2m (2022: £705.3m) were recognised as cost of sales in the year.
During the year £13.4m additional NRV was charged, mainly relating to the legacy Farnham development.
Inventories are stated after an NRV provision of £20.2m (2022: £12.6m), which it is currently forecast that over a third will be used in the next
financial year.
Movements in the NRV provision in the current and prior year are shown below:
2023 2022
£m £m
At beginning of the year
12.6
20.7
Pre-exceptional NRV charged in the year
13.4
9.6
Pre-exceptional NRV used in the year
(5.0)
(7.2)
Exceptional NRV used in the year
(0.8)
(10.5)
Total movement in NRV in the year
7.6
(8.1)
At end of the year
20.2
12.6
19 Movement in net cash
2023 Movement 2022
£m £m £m
Cash and cash equivalents
162.6
(211.0)
373.6
Bank loans and senior loan notes
(97.7)
(0.6)
(97.1)
Net cash
64.9
(211.6)
276.5
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 144 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
20 Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
2023 2022
£m £m
Non-current
Senior loan notes
85.0
100.0
Revolving credit and senior loan notes issue costs
(1.5)
(2.9)
83.5
9 7.1
Current
Senior loan notes
15.0
Revolving credit and senior loan notes issue costs
(0.8)
14.2
There were undrawn amounts of £250.0m (2022: £250.0m) under the RCF at the consolidated statement of financial position date. The Group
was undrawn throughout the financial year (2022: undrawn) under the RCF. See note 24 for additional disclosures.
21 Trade and other payables
2023 2022
£m £m
Non-current
Land payables on contractual terms
64.7
32.9
Other payables
2.0
2.3
Contract liabilities
0.3
0.3
Accruals and deferred income
4.1
6.3
71.1
41.8
Current
Land payables on contractual terms
140.8
165.8
Other trade payables
61.8
41.1
Contract liabilities
5.7
19.0
Due to joint ventures
0.7
0.1
Taxes and social security costs
1.7
1.8
Other payables
1.1
3.2
Accruals and deferred income
125.2
176.1
337.0
407.1
Land payables are recognised from the date of unconditional exchange of contracts, and represent amounts due to land vendors for
development sites acquired. All land payables are due according to contractual terms. Where land is purchased on deferred settlement
terms then the land and the land payable are discounted to their fair value using the eect effective interest method in accordance with IFRS 9.
The dierencThe difference between the fair value and the nominal value is amortised over the deferment period, with the financing element being charged
as an interest expense through the consolidated income statement. As at 31 October 2023 the dierenc the difference between the fair value and nominal
value of land payables is £6.8m (2022: £2.4m).
Contract liabilities represent payments on account, received from customers, in excess of billable work-in-progress on aos on affordable and other
sales in bulk on contracts in which revenue is recognised over time. Based on historical trends, the Directors expect a significant proportion of
the contract liabilities total to be recognised as revenue in the next reporting period.
Amounts due to joint ventures are interest free and repayable on demand. See note 14 for additional details on the Group’s interests in
joint ventures.
Other trade payables mainly comprise amounts due to suppliers and subcontractor retentions. Suppliers are settled according to agreed
payment terms and subcontractor retentions are released once the retention condition has been satisfied.
Accruals are mainly work-in-progress related where work has been performed but not yet invoiced.
Crest Nicholson 145 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
22 Provisions
Combustible Other
materials Legal provision Joint ventures provisions Total
£m £m £m £m £m
At 1 November 2021
42.6
0.5
43.1
Provided in the year
102.5
0.3
102.8
Imputed interest
1.0
1.0
Utilised in the year
(5.3)
(5.3)
Released in the year
(0.4)
(0.4)
Funding commitment recognised
1.2
1.2
Reclassification
0.6
0.6
At 31 October 2022
140.8
1.2
1.0
143.0
Provided in the year
12.0
13.0
0.4
25.4
Imputed interest
4.6
4.6
Utilised in the year
(12.6)
(0.6)
(13.2)
Released in the year
(0.2)
(0.2)
Funding commitment change
(0.3)
(0.3)
At 31 October 2023
144.8
13.0
0.9
0.6
159.3
At 31 October 2023
Non-current
73.6
0.2
73.8
Current
71.2
13.0
0.9
0.4
85.5
144.8
13.0
0.9
0.6
159.3
At 31 October 2022
Non-current
70.5
0.3
70.8
Current
70.3
1.2
0.7
72.2
140.8
1.2
1.0
143.0
Combustible materials
As a consequence of signing the Developer Remediation Contract on 13 March 2023, the Group has entered into contractual commitments
with the UK Government to identify and remediate those buildings it has developed with possible life-critical fire safety defects. The signing of
the contract did not materially alter the provision required as at 31 October 2022, which reflected the requirements of the Pledge. The Group is
currently working on circa 90 buildings in various stages of design, procurement and works.
The combustible materials provision reflects the estimated costs to complete the remediation of life-critical fire safety issues on identified
buildings. The Directors have used a combination of BSF costed information, other external information, and internal assessments as a basis for
the provision, which is a best estimate at this time.
The Group recorded a further net combustible materials charge of £12.0m in the year predominantly related to changes in forecast build cost
scope and price over the duration of remediation, net of the change in discounting. £11.3m of the charge relates to exceptional items per note
4. The provision is stated after a related discount of £7.3m, which unwinds to the consolidated income statement as finance expense over the
expected duration of the provision using the eehe effective interest rate method.
The provision of £144.8m represents the Group’s best estimate of future costs on 31 October 2023. The Group will continue to assess the
magnitude and utilisation of this provision in future reporting periods. The Group recognises that required remediation works could be subject
to further inflationary pressures and cash outflows. If forecast remediation costs on buildings currently provided for are 20.0% higher than
provided, the pre-tax exceptional items charge in the consolidated income statement would be £29.0m higher. If further buildings are identified
this could also increase the required provision, but the potential quantity of this change cannot be readily determined without further claims or
investigative work.
The Group spent £12.6m in the year across several buildings requiring further investigative costs, including balcony and cladding-related
works. The Group expects to have completed any required remediation within a five-year period, using £71.2m of the remaining provision
within one year, and the balance within one to five years. The timing of the expenditure is based on the Directors best estimates of the timing
of remediating buildings and repaying the BSF incurred costs. Actual timing may diay differ due to delays in agreeing scope of works, obtaining
licences, tendering works contracts and the BSF payment schedule diering to differing to our forecast.
The Group is continuing to review the recoverability of costs incurred from third parties where it has a contractual right of recourse. In the year
£10.0m was recovered from third parties by the Group. The Group also recognised its share of recoveries from third parties in its joint venture
Crest Nicholson Bioregional Quintain LLP of £0.6m, net of changes in build costs. Recoveries are not recognised until they are virtually certain to
be received. See note 4 for consolidated income statement disclosure.
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 146 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Legal provision
The Group is subject to a legal claim relating to a low-rise bespoke apartment block built by the Group which was damaged by fire in 2021.
The fire caused extensive damage to the property which was subsequently demolished and is currently being rebuilt by the freeholder. In June
2023 the Group received a letter of claim alleging fire safety defects and claiming compensation for the rebuild and other associated costs.
The Group has now assessed the claim and the provision recorded represents managements best estimate of the Group’s potential exposure
taking into account legal and professional advice. The claim and ultimate route to settlement is ongoing but the Group currently does not have a
set timeline for when the matter will be concluded.
Joint ventures
Joint ventures represents the Group’s legal or constructive obligation to fund losses on joint ventures.
Other provisions
Other provisions comprise dilapidation provisions on Group oc on Group offices and dilapidation provisions on commercial properties where the Group
previously held the head lease. In the prior year the Group reclassified the brought forward balance of dilapidations on Group oces which offices which
were previously oly offset against right of use assets.
23 Share capital
Shares issued Nominal value Share capital Share premium
Number Pence £ account
Ordinary shares as at 1 November 2021, 31 October 2022
and 31 October 2023
256,920,539
5
12,846,027
74,227,216
Ordinary shares are issued and fully paid. Authorised ordinary shares of five pence each are 342,560,719 (2022: 342,560,719).
For details of outstanding share options at 31 October 2023 see note 17.
Own shares held
The Group and Company holds shares within ESOT for participants of certain share-based payment schemes. These are held within retained
earnings. During the year 840,000 shares were purchased by the ESOT for £1.9m (2022: 440,000 shares were purchased by the ESOT for £1.1m)
and the ESOT transferred 1,027,884 (2022: 41,382) shares to employees and Directors to satisfy options as detailed in note 17. The number of
shares held within the ESOT (Treasury shares), and on which dividends have been waived, at 31 October 2023 was 600,256 (2022: 788,140).
These shares are held within the financial statements in equity at a cost of £1.5m (2022: £2.5m). The market value of these shares at 31 October
2023 was £1.0m (2022: £1.6m).
24 Financial risk management
The Group’s financial instruments comprise cash, trade and other receivables, financial assets at fair value through profit and loss, bank loans,
senior loan notes, and trade and other payables. The main objective of the Group’s policy towards financial instruments is to maximise returns
on the Group’s cash balances, manage the Group’s working capital requirements and finance the Group’s ongoing operations.
Capital management
The Group’s policies seek to match long-term assets with long-term finance and ensure that there is sue is sufficient working capital to meet the
Group’s commitments as they fall due, comply with the loan covenants and continue to sustain trading.
The Group’s capital comprises shareholders’ funds and net cash. A five-year summary of this can be found in the unaudited historical summary
on page 163, in addition to its return on average capital employed.
The Group seeks to manage its capital through control of expenditure, dividend payments and through its banking facilities. The RCF and senior
loan notes impose certain minimum capital requirements on the Group. These requirements are integrated into the Group’s internal forecasting
process and are regularly reviewed. The Group has, and is forecasting, to operate within these capital requirements.
There were undrawn amounts of £250.0m (2022: £250.0m) under the RCF at the consolidated statement of financial position date. The RCF
carries interest at SONIA plus 1.85% and ends in 2026.
Both the Senior loan notes and the RCF are subject to three covenants that are measured quarterly in January, April, July and October each
year, they are, gearing being of a maximum of 70%, interest cover being a minimum of 3 times and consolidated tangible net worth being not
less than £500m, all based on measures as defined in the facilities agreements which are adjusted from the equivalent IFRS amounts. As at the
statement of financial position date gearing was 17.0%, interest cover was 8.0 times and consolidated tangible net worth was £827.3m.
On 12 October 2022 the Group signed an amendment to the RCF. This amendment extended the facility to run through to October 2026 and
changed the facility into a Sustainability Linked RCF.
Crest Nicholson 147 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Under this amended facility the margin applicable can vary by plus or minus 0.05% depending on the Group’s progress against four targets.
These targets include:
Reduction in absolute scope 1 and 2 emissions in line with our science-based targets
2023. Target met. A focus on eciefficient use of materials and fuel with an absolute reduction in site activity
Increasing the number of our suppliers engaging with the Supply Chain Sustainability School
2023. Target met. Proactive engagement with our key suppliers in the year
Reduction in carbon emissions associated with the use of our homes
2023. Target met. Impact of the switch to standard house types across the business
Increasing the number of our employees in trainee positions and on training programmes
2023. Target met. A continued priority with dedicated resource and strong employee engagement
As a result of meeting 4 out of 4 of the metrics for FY23 the margin on the RCF will be amended down by 0.05% from the date of submission of
the compliance documents for the facility.
Financial risk
As virtually all of the operations of the Group are in sterling, there is no direct currency risk, and thus the Group’s main financial risks are credit
risk, liquidity risk and market interest rate risk. The Board is responsible for managing these risks and the policies adopted are as set out below:
Credit risk
Credit risk is the risk of financial loss to the Group if a customer or other counterparty to a financial instrument fails to meet its contractual
obligations, and arises principally from the Group’s cash deposits, as most receivables are secured on land and buildings.
The Group has cash deposits of £162.6m (2022: £373.6m) which are held by the providers of its banking facilities. These are primarily provided
by HSBC Bank Plc, Barclays Bank Plc, Lloyds Bank Plc and Natwest Group Plc, being four of the UK’s leading financial institutions. The security
and suitability of these banks is monitored by the treasury function on a regular basis. The Group has bank facilities of £250.0m expiring in
October 2026, with £250.0m remaining available for drawdown under such facilities at 31 October 2023.
Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss of £3.7m (2022: £4.6m) are receivables on extended terms granted as part of a sales
transaction and are secured by way of a legal charge on the relevant property and therefore credit risk is considered low.
The carrying value of trade and other receivables is mainly contractual amounts due from housing associations, bulk sale purchasers, land sales to
other housebuilders and a development agreement where the Group is entitled to recovery of costs incurred under the agreement, and equates to
the Group’s exposure to credit risk which is set out in note 17. Amounts due from joint ventures of £29.5m (2022: £27.1m) is funding provided on four
(2022: three) joint venture developments which are being project managed by the Group and are subject to contractual arrangements. The Group
has assessed the expected credit loss impact on the carrying value of trade and other receivables as set out in note 17. Within trade receivables the
other largest single amount outstanding at 31 October 2023 is £12.1m (2022: £11.5m) which is within agreed terms.
The Group considers the credit quality of financial assets that are neither past due nor impaired as good. In managing risk the Group assesses the
credit risk of its counterparties before entering into a transaction. No credit limits were exceeded during the reporting year, and the Directors do
not expect any material losses from non-performance of any counterparties, including in respect of receivables not yet due. No individually material
financial assets are past due, or are considered to be impaired as at the consolidated statement of financial position date (2022: none).
Liquidity risk
Liquidity risk is the risk that the Group will not be able to meet its financial obligations as they fall due. Cash flow forecasts are produced to
monitor the expected cash flow requirements of the Group against the available facilities. The principal risks within these cash flows relate to
achieving the level of sales volume and prices in line with current forecasts.
The following are the contractual maturities of the financial liabilities of the Group at 31 October 2023:
Contractual More than
Carrying value cash flows Within 1 year 1-2 years 2-3 years 3yea3 years
2023 £m £m £m £m £m £m
Senior loan notes
100.0
112.5
18.5
23.1
2.4
68.5
Financial liabilities carrying no interest
401.4
408.8
333.5
44.1
28.3
2.9
At 31 October 2023
501.4
521.3
352.0
67.2
30.7
71.4
Contractual More than
Carrying value cash flows Within 1 year 1-2 years 2-3 years 3yea3 years
2022 £m £m £m £m £m £m
Senior loan notes
100.0
116.1
3.5
18.5
23.1
71.0
Financial liabilities carrying interest
29.8
30.1
30.1
Financial liabilities carrying no interest
395.2
397.8
357.6
37.5
1.1
1.6
At 31 October 2022
525.0
544.0
391.2
56.0
24.2
72.6
Other financial liabilities carrying interest are land acquisitions using promissory notes. The timing and amount of future cash flows given in the
table above is based on the Directors’ best estimate of the likely outcome.
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 148 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Market interest rate risk
Market interest rate risk reflects the Group’s exposure to fluctuations to interest rates in the market. The risk arises because the Group’s RCF is
subject to floating interest rates based on SONIA. The Group accepts a degree of interest rate risk, and monitors rate changes to ensure they
are within acceptable limits and in line with banking covenants. The Group has partially mitigated this risk by placing £100m of senior loan notes
which are at fixed interest rates. For the year ended 31 October 2023 it is estimated that an increase of 1.0% in interest rates applying for the
full year would decrease the Group’s profit before tax and equity by £nil (2022: £nil). The Group currently does not have any interest carrying
liabilities with floating interest rates.
The interest rate profile of the financial liabilities of the Group was:
2023 2022
£m £m
Sterling bank borrowings, loan notes and long-term creditors
Financial liabilities carrying interest
100.0
129.8
Financial liabilities carrying no interest
401.4
395.2
501.4
525.0
For financial liabilities that have no interest payable but for which imputed interest is charged, consisting of land payables, the weighted average
period to maturity is 26 months (2022: 14 months).
2023 2022
£m £m
The maturity of the financial liabilities is:
Repayable within one year
344.0
385.2
Repayable between one and two years
61.7
52.1
Repayable between two and five years
78.9
72.1
Repayable after five years
16.8
15.6
501.4
525.0
Fair values
Financial assets
The Group’s financial assets are detailed in a table below. The carrying value of cash and cash equivalents and trade and other receivables is a
reasonable approximation of fair value which would be measured under a level 3 hierarchy. Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss
are carried at fair value and categorised as level 3 (inputs not based on observable market data) within the hierarchical classification of IFRS 13:
Revised.
Financial liabilities
The Group’s financial liabilities are detailed in a table below, the carrying amounts of which are deemed to be a reasonable approximation to
their fair value. The fair values of the RCF, other loans and loan notes are calculated based on the present value of future principal and interest
cash flows, discounted at the market rate of interest at the consolidated statement of financial position date.
The fair values of the facilities determined on this basis are:
2023
Nominal Face value Carrying value Fair value
interest rate £m £m
£m
Maturity
Current
Senior loan notes
3.15%
15.0
15.0
15.0
2024
Non-current
Senior loan notes
3.32%–3.87%
85.0
85.0
85.0
2025–2029
Total interest-bearing loans
100.0
100.0
100.0
2022
Nominal Face value Carrying value Fair value
interest rate £m £m
£m
Maturity
Senior loan notes
3.15%–3.87%
100.0
100.0
100.0
2024–2029
Total non-current interest-bearing loans
100.0
100.0
100.0
Crest Nicholson 149 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Financial assets and liabilities by category
Financial assets
2023 2022
£m £m
Sterling cash deposits
162.6
373.6
Trade receivables
60.9
59.1
Amounts due from joint ventures
29.5
27.1
Other receivables
22.7
29.6
Total financial assets at amortised cost
275.7
489.4
Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss
3.7
4.6
Total financial assets
279.4
494.0
Financial liabilities
2023 2022
£m £m
Senior loan notes
100.0
100.0
Land payables on contractual terms carrying interest
29.8
Land payables on contractual terms carrying no interest
205.5
168.9
Amounts due to joint ventures
0.7
0.1
Lease liabilities
6.4
3.9
Other trade payables
61.8
41.1
Other payables
3.1
5.5
Accruals
123.9
175.7
Total financial liabilities at amortised cost
501.4
525.0
25 Contingencies and commitments
There are performance bonds and other engagements, including those in respect of joint venture partners, undertaken in the ordinary course
of business. It is impractical to quantify the financial eect of performance bonds and otherpractical to quantify the financial effect of performance bonds and other arrangements. The Directors consider the possibility
of a cash outflow in settlement of performance bonds and other arrangements to be remote and therefore this does not represent a contingent
liability for the Group.
In the ordinary course of business, the Group enters into certain land purchase contracts with vendors on a conditional exchange basis.
The conditions must be satisfied for the Group to recognise the land asset and corresponding liabilities within the consolidated statement of
financial position. No land payable in respect of conditional land acquisitions has been recognised.
The Group provides for all known material legal actions, where having taken appropriate legal advice as to the likelihood of success of the
actions, it is considered probable that an outflow of economic resource will be required, and the amount can be reliably measured. No material
contingent liability in respect of such claims has been recognised since there are no known claims of this nature.
As a consequence of signing the Developer Remediation Contract on 13 March 2023, the Group has entered into contractual commitments with
the UK Government to identify and remediate those buildings it has developed with possible life-critical fire safety defects. Accordingly, while
the Group believes that most significant liabilities will have been identified through the process of building owners assessing buildings and
applying for BSF funding and through Crest commissioning assessments to date, contingent liabilities exist where additional buildings have not
yet been identified which require remediation. Due to the enduring challenges of developing a reliable estimate of these possible costs, it is not
practicable to disclose an expected range.
The Group is reviewing the recoverability of costs incurred from third parties where it has a contractual right of recourse. As reflected in these
financial results, the Group has a track record of successfully obtaining such recoveries, however no contingent assets have been recognised in
these consolidated financial statements for such items.
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 150 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
26 Net cash and land creditors
2023 2022
£m £m
Cash and cash equivalents
162.6
373.6
Non-current Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
(83.5)
(97.1)
Current Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
(14.2)
Net cash
64.9
276.5
Land payables on contractual terms carrying interest
(29.8)
Land payables on contractual terms carrying no interest
(205.5)
(168.9)
Net cash and land creditors
(140.6)
77.8
27 Related party transactions
Transactions between fellow subsidiaries, which are related parties, are eliminated on consolidation, as well as transactions between the
Company and its subsidiaries during the current and prior year.
Transactions between the Group and key management personnel mainly comprise remuneration which is given in note 6. Detailed disclosure
for Board members is given within the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 81–98. There were no other transactions between the Group
and key management personnel in the year.
Transactions between the Group and the Crest Nicholson Group Pension and Life Assurance Scheme is given in note 16.
The Company’s Directors and Non-Executive Directors have associations other than with the Company. From time to time the Group may trade
with organisations with which a Director or Non-Executive Director has an association. Where this occurs, it is on normal commercial terms and
without the direct involvement of the Director or Non-Executive Director.
The Group had the following transactions/balances with its joint ventures in the year/at year end:
2023 2022
£m £m
Interest income on joint venture funding
1.2
2.1
Project management fees recognised
1.9
2.0
Amounts due from joint ventures, net of expected credit losses
29.5
27.1
Amounts due to joint ventures
0.7
0.1
Funding to joint ventures
(13.0)
(7.5)
Repayment of funding from joint ventures
11.7
18.8
Dividends received from joint ventures
1.5
2.4
Crest Nicholson 151 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
28 Group undertakings
In accordance with Section 409 Companies Act 2006, the following is a list of all the Group’s undertakings at 31 October 2023.
Subsidiary undertakings
At 31 October 2023 the Group had an interest in the below subsidiary undertakings, which are included in the consolidated financial statements.
All subsidiaries were incorporated in England and Wales.
Voting
rights and
shareholding
Registered Active/ (direct or
Entity name oceoffice
dormant
Year end date
indirect)
Bath Riverside Estate Management Company Limited
2
Dormant
31 October
100%
Bath Riverside Liberty Management Company Limited
2
Dormant
31 October
100%
Castle Bidco Home Loans Limited
1
Active
31 October
100%
Brightwells Residential 1 Company Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Bristol Parkway North Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Building 7 Harbourside Management Company Limited
2
Active
31 December
58.33%
Buildings 3A, 3B & 4 Harbourside Management Company Limited
2
Dormant
31 December
83.33%
Clevedon Developments Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Clevedon Investment Limited
1
Active
31 October
100%
CN Finance plc
*
1
Active
31 October
100%
CN Nominees Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
CN Properties Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
CN Secretarial Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
CN Shelf 2 LLP
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
CN Shelf 3 LLP
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest (Claybury) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Developments Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Estates Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Homes (Eastern) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Homes (Midlands) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Homes (Nominees) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Homes (Nominees No. 2) Limited
1
Active
31 October
100%
Crest Homes (Northern) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Homes (South East) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Homes (South West) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Homes (South) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Homes (Wessex) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Homes (Westerham) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Homes Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Manhattan Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (Bath) Holdings Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (Chiltern) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (Eastern) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (Epsom) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (Henley-on-Thames) Limited
1
Active
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (Highlands Farm) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (Londinium) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (Midlands) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (Peckham) Limited
1
Active
31 October
100%
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 152 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Voting
rights and
shareholding
Registered Active/ (direct or
Entity name oceoffice
dormant
Year end date
indirect)
Crest Nicholson (South East) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (South West) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (South) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (Stotfold) Limited
1
Active
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson Developments (Chertsey) Limited
1
Active
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson Operations Limited
1
Active
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson Pension Trustee Limited
1
Dormant
31 January
100%
Crest Nicholson plc
1
Active
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson Projects Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson Properties Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson Regeneration Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson Residential (London) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson Residential (Midlands) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson Residential (South East) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson Residential (South) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson Residential Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Nicholson (Wheatley) LLP
1
Active
31 October
100%
Crest Partnership Homes Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Crest Strategic Projects Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Eastern Perspective Management Company Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Essex Brewery (Walthamstow) LLP
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Harbourside Leisure Management Company Limited
1
Active
30 December
71.43%
Landscape Estates Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Mertonplace Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Nicholson Estates (Century House) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Central Plaza) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Ellis Mews (Park Central) Management Limited
1
Active
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 11) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 12) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 1A North) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 1A South) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 1B) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 3/1) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 3/2) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 3/3) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 3/4) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 4/41 & 42) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 4/43/44) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 5/53) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 5/54) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 5/55) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
1 500 Dashwood Lang Road, Bourne Business Park, Addlestone, Surrey KT15 2HJ.
2 Unit 2 & 3 Beech Court, Wokingham Road, Hurst, Reading RG10 0RU.
* CN Finance plc is the only direct holding of Crest Nicholson Holdings plc.
Crest Nicholson 153 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Voting
rights and
shareholding
Registered Active/ (direct or
Entity name oceoffice
dormant
Year end date
indirect)
Park Central Management (Zone 6/61-64) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 7/9) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 8) Limited
1
Dormant
31 October
100%
Park Central Management (Zone 9/91) Limited
1
Dormant
31 January
100%
Park West Management Services Limited
1
Active
29 March
62.00%
1 500 Dashwood Lang Road, Bourne Business Park, Addlestone, Surrey KT15 2HJ.
Subsidiary audit exemption
The following subsidiaries have taken advantage of an exemption from audit under section 479A of the Companies Act 2006. The parent of
the subsidiaries, Crest Nicholson plc, has provided a statutory guarantee for any outstanding liabilities of these subsidiaries. All subsidiary
undertakings have been included in the consolidated financial statements of Crest Nicholson Holdings plc as at 31 October 2023.
Clevedon Investment Limited (00454327) Crest Homes (Nominees No. 2) Limited (02213319)
Crest Nicholson (Henley-on-Thames) Limited (03828831) Crest Nicholson (Peckham) Limited (07296143)
Crest Nicholson (Stotfold) Limited (08774274) Crest Nicholson (Bath) Holdings Limited (05235961)
Crest Nicholson Developments (Chertsey) Limited (04707982) Crest Homes (Nominees) Limited (01715768)
Crest Nicholson Residential Limited (00714425)
Joint venture undertakings
At 31 October 2023 the Group had an interest in the following joint venture undertakings which are equity accounted within the consolidated
financial statements. The principal activity of all undertakings is that of residential development. All joint ventures were incorporated in England
and Wales.
Voting
rights and
shareholding
Registered Active/ (direct or
Entity name oceoffice
dormant
Year end date
indirect)
Material joint ventures
Crest A2D (Walton Court) LLP
1
Active
31 March
50%
Elmsbrook (Crest A2D) LLP
4
Active
31 March
50%
Crest Sovereign (Brooklands) LLP
3
Active
31 October
50%
Crest Peabody (Turweston) LLP
1
Active
31 May
50%
Other joint ventures not material to the Group
Crest/Vistry (Epsom) LLP
1
Active
31 October
50%
Crest Nicholson Bioregional Quintain LLP
1
Active
31 October
50%
English Land Banking Company Limited
1
Active
31 October
50%
Haydon Development Company Limited
2
Active
30 April
21.36%
North Swindon Development Company Limited
2
Active
31 December
32.64%
1 500 Dashwood Lang Road, Bourne Business Park, Addlestone, Surrey KT15 2HJ.
2 6 Drakes Meadow, Penny Lane, Swindon, Wiltshire SN3 3LL.
3 Sovereign House, Basing View, Basingstoke RG21 4FA.
4 The Point, 37 North Wharf Road, London W2 1BD.
Notes to the consolidated financials statements continued
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 154 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Joint operations
The Group is party to a joint unincorporated arrangement with Linden Homes Limited, the purpose of which was to acquire, and develop, a
site in Hemel Hempstead, Hertfordshire. The two parties are jointly responsible for the control and management of the site’s development,
with each party funding 50% of the cost of the land acquisition and development of the site, in return for 50% of the returns. As such this
arrangement was designated as a joint operation.
The Group is party to a joint unincorporated arrangement with CGNU Life Assurance Limited, the purpose of which is to acquire, and develop,
a site in Chertsey, Surrey. The two parties are jointly responsible for the control and management of the site’s development, with each party
funding 50% of the cost of the land acquisition and development of the site, in return for 50% of the returns. As such this arrangement has been
designated as a joint operation.
The Group is party to a joint arrangement with Passion Property Group Limited, the purpose of which was to develop a site in London.
The development was completed in 2014 and there are no material balances in the Group financial statements relating to this joint arrangement
as at 31 October 2023. The two parties were jointly responsible for the control and management of the site’s development, with each party
having prescribed funding obligations and returns. As such this arrangement has been designated as a joint operation.
In line with the Group’s accounting policies, the Group has recognised its share of the jointly controlled assets and liabilities, and income and
expenditure, in relation to these joint arrangements on a line-by-line basis in the consolidated statement of financial position and consolidated
income statement as there is no legal entity in place and the arrangements as structured such that the Group has a direct interest in the
underlying assets and liabilities of each arrangement.
Crest Nicholson Employee Share Ownership Trust
The Group operates the Crest Nicholson ESOT which is used to satisfy awards granted under the Group’s share incentive schemes, shares
are allotted to the Trust or the Trust is funded to acquire shares in the open market. The ESOT falls within the scope of IFRS 10: Consolidated
Financial Statements, and is consolidated within the Group financial statements, as the Group is considered to have control over the ESOT.
Crest Nicholson 155 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Note
2023
£m
2022
£m
Assets
Non-current assets
Investments 4 1.6 2.6
Current assets
Trade and other receivables 5 186.4 222.4
Total Assets 188.0 225.0
Net Assets 188.0 225.0
Shareholders’ Equity
Share capital 6 12.8 12.8
Share premium account 6 74.2 74.2
Retained earnings:
At 1 November 138.0 166.1
Profit for the year 8.6 10.5
Other changes in retained earnings (45.6) (38.6)
At 31 October 101.0 138.0
Total Shareholders’ Equity 188.0 225.0
The Company recorded a profit for the financial year of £8.6m (2022: £10.5m).
The notes on pages 158–160 form part of these financial statements.
The financial statements on pages 156–160 were approved by the Board of Directors on 23 January 2024.
On behalf of the Board
Peter Truscott Bill Floydd
Director Director
Company statement of financial position
As at 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 156 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Note
Share capital
£m
Share premium
account
£m
Retained
earnings
£m
Total equit y
£m
Balance at 1 November 2021 12.8 74.2 166.1 253.1
Profit for the financial year and total comprehensive income 10.5 10.5
Transactions with shareholders
Dividends paid (38.5) (38.5)
Exercise of share options through employee share
ownershiptrust 4 (0.1) (0.1)
Balance at 31 October 2022 12.8 74.2 138.0 225.0
Profit for the financial year and total comprehensive income 8.6 8.6
Transactions with shareholders
Dividends paid (43.6) (43.6)
Exercise of share options through employee share
ownershiptrust 4 (2.9) (2.9)
Net proceeds from the issue of shares and exercise of
shareoptions 0.9 0.9
Balance at 31 October 2023 12.8 74.2 101.0 188.0
Company statement of changes in equity
For the year ended 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 157 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
1 Accounting policies
Basis of preparation
Crest Nicholson Holdings plc (the Company) is a public company limited by shares, incorporated, listed and domiciled in England and Wales.
The address of the registered oce is 500 Dashwood Lang Road, Bourne Business Park, Addlestone, Surrey KT15 2HJ. The Company financial
statements have been prepared and approved by the Directors in accordance with Financial Reporting Standard 101 Reduced Disclosure
Framework (FRS 101), in accordance with the Companies Act 2006 as applicable to companies using FRS 101, and have been prepared on
the historical cost basis. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with FRS 101 requires the Directors to make assumptions
and judgements that aect the application of policies and reported amounts within the financial statements. Assumptions and judgements
are based on experience and other factors that the Directors consider reasonable under the circumstances. Actual results may dier from
these estimates.
The financial statements are presented in pounds sterling and amounts stated are denominated in millions (£m), unless otherwise stated.
The accounting policies have been applied consistently in dealing with items which are considered material.
These financial statements present information about the Company as an individual undertaking and not about its group. Under Section 408
ofthe Companies Act 2006 the Company is exempt from the requirement to present its own profit and loss account.
As outlined in FRS 101 paragraph 8(a) the Company is exempt from the requirements of paragraphs 45(b) and 46 to 52 of IFRS 2 Share-based
Payments. This exemption has been taken in the preparation of these financial statements.
As outlined in FRS 101 paragraph 8(d-e) the Company is exempt from the requirements of IFRS 7 Financial Instruments: Disclosures, and from
the requirements of paragraphs 91 to 99 of IFRS 13 Fair Value Measurement. These exemptions have been taken in the preparation of these
financial statements.
As outlined in FRS 101 paragraph 8(h) the Company is exempt from the requirement to prepare a cash flow statement on the grounds that
a parent undertaking includes the Company in its own published consolidated financial statements. This exemption has been taken in the
preparation of these financial statements.
As outlined in FRS 101 paragraph 8(i) the Company is exempt from the requirement to provide information about the impact of IFRSs that
havebeen issued but are not yet eective. This exemption has been taken in the preparation of these financial statements.
Under FRS 101 paragraph 8(j) the Company is exempt from the requirement to disclose related party transactions with its subsidiary
undertakings on the grounds that they are wholly owned subsidiary undertakings of Crest Nicholson Holdings plc. This exemption has been
taken in the preparation of these financial statements.
Going concern
The Directors reviewed detailed cash flows and financial forecast for the period up to April 2025, in line the those modelled for the Group’s
going concern assessment. The Company is reliant upon the performance of the Group as a whole to meet its liabilities. Throughout this review
period the Company is forecast to be able to meet its liabilities as they fall due. Therefore, having assessed the principal risks and all other
relevant matters, the Directors consider it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting in preparing the financial statements
ofthe Company. The Group’s going concern assessment can be found in note 1 of the consolidated financial statements.
Adoption of new and revised standards
There were no new standards, amendments or interpretations that were adopted by the Company and eective for the first time for the financial
year beginning 1 November 2022 that have had a material impact on the Company.
The principal accounting policies set out below have, unless otherwise stated, been applied consistently to all years presented in these
financial statements.
Share-based payments
The Company issues equity-settled share-based payments to certain employees of its subsidiaries. Equity-settled share-based payments are
measured at fair value at the grant date, and charged to the income statement on a straight-line basis over the vesting period, based on the
estimate of shares that will vest. The cost of equity-settled share-based payments granted to employees of subsidiary companies is borne
bythe employing company.
Taxation
Income tax comprises current tax and deferred tax. Income tax is recognised in the Company’s income statement except to the extent that
itrelates to items recognised in other comprehensive income, in which case it is also recognised in other comprehensive income.
Current tax is the expected tax payable on taxable profit for the year and any adjustment to tax payable in respect of previous years.
Taxable profit is profit before tax per the Company’s income statement after adjusting for income and expenditure that is not subject to tax,
and for items that are subject to tax in other accounting periods. The Company’s liability for current tax is calculated using tax rates that have
been enacted or substantively enacted by the statement ofnancial position date. Where uncertain tax liabilities exist, the liability recognised
isassessed as the amount that is probable to be payable.
Deferred tax is provided in full on temporary dierences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities in the financial statements and
the corresponding tax bases used in the computation of taxable profit. Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is probable that
taxable profits will be available against which deductible temporary dierences can be utilised. Deferred tax is calculated using tax rates that
have been substantively enacted by the statement of financial position date.
Dividends
Final and interim dividend distributions to the Company’s shareholders are recorded in the Company’s financial statements in the earlier of the
period in which they are approved by the Company’s shareholders, or paid.
Notes to the company financial statements
Crest Nicholson 158 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Investments
Investments relate to Company contributions to the Crest Nicholson ESOT. The ESOT will use the contribution to acquire Company ordinary
shares in the market in order to satisfy share options under the Company’s share incentive schemes.
Financial assets
Financial assets are initially recognised at fair value and subsequently classified into one of the following measurement categories:
Measured at amortised cost
Measured subsequently at FVTPL
Measured subsequently at FVOCI.
The classification of financial assets depends on the Companys business model for managing the asset and the contractual terms of the cash
flows. Assets that are held for the collection of contractual cash flows that represent solely payments of principal and interest are measured
at amortised cost, with any interest income recognised in the income statement using the eective interest rate method. Financial assets that
do not meet the criteria to be measured at amortised cost are classified by the Company as measured at FVTPL. Fair value gains and losses
on financial assets measured at FVTPL are recognised in the income statement and presented within administrative expenses. The Company
currently has no financial assets measured at FVOCI.
Trade and other receivables
Trade and other receivables are recognised initially at fair value and subsequently measured at amortised cost, using the eective interest
method, less provision for impairment. A provision for impairment of trade receivables is established based on an expected credit loss model
applying the simplified approach, which uses a lifetime expected loss allowance for all trade receivables. The amount of the loss is recognised
in the income statement.
Financial liabilities
Financial liabilities are initially recognised at fair value and subsequently classified into one of the following measurement categories:
Measured at amortised cost
Measured subsequently at FVTPL.
Non-derivative financial liabilities are measured at FVTPL when they are considered held for trading or designated as such on initial recognition.
The Company has no non-derivative financial liabilities measured at FVTPL.
Own shares held by ESOT
Transactions of the Company sponsored ESOT are included in both the Group financial statements and the Company’s own financial
statements. The purchase of shares in the Company by the ESOT are charged directly to equity.
Audit fee
Auditor’s remuneration for audit of these financial statements of £30,000 (2022: £27,500) was met by Crest Nicholson plc. No disclosure of
other non-audit services has been made as this is included within note 5 of the consolidated financial statements.
Critical accounting estimates and judgements
The preparation of the Company financial statements under FRS 101 requires the Directors to make estimates and assumptions that aect the
application of policies and reported amounts of assets and liabilities, income and expenses and related disclosures.
In applying the Company’s accounting policies, the Directors have made no individual judgements that have a significant impact on the
financial statements.
Estimates and associated assumptions aecting the financial statements are based on historical experience and various other factors that are
believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. The estimates and underlying assumptions are reviewed on an ongoing basis. Changes in
accounting estimates may be necessary if there are changes in the circumstances on which the estimate was based or as a result of new
information. Revisions to accounting estimates are recognised in the year in which the estimate is revised if the revision aects only that year,
or in the year of revision and future years if the revision aects both current and future years. The Directors do not consider there are any
significant sources of estimation uncertainty that have a risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying value of assets and liabilities of
the Company.
2 Directors and employees
The Company had no employees during either year. Details of Directors’ emoluments, which were paid by another Group company, are set out
in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 81–98.
3 Dividends
Details of the dividends recognised as distributions to equity shareholders in the year and those proposed after the statement of financial
position date are shown in note 9 of the consolidated financial statements.
Crest Nicholson 159 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
4 Investments
2023
£m
2022
£m
Investments in shares of subsidiary undertaking at cost at beginning of the year 2.6 1.6
Additions 1.9 1.1
Disposals (2.9) (0.1)
Investments in shares of subsidiary undertaking at cost at end of the year 1.6 2.6
Additions and disposals in the year relate to Company contributions/utilisation to/from the Trust.
The Directors believe that the carrying value of the investments is supported by their underlying assets.
5 Trade and other receivables
2023
£m
2022
£m
Amounts due from Group undertakings 186.4 222.4
Amounts due from Group undertakings are unsecured, repayable on demand and carry an interest rate of 5.0% (2022: 5.0%).
Amounts due from Group undertakings are stated after an allowance of £nil has been made (2022: £nil) in respect of expected credit losses. £nil
(2022: £nil) provision was made during the year, £nil (2022: £nil) was utilised, and £nil (2022: £nil) provision was released during the year.
6 Share capital
The Company share capital is disclosed in note 23 of the consolidated financial statements.
7 Contingencies and commitments
There are performance bonds and other arrangements, including those in respect of joint venture partners, undertaken in the ordinary course
of business. It is impractical to quantify the financial eect of performance bonds and other arrangements. The Directors consider the possibility
of a cash outflow in settlement of performance bonds and other arrangements to be remote and therefore this does not represent a contingent
liability for the Company.
In addition, the Company is required from time to time to act as guarantor for the performance by subsidiary undertakings of contracts entered
into in the normal course of their business and typically provide that the Company will ensure that the obligations of the subsidiary are carried
out or met in the unlikely event that any subsidiary default occurs. The Company considers the likelihood of an outflow of cash under these
arrangements to be remote and therefore this does not represent a contingent liability for the Company.
8 Group undertakings
A list of all the Group’s undertakings at 31 October 2023 is given in note 28 of the consolidated financial statements.
Notes to the company financial statements continued
Crest Nicholson 160 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
The Group uses a number of APM which are not defined within IFRS. The Directors use the APM, along with IFRS measures, to assess the
operational performance of the Group as detailed in the Strategic Report on pages 152 of the 2023 annual report and financial statements
andabove. Definitions and reconciliations of the financial APM used compared to IFRS measures, are included below:
Sales
The Group uses sales as a core management measure to reflect the full extent of its business operations and responsibilities. Sales is a
combination of statutory revenue as per the consolidated income statement and the Group’s share of revenue earned by joint ventures,
asdetailed in the below table:
2023
£m
2022
£m
Revenue 657.5 913.6
Group’s share of joint venture revenue (note 14) 34.6 42.2
Sales 692.1 955.8
Return on capital employed
The Group uses ROCE as a core management measure to reflect the profitability and eciency with which capital is employed. ROCE is
calculated as adjusted operating profit before joint ventures divided by average capital employed (capital employed = equity plus net borrowing
or less net cash), as presented below. The Group has long-term performance measures linked to ROCE. ROCE achieved by the Group in the
year reduced to 6.3% (2022: increased to 22.4%).
2023 2022
Adjusted operating profit £m 44.2 140.9
Average of opening and closing capital employed £m 699.0 627.7
ROCE % 6.3 22.4
Capital employed 2023 2022 2021
Equity shareholders’ funds £m 856.3 883.1 901.6
Net cash (note 19) £m (64.9) (276.5) (252.8)
Closing capital employed £m 791.4 606.6 648.8
Land creditors as a percentage of net assets
The Group uses land creditors as a percentage of net assets as a core management measure to ensure that the Group is maintaining a robust
financial position when entering into future land commitments. Land creditors as a percentage of net assets is calculated as land creditors
divided by net assets, as presented below. Land creditors as a percentage of net assets has increased in the year to 24.0% (2022: reduced
to22.5%).
2023 2022
Land creditors (note 21) £m 205.5 198.7
Net assets £m 856.3 883.1
Land creditors as a percentage of net assets % 24.0 22.5
Net cash
Net cash is cash and cash equivalents plus non-current and current interest-bearing loans and borrowings. Net cash illustrates the Group’s
overall liquidity position and general financial resilience. Net cash has reduced in the year to £64.9m from £276.5m in 2022.
2023
£m
2022
£m
Cash and cash equivalents 162.6 373.6
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings (97.7) (97.1)
Net cash 64.9 276.5
Alternative performance measures (unaudited)
Crest Nicholson 161 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Adjusted performance metrics
Adjusted performance metrics as shown below comprise statutory metrics adjusted for the exceptional items as presented in note 4 of the
consolidated financial statements. The exceptional items have a material impact to reported performance and arise from recent, unforeseen
events. As such, the Directors’ consider these adjusted performance metrics reflect a more accurate view of its core operations and business
performance. EBIT margin for share award performance conditions is equivalent to operating profit margin.
Year ended 31 October 2023 Statutory
Exceptional
items Adjusted
Gross profit £m 86.3 14.3 100.6
Gross profit margin % 13.1 2.2 15.3
Operating profit £m 29.9 14.3 44.2
Operating profit margin % 4.5 2.2 6.7
Net finance expense £m (10.1) 4.6 (5.5)
Share of post-tax profit/(loss) of joint ventures using the equity method £m 3.3 (0.6) 2.7
Profit before tax £m 23.1 18.3 41.4
Income tax expense £m (5.2) (4.8) (10.0)
Profit after tax £m 17.9 13.5 31.4
Basic earnings per share Pence 7.0 5.3 12.3
Diluted earnings per share Pence 7.0 5.2 12.2
Year ended 31 October 2022
Statutory
Exceptional
items Adjusted
Gross profit £m 91.8 102.5 194.3
Gross profit margin % 10.0 11.3 21.3
Operating profit £m 38.4 102.5 140.9
Operating profit margin % 4.2 11.2 15.4
Net finance expense £m (8.1) 1.0 (7.1)
Share of post-tax profit/(loss) of joint ventures using the equity method £m 2.5 1.5 4.0
Profit before tax £m 32.8 105.0 137.8
Income tax expense £m (6.4) (22.4) (28.8)
Profit after tax £m 26.4 82.6 109.0
Basic earnings per share Pence 10.3 32.2 42.5
Diluted earnings per share Pence 10.2 32.1 42.3
Alternative performance measures (unaudited) continued
Crest Nicholson 162 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Note 2023
1
2022
1
2021
2
2020
3
2019
4
Consolidated income statement
Revenue £m 657.5 913.6 786.6 677.9 1,086.4
Gross profit £m 100.6 194.3 166.7 107.7 201.9
Gross profit margin % 15.3 21.3 21.2 15.9 18.6
Net administrative expenses £m (55.8) (51.1) (51.1) (50.3) (65.5)
Net impairment losses on financial assets £m (0.6) (2.3) (1.0) (0.3) (3.4)
Operating profit before joint ventures £m 44.2 140.9 114.6 57.1 133.0
Operating profit before joint ventures margin % 6.7 15.4 14.6 8.4 12.2
Share of post-tax profit/(loss) of joint ventures £m 2.7 4.0 1.7 (0.5) (0.9)
Operating profit after joint ventures £m 46.9 144.9 116.3 56.6 132.1
Operating profit after joint ventures margin % 7.1 15.9 14.8 8.3 12.2
Net finance expense £m (5.5) (7.1) (9.1) (10.7) (11.0)
Profit before taxation £m 41.4 137.8 107.2 45.9 121.1
Income tax expense £m (10.0) (28.8) (19.9) (8.5) (23.7)
Profit after taxation attributable to equity shareholders £m 31.4 109.0 87.3 37.4 97.4
Basic earnings per share Pence 12.3 42.5 34.0 14.6 38.0
Consolidated statement of financial position
Equity shareholders’ funds 1 £m 856.3 883.1 901.6 825.3 854.4
Net cash 2 £m (64.9) (276.5) (252.8) (142.2) (37.2)
Capital employed closing £m 791.4 606.6 648.8 683.1 817.2
Gearing 3 % (8.2) (45.6) (39.0) (20.8) (4.6)
Land creditors £m 205.5 198.7 222.9 205.7 216.5
Net (cash)/debt and land creditors 4 £m 140.6 (77.8) (29.9) 63.5 179.3
Return on average capital employed 5 % 6.3 22.4 17.2 7.6 15.9
Return on average equity 6 % 3.6 12.2 10.1 4.5 11.3
Housing
Home completions 7 Units 2,020 2,734 2,407 2,247 2,912
Average selling price – open market 8 £000 406 388 359 336 388
Short-term land 9 Units 14,922 14,250 14,677 14,991 16,960
Strategic land 10 Units 18,830 22,450 22,308 22,724 20,169
Total short-term and strategic land Units 33,752 36,700 36,985 37,715 37,129
Land pipeline gross development value 11 £m 12,163 12,111 11,834 11,360 12,137
1 Consolidated income statement statistics, return on average capital employed and return on average equity are presented before exceptional items as presented in note 4 of the 2023
consolidated financial statements.
2 Consolidated income statement statistics, return on average capital employed and return on average equity are presented before exceptional items relating to net combustible materials
provision charge £28.8m, inventory impairment credit £8.0m, and finance expense credit £0.5m.
3 Consolidated income statement statistics, return on average capital employed and return on average equity are presented before exceptional items relating to combustible materials
provision £0.6m, inventory impairment £43.7m, restructuring costs £7.5m and impairment losses on financial assets £7.6m. 2020 equity shareholders’ funds, capital employed closing,
gearing and return on average equity have been restated to reflect the change in accounting policy on land options.
4 Consolidated income statement statistics, return on average capital employed and return on average equity are presented before £18.4m exceptional item relating to combustible materials
provision. Not restated to reflect the change in accounting policy on land options from 1 November 2020.
Note
1 Equity shareholders’ funds = Group total equity (share capital plus share premium plus retained earnings).
2 Net (cash)/borrowings = Cash and cash equivalents plus non-current and current interest-bearing loans and borrowings.
3 Gearing = Net (cash)/borrowings divided by capital employed closing.
4 Net (cash)/debt and land creditors = land creditors less net cash or add net borrowings.
5 Return on capital employed = adjusted operating profit before joint ventures divided by average capital employed (capital employed = equity shareholders’ funds plus net borrowing or less net cash).
6 Return on average equity = adjusted profit after taxation attributable to equity shareholders divided by average equity shareholders’ funds.
7 Units completed = Open market and housing association homes recognised in the year. In 2023, 2022 and 2021 units completed includes joint ventures units at full unit count and is stated
on an equivalent unit basis. This equivalent unit basis allocates a proportion of the unit count for a deal to the land sale element where the deal contains a land sale. 2019 to 2020 units
completed includes the Group’s share of joint venture units and no equivalent unit allocation to land sale elements.
8 Average selling price – open market = Revenue recognised in the year on open market homes (including the Group’s share of revenue recognised in the year on open market homes by
joint ventures), divided by open market home completions (adjusted to reflect the Group’s share of joint venture units).
9 Short-term land = Land controlled by the Group with a minimum resolution to grant planning permission.
10 Strategic land = Longer-term land controlled by the Group without planning permission.
11 Land pipeline gross development value = Forecast development revenue of the land pipeline.
Historical summary (unaudited)
For the year ended/as at 31 October 2023
Crest Nicholson 163 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
Financial statements
Shareholder services and Glossary
Shareholder services
Enquiries concerning shares or
shareholdings, such as the loss of a
share certificate, consolidation of share
certificates, amalgamation of holdings or
dividend payments, should be made to the
Company’s registrar:
Equiniti Limited, Aspect House, Spencer Road
Lancing, West Sussex BN99 6DA.
Shareholder helpline: 0371 384 2183
International shareholder helpline:
+44 (0)371 384 2183. Lines are open 8.30 a.m.
to 5.30 p.m., Monday to Friday (excluding
public holidays in England and Wales).
Share fraud
Share or investment scams are often run
from ‘boiler rooms’ where fraudsters cold call
investors oering them worthless, overpriced
or even non-existent shares, or oer to buy
their shares in a company at a higher price
than the market values. Shareholders are
advised to be very wary of any unsolicited
advice, oers to buy shares at a discount,
or oers of free reports about a company.
Even seasoned investors have been caught
out by such fraudsters. The Financial Conduct
Authority has some helpful information.
Report a scam:
If you are contacted by a cold caller, you
should inform the Company Secretary by
email at info@crestnicholson.com, as well as
the Financial Conduct Authority by using their
share fraud reporting form at www.fca.org.uk/
scams, or by calling their Consumer Helpline
on 0800 111 6768. If you have already paid
money to a share fraudster you should
contact Action Fraud on 0300 123 2040 or
www.actionfraud.police.uk
Chequeless dividends
From October 2024 payments to Crest
Nicholson Holdings plc shareholders will no
longer be made by cheque.
If you currently receive your dividend via
cheque, you will need to provide your bank
or building society account details to the
registrars so that payments can be made to
your nominated account by direct credit.
In addition Crest Nicholson will only issue
annual dividend confirmations moving
forward rather than a confirmation for
each dividend payment. This will now be
provided electronically via Shareview.
To receive your dividend payments and
annual dividend confirmation, you must visit
www.shareview.co.uk to add your bank or
building society account details and your
email address.
Further information on the action that
will need to be taken will be provided to
shareholders in the letter accompanying this
Annual Report and on our website.
Glossary
Act
The Companies Act 2006
AGM
Annual General Meeting
APM
Alternative performance
measures
AQIs
Audit Quality Indicators
BEIS
Department for Business,
Energy and Industrial Strategy
BSF
Building Safety Fund
Code
UK Corporate Governance
Code
Crest
Crest Nicholson Holdings plc
and its undertakings
CVR
Cost and Value Reconciliation
DBP
Deferred Bonus Plan
D&I
Diversity & Inclusion
EBIT
Earnings before interest and
taxes
ELT
Executive Leadership Team
ERP
Enterprise resource planning
ESG
Environment, Social &
Governance
ESOT or
Trust
Employee share ownership
trust
FRC
Financial Reporting Council
FHS
Future Homes Standard
FVTPL
Fair value through profit or loss
FVOCI
Fair value through other
comprehensive income
GDV
Gross Development Value
GHG
Greenhouse gas
HBF
Home Builders Federation
IFRS
International Financial
Reporting Standards
IPPF
International Professional
Practice Framework
KPI
Key Performance Indicator
LTIP
Long-Term Incentive Plan
NHBC
National House Building
Council
NHQC
New Homes Quality Code
Notice
The Notice of the AGM
NRV
Net realised value
PBT
Profit before tax
PSL
Partnerships and Strategic
Land
Pledge
Building Safety Pledge
PRS
Private Rented Sector
OF
Operational Framework
RAMS
Risk Assessment and Method
Statements
RCF
Revolving Credit Facility
ROCE
Return on capital employed
RPDT
Residential property developer
tax
RPs
Registered Providers
SaaS
Software as a Service
SAYE
Save as you earn/Sharesave
SBTi
Science Based Targets
Initiative
SHE
Safety, Health & Environment
SPOW
Sales per outlet per week
SuDS
Sustainable drainage systems
Supplier
Code
Sustainable Procurement
Policy and Supply Chain Code
of Conduct
TCFD
Task Force on Climate-related
Financial Disclosures
tCO
2
e
Tonnes of carbon dioxide
equivalent
Crest Nicholson 164 Annual Report and financial statements 2023
This Annual Report and financial statements has been printed sustainably in the UK
by Pureprint, a CarbonNeutral® company, andcertified to ISO 14001 environmental
management system.
It has been digitally printed without the use of film separations, plates and associated
processing chemicals, and 100% of all the dry waste associated with this production
hasbeen recycled.
This publication is printed on uncoated stock, made from 100% recycled fibre, and some
flecks and variations in colour will therefore be visible. It has been manufactured at a mill
that has ISO 14001 environmental standard accreditation. The paper is Carbon Balanced
with World Land Trust, an international conservation charity, who oset carbon emissions
through the purchase and preservation of high conservation value land.
Through protecting standing forests under threat of clearance, carbon is locked-in
that would otherwise be released. These protected forests are then able to continue
absorbing carbon from the atmosphere, referred to as REDD (Reduced Emissions
fromDeforestation and forest Degradation).
Additional to the carbon benefits is the flora and fauna this land preserves,
including several species identified at risk ofextinction on the IUCN Red List of
Threatened Species.
This report is 100% recyclable.
If you no longer wish to retain this copy of the Annual Report and financial statements,
please do pass it on to someone or recycle it.
CBP00019082504183028
Crest Nicholson Holdings plc
500 Dashwood Lang Road
Bourne Business Park
Addlestone
Surrey
KT15 2HJ
Email: info@crestnicholson.com
Telephone: 01932 580 555
www.crestnicholson.com
Registered number 6800600